Ford Automobile 2010 E 150 User Manual

Table of Contents  
All rights reserved. Reproduction by any means, electronic or mechanical  
including photocopying, recording or by any information storage and retrieval  
system or translation in whole or part is not permitted without written  
authorization from Ford Motor Company. Ford may change the contents without  
notice and without incurring obligation.  
Copyright © 2009 Ford Motor Company  
3
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
CONGRATULATIONS  
Congratulations on acquiring your new Ford. Please take the time to get  
well acquainted with your vehicle by reading this handbook. The more  
you know and understand about your vehicle, the greater the safety and  
pleasure you will derive from driving it.  
For more information on Ford Motor Company and its products visit the  
following website:  
In the United States: www.ford.com  
In Canada: www.ford.ca  
In Australia: www.ford.com.au  
In Mexico: www.ford.com.mx  
Additional owner information is given in separate publications.  
This Owner’s Guide describes every option and model variant available  
and therefore some of the items covered may not apply to your  
particular vehicle. Furthermore, due to printing cycles it may describe  
options before they are generally available.  
Remember to pass on this Owner’s Guide when reselling the vehicle. It is  
an integral part of the vehicle.  
WARNING: Fuel pump shut-off switch (Diesel and  
Stripped Chassis vehicles only): In the event of an accident  
the safety switch will automatically cut off the fuel supply to the  
engine. The switch can also be activated through sudden vibration (e.g.  
collision when parking). To reset the switch, refer to the Fuel pump  
shut-off switch in the Roadside Emergencies chapter.  
4
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
SAFETY AND ENVIRONMENT PROTECTION  
Warning symbols in this guide  
How can you reduce the risk of personal injury to yourself or others? In  
this guide, answers to such questions are contained in comments  
highlighted by the warning triangle symbol. These comments should be  
read and observed.  
Warning symbols on your vehicle  
When you see this symbol, it is  
imperative that you consult the  
relevant section of this guide before  
touching or attempting adjustment  
of any kind.  
Protecting the environment  
We must all play our part in  
protecting the environment. Correct  
vehicle usage and the authorized  
disposal of waste, cleaning and  
lubrication materials are significant  
steps towards this aim. Information in this respect is highlighted in this  
guide with the tree symbol.  
CALIFORNIA Proposition 65 Warning  
WARNING: Engine exhaust, some of its constituents, and  
certain vehicle components contain or emit chemicals known to  
the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other  
reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and  
certain products of component wear contain or emit chemicals known  
to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other  
reproductive harm.  
PERCHLORATE MATERIAL  
Certain components of this vehicle such as airbag modules, seat belt  
pretensioners, and button cell batteries may contain Perchlorate Material –  
Special handling may apply for service or vehicle end of life disposal. See  
www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.  
5
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
BREAKING-IN YOUR VEHICLE  
Your vehicle does not need an extensive break-in. Try not to drive  
continuously at the same speed for the first 1,000 miles (1,600 km) of  
new vehicle operation. Vary your speed frequently in order to give the  
moving parts a chance to break in.  
Drive your new vehicle at least 1,000 miles (1,600 km) before towing a  
trailer. For more detailed information about towing a trailer, refer to  
Trailer towing in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter.  
Do not add friction modifier compounds or special break-in oils since  
these additives may prevent piston ring seating. See Engine oil in the  
Maintenance and Specifications chapter for more information on oil  
usage.  
SPECIAL NOTICES  
New Vehicle Limited Warranty  
For a detailed description of what is covered and what is not covered by  
your vehicle’s New Vehicle Limited Warranty, refer to the Warranty  
Guide/Customer Information Guide that is provided to you along with  
your Owner’s Guide.  
Special instructions  
For your added safety, your vehicle is fitted with sophisticated electronic  
controls.  
WARNING: Please read the section Airbag Supplemental  
Restraint System (SRS) in the Seating and Safety Restraints  
chapter. Failure to follow the specific warnings and instructions could  
result in personal injury.  
WARNING: Front seat mounted rear-facing child or infant seats  
should NEVER be placed in front of an active passenger airbag.  
6
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Notice to owners of diesel-powered vehicles  
Read the 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Power Stroke Direct Injection Turbo Diesel  
Owner’s Guide Supplement for information regarding correct operation  
and maintenance of your Diesel-powered light truck.  
Notice to owners of pickup trucks and utility type vehicles  
WARNING: Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover  
rate than other types of vehicles.  
Before you drive your vehicle, please read this Owner’s Guide carefully.  
Your vehicle is not a passenger car. As with other vehicles of this type,  
failure to operate this vehicle correctly may result in loss of vehicle  
control, vehicle rollover, personal injury or death.  
Using your vehicle as an ambulance  
If your light truck is equipped with the Ford Ambulance Preparation  
Package, it may be utilized as an ambulance. Ford urges ambulance  
manufacturers to follow the recommendations of the Ford Incomplete  
Vehicle Manual, Ford Truck Body Builder’s Layout Book and the  
Qualified Vehicle Modifiers (QVM) Guidelines as well as pertinent  
supplements. For additional information, please contact the Truck Body  
Builders Advisory Service at http://www.fleet.ford.com/truckbbas/ and  
then by selecting “Contact Us” or by phone at 1–877–840–4338.  
Use of your Ford light truck as an ambulance, without the Ford  
Ambulance Preparation Package voids the Ford New Vehicle Limited  
Warranty and may void the Emissions Warranties. In addition, ambulance  
usage without the preparation package could cause high underbody  
temperatures, overpressurized fuel and a risk of spraying fuel which  
could lead to fires.  
If your vehicle is equipped with the Ford Ambulance Preparation  
Package, it will be indicated on the Safety Compliance Certification  
Label. The label is located on the driver’s side door pillar or on the rear  
edge of the driver’s door. You can determine whether the ambulance  
manufacturer followed Ford’s recommendations by directly contacting  
that manufacturer.  
7
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
Using your vehicle as a stationary power source (PTO)  
Refer to the Driving chapter for more information and guidelines for  
operating a vehicle equipped with an aftermarket power take-off system.  
DATA RECORDING  
Service Data Recording  
Service data recorders in your vehicle are capable of collecting and  
storing diagnostic information about your vehicle. This potentially  
includes information about the performance or status of various systems  
and modules in the vehicle, such as engine, throttle, steering or brake  
systems. In order to properly diagnose and service your vehicle, Ford  
Motor Company, Ford of Canada, and service and repair facilities may  
access or share among them vehicle diagnostic information received  
through a direct connection to your vehicle when diagnosing or servicing  
your vehicle. For U.S. only (if equipped), if you choose to use the SYNC௡  
Vehicle Health Report, you consent that certain diagnostic information  
may also be accessed electronically by Ford Motor Company and Ford  
authorized service facilities, and that the diagnostic information may be  
used for any purpose. See your SYNCsupplement for more information.  
Event Data Recording  
Other modules in your vehicle — event data recorders — are  
capable of collecting and storing data during a crash or near  
crash event. The recorded information may assist in the  
investigation of such an event. The modules may record  
information about both the vehicle and the occupants, potentially  
including information such as:  
how various systems in your vehicle were operating;  
whether or not the driver and passenger seatbelts were  
buckled;  
how far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator  
and/or the brake pedal;  
how fast the vehicle was traveling;  
where the driver was positioning the steering wheel; and  
longitude and latitude of vehicle at last location, using GPS  
technology and advanced vehicle sensors.  
8
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
To access this information, special equipment must be directly  
connected to the recording modules. Ford Motor Company and  
Ford of Canada do not access event data recorder information  
without obtaining consent, unless pursuant to court order or  
where required by law enforcement, other government authorities  
or other third parties acting with lawful authority. Other parties  
may seek to access the information independently of Ford Motor  
Company and Ford of Canada. To the extent that any law  
pertaining to Event Data Recording applies to SYNCor its  
features, please note the following: Once 911 Assist (if equipped)  
is enabled (set ON), 911 Assist may, through any paired and  
connected cell phone, disclose to emergency services that the  
vehicle has been in a crash involving the deployment of an airbag  
or, in certain vehicles, the activation of the fuel pump shut-off.  
Certain versions or updates to 911 Assist may also be capable of  
electronically or verbally disclosing to 911 operators the vehicle  
location, and/or other details about the vehicle or crash to assist  
911 operators to provide the most appropriate emergency  
services. If you do not want to disclose this information, do not  
activate the feature. See your SYNCsupplement for more  
information. Additionally, when you connect to Traffic, Directions  
and Information (if equipped, U.S. only), the service uses GPS  
technology and advanced vehicle sensors to collect the vehicle’s  
current location, travel direction, and speed (“vehicle travel  
information”) only to help provide you with the directions, traffic  
reports, or business searches you request. If you do not want  
Ford or its vendors to receive this information, do not activate  
the service. Ford Motor Company and the vendors it uses to  
provide you with this information do not store your vehicle travel  
information. For more information, see Traffic, Directions and  
Information, Terms and Conditions. See your SYNCsupplement  
for more information.  
9
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Vehicle Modification Data Recording  
Some aftermarket products may cause severe engine and/or transmission  
damage; refer to the What is not covered section in The new vehicle  
limited warranty for your vehicle chapter of your vehicle’s Warranty  
Guide for more information. Some vehicles are equipped with  
Powertrain Control Systems that can detect and store information about  
vehicle modifications that, for example, increase horsepower and torque  
output; this information cannot be erased and will stay in the system’s  
memory even if the modification is removed. When a dealer or repair  
facility works on your vehicle, it may be necessary for them to access the  
information in the Powertrain Control System. This information will likely  
identify if any unauthorized modifications have been made to the system,  
which may be used to determine if the warranty has been violated and if  
repairs will be covered by warranty.  
CELL PHONE USE  
The use of Mobile Communications Equipment has become increasingly  
important in the conduct of business and personal affairs. However,  
drivers must not compromise their own or others’ safety when using  
such equipment. Mobile Communications can enhance personal safety  
and security when appropriately used, particularly in emergency  
situations. Safety must be paramount when using mobile communications  
equipment to avoid negating these benefits.  
Mobile Communication Equipment includes, but is not limited to cellular  
phones, pagers, portable email devices, in-vehicle communications  
systems, telematics devices and portable two-way radios.  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
10  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
EXPORT UNIQUE (NON–UNITED STATES/CANADA) VEHICLE  
SPECIFIC INFORMATION  
For your particular global region, your vehicle may be equipped with  
features and options that are different from the features and options that  
are described in this Owner’s Guide. A market unique supplement may  
be supplied that complements this book. By referring to the market  
unique supplement, if provided, you can properly identify those features,  
recommendations and specifications that are unique to your vehicle. This  
Owner’s Guide is written primarily for the U.S. and Canadian Markets.  
Features or equipment listed as standard may be different on units built  
for Export. Refer to this Owner’s Guide for all other required  
information and warnings.  
11  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
These are some of the symbols you may see on your vehicle.  
Vehicle Symbol Glossary  
Safety Alert  
See Owner’s Guide  
Airbag - Front  
Fasten Safety Belt  
Airbag - Side  
Child Seat Lower  
Anchor  
Child Seat Tether  
Anchor  
Brake System  
Anti-Lock Brake System  
Parking Brake System  
Brake Fluid -  
Non-Petroleum Based  
Parking Aid System  
Speed Control  
Stability Control System  
Master Lighting Switch  
Fog Lamps-Front  
Hazard Warning Flasher  
Fuse Compartment  
Windshield Wash/Wipe  
Fuel Pump Reset  
Windshield  
Rear Window  
Defrost/Demist  
Defrost/Demist  
12  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Vehicle Symbol Glossary  
Power Window Lockout  
Interior Luggage  
Power Windows  
Front/Rear  
Child Safety Door  
Lock/Unlock  
Compartment Release  
Panic Alarm  
Engine Oil  
Engine Coolant  
Temperature  
Engine Coolant  
Do Not Open When Hot  
Battery  
Avoid Smoking, Flames,  
or Sparks  
Battery Acid  
Fan Warning  
Explosive Gas  
MAX  
MIN  
Maintain Correct Fluid  
Level  
Power Steering Fluid  
Service Engine Soon  
Engine Air Filter  
Jack  
Passenger Compartment  
Air Filter  
Low Tire Pressure  
Warning  
Check Fuel Cap  
13  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
WARNING LIGHTS AND CHIMES  
Warning lights and gauges can alert you to a vehicle condition that may  
become serious enough to cause expensive repairs. A warning light may  
illuminate when a problem exists with one of your vehicle’s functions.  
Many lights will illuminate when you start your vehicle to make sure the  
bulb works. If any light remains on after starting the vehicle, refer to the  
respective system warning light for additional information.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel engine, it has a unique cluster,  
refer to Starting the engine in your 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Power Stroke  
Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s Guide Supplement.  
Vehicles with optional message  
center: Warning lights called out as  
RTT are reconfigurable telltale  
(RTT) indicator lights will illuminate  
in the optional message center.  
These lights function the same as  
the other warning lights. If your  
vehicle is not equipped with a  
message center, the lights will appear on the cluster.  
Service engine soon: The service  
engine soon indicator light  
illuminates when the ignition is first  
turned to the on position to check  
the bulb and to indicate whether the vehicle is ready for  
Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) testing. Normally, the ЉService engine soonЉ  
14  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
light will stay on until the engine is cranked, then turn itself off if no  
malfunctions are present. However, if after 15 seconds the service engine  
soon light blinks eight times, it means that the vehicle is not ready for  
I/M testing. See the Readiness for Inspection/Maintenance (I/M)  
testing in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
Solid illumination after the engine is started indicates the On Board  
Diagnostics System (OBD-II) has detected a malfunction. Refer to On  
board diagnostics (OBD-II) in the Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter. If the light is blinking, engine misfire is occurring which could  
damage your catalytic converter. Drive in a moderate fashion (avoid  
heavy acceleration and deceleration) and have your vehicle serviced  
immediately by your authorized dealer.  
WARNING: Under engine misfire conditions, excessive exhaust  
temperatures could damage the catalytic converter, the fuel  
system, interior floor coverings or other vehicle components, possibly  
causing a fire.  
Electronic throttle control  
(RTT): Displays when the engine  
has defaulted to a “limp-home”  
operation. Report the fault to a  
dealer at the earliest opportunity.  
Check fuel cap (RTT): Displays  
when the fuel cap may not be  
properly installed. Continued driving  
with this light on may cause the  
Service Engine Soon warning light  
to come on, refer to Fuel filler cap  
in the Maintenance and Specification chapter.  
Brake system warning light: To  
confirm the brake system warning  
light is functional, it will  
momentarily illuminate when the  
ignition is turned to the on position  
!
P
BRAKE  
when the engine is not running, or in a position between on and start, or  
by applying the parking brake when the ignition is turned to the on  
position. If the brake system warning light does not illuminate at this  
time, seek service immediately from your authorized dealer. Illumination  
after releasing the parking brake indicates low brake fluid level and the  
brake system should be inspected immediately by your authorized dealer.  
15  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
WARNING: Driving a vehicle with the brake system warning  
light on is dangerous. A significant decrease in braking  
performance may occur. It will take you longer to stop the vehicle.  
Have the vehicle checked by your authorized dealer. Driving extended  
distances with the parking brake engaged can cause brake failure and  
the risk of personal injury.  
Anti-lock brake system: If the  
ABS light stays illuminated or  
ABS  
continues to flash, a malfunction has  
been detected, have the system  
serviced immediately by your  
authorized dealer. Normal braking is still functional unless the brake  
warning light also is illuminated.  
Airbag readiness: If this light fails  
to illuminate when the ignition is  
turned to on, continues to flash or  
remains on, have the system  
serviced immediately by your authorized dealer. A chime will sound  
when there is a malfunction in the indicator light.  
Safety belt: Reminds you to fasten  
your safety belt. A Belt-Minder௡  
chime will also sound to remind you  
to fasten your safety belt. Refer to  
the Seating and Safety Restraints  
chapter to activate/deactivate the Belt-Minderchime feature.  
Engine oil pressure (RTT):  
Displays when the oil pressure falls  
below the normal range, refer to  
Engine oil in the Maintenance  
and Specifications chapter.  
Engine coolant temperature  
(RTT): Displays when the engine  
coolant temperature is high. Stop  
the vehicle as soon as possible, switch off the engine and let cool. Refer  
to Engine coolant in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
16  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
WARNING: Never remove the coolant reservoir cap while the  
engine is running or hot.  
Low tire pressure warning (if  
equipped): Illuminates when your  
tire pressure is low. If the light  
remains on at start up or while  
driving, the tire pressure should be  
checked. Refer to Inflating your tires in the Tires, Wheels and  
Loading chapter. When the ignition is first turned to on, the light will  
illuminate for three seconds to ensure the bulb is working. If the light  
does not turn on or begins to flash, have the system inspected by your  
authorized dealer. For more information on this system, refer to Tire  
pressure monitoring system (TPMS) in the Tires, Wheels and  
Loading chapter.  
Traction control / AdvanceTrac௡  
(if equipped): Illuminates when  
the traction control system or the  
AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem is  
active. If the light remains on, have  
the system serviced immediately by  
your authorized dealer. For further information, refer to Traction  
control or AdvanceTracwith roll stability control™ (RSC) stability  
enhancement system in the Driving chapter.  
WARNING: If your vehicle is equipped with the AdvanceTrac௡  
with RSCsystem, then it was designed to be operated with  
RSC. Reduce speed and proceed to an authorized dealer to have the  
system serviced immediately.  
Transmission Tow/Haul Feature  
(if equipped): Illuminates when  
the Tow/Haul feature has been  
activated. Refer to the Driving  
chapter for transmission function and operation. If the light flashes  
steadily, have the system serviced immediately, damage to the  
transmission could occur.  
17  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Anti-theft system: Flashes when  
the SecuriLockPassive Anti-theft  
System has been activated.  
Overdrive off (if equipped):  
Illuminates when the overdrive  
function of the transmission has  
been turned off; refer to the  
O/D  
OFF  
Driving chapter. If the light does not illuminate, have the transmission  
serviced soon, or damage may occur.  
Charging system (RTT):  
Illuminates when the battery is not  
charging properly. If it stays on  
while the engine is running, there  
may be a malfunction with the charging system. Contact your authorized  
dealer as soon as possible. This indicates a problem with the electrical  
system or a related component.  
Speed control: Illuminates when  
the speed control is activated. Turns  
off when the speed control system  
is deactivated.  
Low fuel (RTT): Displays when  
the fuel level in the fuel tank is at  
or near empty (refer to Fuel gauge  
in this chapter).  
Turn signal: Illuminates when the  
left or right turn signal or the  
hazard lights are turned on. If the  
indicators stay on or flash faster, check for a burned out bulb.  
High beams: Illuminates when the  
high beam headlamps are turned on.  
Key-in-ignition warning chime: Sounds when the key is left in the  
ignition in the off or accessory position and the driver’s door is opened.  
Headlamps on warning chime: Sounds when the headlamps or parking  
lamps are on, the ignition is off (the key is not in the ignition) and the  
driver’s door is opened.  
18  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Parking brake on warning chime: Sounds when the parking brake is  
set, the engine is running and the vehicle is driven more than 3 mph  
(5 km/h).  
GAUGES  
Speedometer: Indicates the  
current vehicle speed.  
Engine coolant temperature  
gauge: Indicates engine coolant  
temperature. At normal operating  
temperature, the needle will be in  
the normal range (between “H” and  
“C”). If it enters the red section,  
the engine is overheating. Stop  
the vehicle as soon as safely  
possible, switch off the engine and let the engine cool.  
19  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
WARNING: Never remove the coolant reservoir cap while the  
engine is running or hot.  
Odometer: Registers the total miles  
(kilometers) of the vehicle.  
Refer to Message center in this  
chapter on how to switch the  
display from metric to English.  
Trip odometer: Registers the miles (kilometers) of individual journeys.  
Refer to Message center in this chapter to learn how to use the trip  
odometer.  
Tachometer: Indicates the engine  
speed in revolutions per minute.  
Driving with your tachometer  
pointer continuously at the top of  
the scale may damage the engine.  
Battery voltage gauge: Indicates  
the battery voltage when the  
ignition is in the on position. If the  
pointer moves and stays outside the  
normal operating range, have the  
vehicle’s electrical system checked  
by your authorized dealer as soon as  
possible.  
Engine oil pressure gauge:  
Indicates engine oil pressure. The  
needle should stay in the normal  
operating range (between “L” and  
“H”). If the needle falls below the  
normal range, stop the vehicle, turn  
off the engine and check the engine  
oil level. Add oil if needed. If the oil  
level is correct, have your vehicle checked by your authorized dealer.  
20  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Fuel gauge: Indicates  
approximately how much fuel is left  
in the fuel tank (when the ignition  
is in the on position). The fuel  
gauge may vary slightly when the  
vehicle is in motion or on a grade.  
The FUEL icon and arrow indicates  
which side of the vehicle the fuel  
filler door is located.  
Refer to Filling the tank in the Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter for more information.  
MESSAGE CENTER (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle’s message center is capable of monitoring many vehicle  
systems and will alert you to potential vehicle problems and various  
conditions with an informational message followed by a long indicator  
chime.  
The message center display is located in the instrument cluster.  
Selectable features (information menu)  
Press and release the SELECT/RESET stem, located in the speedometer,  
to scroll and reset the following functions. Select or reset the function by  
holding the SELECT/RESET stem for more than two seconds.  
TRIP A/B  
Registers the distance of individual journeys. To reset, press and hold for  
less than two seconds.  
MILES (km) TO E  
This displays an estimate of approximately how far you can drive with  
the fuel remaining in your tank under normal driving conditions.  
Remember to turn the ignition off when refueling to allow this feature to  
correctly detect the added fuel.  
The DTE function will display LOW FUEL LEVEL when you have  
approximately 50 miles (80 km), to empty. Press the SELECT/RESET  
stem to clear this warning message. It will return at approximately  
25 miles (40 km), 10 miles (16 km) and 0 miles (0 km) to empty.  
DTE is calculated using a running average fuel economy, which is based  
on your recent driving history of 500 miles (800 km). This value is not  
the same as the average fuel economy display. The running average fuel  
economy is re-initialized to a factory default value if the battery is  
disconnected.  
21  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
XX.X MPG (L/100km)  
Average fuel economy displays your average fuel economy in miles/gallon  
or liters/100 km.  
If you calculate your average fuel economy by dividing distance traveled  
by gallons of fuel used (liters of fuel used by 100 kilometers traveled),  
your figure may be different than displayed for the following reasons:  
Your vehicle was not perfectly level during fill-up  
Differences in the automatic shut-off points on the fuel pumps at  
service stations  
Variations in top-off procedure from one fill-up to another  
Rounding of the displayed values to the nearest 0.1 gallon (liter)  
1. Drive the vehicle at least 5 miles (8 km) with the speed control  
system engaged to display a stabilized average.  
2. Record the highway fuel economy for future reference.  
It is important to press the SELECT/RESET stem (press and hold the  
SELECT/RESET stem for two seconds in order to reset the function)  
after setting the speed control to get accurate highway fuel economy  
readings.  
MPG (L/km)  
This displays instantaneous fuel economy as a bar graph ranging from ↓  
poor economy to excellent economy.  
Your vehicle must be moving to calculate instantaneous fuel economy.  
When your vehicle is not moving, this function shows , one or no bars  
illuminated. Instantaneous fuel economy cannot be reset.  
COMPASS (if equipped)  
The compass heading is displayed as one of N, NE, E, SE, S, SW, W and  
NW in the message center display.  
The compass reading may be affected when you drive near large  
buildings, bridges, power lines and powerful broadcast antenna. Magnetic  
or metallic objects placed in, on or near the vehicle may also affect  
compass accuracy.  
Usually, when something affects the compass readings, the compass will  
correct itself after a few days of operating your vehicle in normal  
conditions. If the compass still appears to be inaccurate, a manual  
calibration may be necessary. Refer to Compass zone adjustment.  
Most geographic areas (zones) have a magnetic north compass point that  
varies slightly from the northerly direction on maps. This variation is up  
22  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
to four degrees between adjacent zones and will become noticeable as  
the vehicle crosses multiple zones. A correct zone setting will eliminate  
this error. Refer to Compass calibration adjustment.  
Compass zone adjustment  
1. Determine which magnetic zone  
you are in for your geographic  
location by referring to the zone  
3 2  
4
1
15  
map.  
14  
13  
2. Press and release the  
SELECT/RESET stem to scroll  
through the information displays  
until the message center displays  
HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU.  
5
12  
6
7 8 91011  
3. Press and hold the  
SELECT/RESET stem until the  
message center displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK. Do not  
hold the stem down at this point as you do not want to enter the system  
check. Instead, quickly release the stem and repeatedly press it again to  
scroll through the setup menu until the message center displays  
COMPASS ZONE XX.  
4. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem for approximately two  
seconds to enter the compass zone adjustment mode.  
5. Press and release the SELECT/RESET stem until the desired zone  
number appears.  
6. Release the SELECT/RESET stem and allow the setup timer to expire  
to exit the procedure.  
Compass calibration adjustment  
Note: For optimum calibration, drive to an open, level location away  
from large metallic objects or structures. Switch off all non-essential  
electrical accessories (heated rear window, heater, A/C, map lamps,  
wiper, etc.) and make sure all the doors are closed.  
1. Press and release the SELECT/RESET stem to scroll through the  
information displays until the message center displays HOLD RESET  
FOR SETUP MENU.  
2. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem until the message center  
displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK. Do not hold the stem  
down at this point as you do not want to enter the system check.  
Instead, quickly release the stem and repeatedly press it again to scroll  
through the setup menu until the message center displays COMPASS  
ZONE XX.  
23  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
3. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem for approximately two  
seconds until the message center enters the compass zone adjustment  
mode.  
4. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem until the message center  
displays CIRCLE SLOWLY TO CALIBRATE.  
Note: This step may require up to five circles to complete the  
calibration.  
Note: If the SELECT/RESET stem is pressed during the calibration or  
three minutes has elapsed since the beginning of the calibration without  
driving the vehicle, the message center reverts back to normal operation  
and the CAL will display until a successful calibration is carried out.  
5. Slowly drive the vehicle in a circle less than 3 mph (5 km/h ) until the  
CIRCLE SLOWLY TO CALIBRATE message changes to CALIBRATION  
COMPLETED.  
Setup menu (vehicle customization and vehicle system check)  
HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU  
Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to get into the setup menu  
sequence for the following displays:  
Note: When returning to the setup menu and a non-English language  
has been selected, HOLD RESET FOR ENGLISH will be displayed to  
change back to English. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to  
change back to English.  
OIL LIFE XXX% HOLD RESET = NEW  
This displays the remaining oil life.  
An oil change is required whenever indicated by the message center and  
according to the recommended maintenance schedule. USE ONLY  
RECOMMENDED ENGINE OILS.  
To reset the oil monitoring system to 100% after each oil change  
(approximately 7,500 miles [12,000 km] or 12 months) perform the  
following:  
1. Press and release the SELECT/RESET stem to display “OIL LIFE  
XXX% HOLD RESET = NEW”.  
2. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem for two seconds and release  
to reset the oil life to 100%.  
Note: To change oil life 100% miles value from 7,500 miles (12,000 km)  
or 12 months to another value, proceed to Step 3.  
3. Once “OIL LIFE SET TO XXX%” is displayed, release and press the  
SELECT/RESET stem to change the Oil Life Start Value. Each release  
and press will reduce the value by 10%.  
24  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
Note: Oil life start value of 100% equals 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or  
12 months. For example, setting oil life start value to 60% sets the oil  
life start value to 4,500 miles (7,200 km) and 219 days.  
UNITS ENG / METRIC  
Displays the current units English or Metric.  
Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to change from English to  
Metric.  
Press the SELECT/RESET stem for the next setup menu item or wait for  
more than four seconds to return to the info menu.  
AUTOLOCK (if equipped)  
This feature automatically locks all vehicle doors when the vehicle is  
shifted into any gear and when the vehicle is in motion over 13 mph  
(20 km/h) or higher.  
Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to turn this feature on or off.  
Press the SELECT/RESET stem for the next setup menu item or wait for  
more than four seconds to return to the info menu.  
AUTOUNLOCK (if equipped)  
This feature automatically unlocks all vehicle doors when the driver’s  
door is opened within 10 minutes of the ignition being turned off.  
Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to turn this feature on or off.  
Press the SELECT/RESET stem for the next setup menu item or wait for  
more than four seconds to return to the info menu.  
PARK AID (if equipped)  
This feature sounds a warning tone to warn the driver of obstacles near  
the rear bumper, and functions only when R (Reverse) gear is selected.  
Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to turn this feature on or off.  
(You can also choose to turn this feature on/off when the vehicle is  
placed in reverse.)  
Press the SELECT/RESET stem for the next setup menu item or wait for  
more than four seconds to return to the info menu.  
LANGUAGE = ENGLISH / SPANISH / FRENCH  
Allows you to choose which language the message center will display in.  
Selectable languages are English, Spanish, or French.  
Note: When entering the setup menu and a non-English language has  
been selected, “PRESS RESET FOR ENGLISH” will be displayed to  
change back to English.  
25  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to select a new language.  
Selectable languages are English, Spanish and French  
Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to set the language choice.  
Press the SELECT/RESET stem for the next setup menu item or wait for  
more than four seconds to return to the info menu.  
HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK  
Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to select system check when  
HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK is displayed in the message center.  
For each of the monitored systems, the message center will indicate  
either an ok message or a warning message for two seconds. Pressing the  
SELECT/RESET stem cycles the message center through each of the  
systems being monitored.  
The sequence of the system check report and how it appears in the  
message center is as follows:  
1. XXX% OIL LIFE (Gas engine only)  
2. ENGINE HOURS  
3. ENGINE IDLE HOURS  
4. CHARGING SYSTEM  
5. BRAKE SYSTEM  
6. TBC GAIN = XX.X  
NO TRAILER (if equipped and no trailer connected)  
7. TBC GAIN = XX.X  
OUTPUT = ////// (if equipped and trailer connected)  
8. XX MILES TO E FUEL LEVEL XXX  
System warnings  
System warnings alert you to possible problems or malfunctions in your  
vehicle’s operating systems.  
In the event of a multiple warning situation, the message center will  
cycle the display to show all warnings by displaying each one for four  
seconds.  
The message center will display the last selected feature if there are no  
more warning messages.  
Types of messages and warnings:  
Some messages will appear briefly to inform you of something you  
may need to take action on or be informed of.  
26  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
Some messages will appear once and then again when the vehicle is  
restarted.  
Some messages will reappear after clearing or being reset if a problem  
or condition is still present and needs your attention.  
Some messages can be acknowledged and reset by pressing the  
SELECT/RESET stem. This allows you to use the full message center  
functionality by clearing the message.  
If the message will not reset or clear when pressing the SELECT/RESET  
stem, you must address the problem in order to clear the message.  
PARK BRAKE ENGAGED — Displayed when the parking brake is  
applied (or not fully released).  
CHECK BRAKE SYSTEM — Displayed when a fault has been detected  
by the ABS module.  
SERVICE ADVANCETRAC — Displayed when the AdvanceTrac௡  
system has detected a condition that requires service. Contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
XXX MILES TO E FUEL LEVEL LOW — Displayed as an early  
reminder of a low fuel condition.  
WIRING FAULT ON TRAILER (if equipped) — Displayed and  
accompanied by a single chime if there are certain faults in the vehicle  
wiring and trailer wiring/brake system. Refer to Trailer towing in the  
Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter for more information.  
TRAILER BRAKE MODULE FAULT (if equipped) — Displayed and  
accompanied by a single chime, in response to faults sensed by the TBC.  
Refer to Trailer towing in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter for  
more information.  
TRAILER CONNECTED (if equipped) — Displayed when a correct  
trailer connection (a trailer with electric trailer brakes) is sensed during  
a given ignition cycle. Refer to Trailer towing in the Tires, Wheels and  
Loading chapter for more information.  
TRAILER DISCONNECTED (if equipped) — Displayed and  
accompanied by a single chime when a trailer connection becomes  
disconnected, either intentionally or unintentionally, and has been sensed  
during a given ignition cycle. Refer to Trailer towing in the Tires,  
Wheels and Loading chapter for more information.  
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL LOW — Indicates the brake fluid level is low  
and the brake system should be inspected immediately. Refer to Brake  
fluid in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
27  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
CHECK REAR PARK AID (if equipped) — Displayed when the  
transmission is in R (Reverse). Refer to Reverse sensing system in the  
Driving chapter.  
LOW TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped) — Displayed when one or more  
tires on your vehicle have low tire pressure. Refer to Inflating Your  
Tires in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter.  
TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT (if equipped) — Displayed  
when the Tire Pressure Monitoring System is malfunctioning. If the  
warning stays on or continues to come on, have the system inspected by  
your authorized dealer.  
TIRE PRESSURE SENSOR FAULT (if equipped) — Displayed when  
a tire pressure sensor is malfunctioning, or your spare tire is in use. For  
more information on how the system operates under these conditions,  
refer to Understanding Your Tire Pressure Monitoring System  
(TPMS) in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter. If the warning stays  
on or continues to come on, contact your authorized dealer as soon as  
possible  
ENGINE OIL CHANGE SOON — Displayed when the engine oil life  
remaining is 5% or less. When oil life left is between 5% and 0%, the  
ENGINE OIL CHANGE SOON message will be displayed.  
OIL CHANGE REQUIRED — Displayed when the oil life left reaches  
0%, the OIL CHANGE REQUIRED message will be displayed. OIL LIFE  
OK displays after you have changed the oil.  
28  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
AUDIO SYSTEMS  
AM/FM stereo system (if equipped)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
Accessory delay: Your vehicle is equipped with accessory delay which  
allows you to operate the radio and other electrical accessories for up to  
ten minutes after the ignition has been turned off or until either front  
door is opened.  
1.  
/
: Press  
/
to  
manually go up or down the radio  
frequency. Press and hold for a fast  
advance through radio frequencies.  
Also use in AUDIO mode to gain access to various settings.  
29  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
2. AUDIO: Press AUDIO repeatedly  
to gain access to the following  
settings:  
BAL (Balance): Press AUDIO to reach the balance setting.  
Use  
right (R) speakers.  
FAD (Fade)–If equipped with four speaker audio system: Press  
/
/
SEEK  
to adjust the audio between the left (L) and  
AUDIO to reach the fade feature. Use  
/
/
SEEK  
to adjust  
the audio between the front (F) and back (B) speakers.  
TREB (Treble): Press to adjust the treble setting. Use  
/
/
SEEK  
BASS (Bass): Press to adjust the bass setting. Use  
SEEK to adjust.  
3. SEEK: Press  
to adjust.  
/
/
SEEK  
to  
access the previous/next strong  
station.  
4. Memory presets: To set a  
station: Select frequency band  
AM/FM1/FM2; tune to a station,  
press and hold a preset button until sound returns. You can save up to  
18 stations, six in AM, six in FM1 and FM2.  
5. AM/FM: Press AM/FM to select  
AM/FM1/FM2 frequency band.  
6. ON/OFF/Volume: Press  
VOL-PUSH to turn ON/OFF. Turn  
VOL-PUSH to increase/decrease  
volume.  
7. CLK (Clock): Press CLK to  
toggle between displaying the radio  
frequency and the clock setting.  
30  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Setting the clock: Press and hold CLK until the hours begin to flash.  
Press  
/
/
SEEK  
to manually increase/decrease the hours.  
Press CLK again to set the minutes using  
/
/
SEEK to  
manually increase/decrease the minutes. Allow 10 seconds to pass to  
confirm that the time has been set.  
AM/FM Single CD/MP3 satellite compatible sound system  
(if equipped)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
Accessory delay: Your vehicle is equipped with accessory delay. With  
this feature, the radio and other electrical devices may be used for up to  
ten minutes after the ignition is turned off or until either front door is  
opened.  
31  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
1.  
/
(Tuner): Press to  
manually go up or down the radio  
frequency. Also use in menu mode  
to select various settings.  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press  
/
to tune to the  
next/previous channel.  
In CATEGORY MODE, press  
/
to scroll through the list of  
available SIRIUS channel Categories (Pop, Rock, News, etc.). Refer to  
Category under Menu for further information.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS subscription.  
Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
2.  
(Phone): If your vehicle is  
equipped with SYNC, press to  
access SYNC PHONE features. For  
further information, please refer to the SYNCsupplement.  
If your vehicle is not equipped with SYNC, the display will read NO  
PHONE.  
3. MENU: Press repeatedly to  
access the following settings:  
Setting the clock: Press MENU until SET HOURS or SET MINUTES is  
displayed. Use  
/
to manually increase/decrease. Press MENU again  
to disengage clock mode.  
SATELLITE RADIO MENU (if equipped): Press MENU when satellite  
radio mode is active to access. Press OK to enter into the satellite radio  
menu. Press  
/
to cycle through the following options:  
CATEGORY: Press OK to enter category mode. Press  
/
to  
scroll through the list of available SIRIUS channel Categories (Pop,  
Rock, News, etc.) Press OK when the desired category appears in the  
display. After a category is selected, press SEEK to search for that  
specific category of channels only (i.e. ROCK). You may also select  
CATEGORY ALL to seek all available SIRIUS categories and channels.  
SAVE SONG: Press OK to save the currently playing song in the  
system’s memory. (If you try to save something other than a song,  
CANT SAVE will appear in the display.) When the chosen song is  
playing on any satellite radio channel, the system will alert you with  
32  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
an audible prompt. Press OK while SONG ALERT is in the display and  
the system will take you to the channel playing the desired song. You  
can save up to 20 songs. If you attempt to save a song when the  
system is full, the display will read REPLACE SONG? Press OK to  
access the saved songs and press  
/
to cycle through the saved  
songs. When the song appears in the display that you would like to  
replace, press OK. SONG REPLACED will appear in the display.  
DELETE SONG: Press OK to delete a song from the system’s  
memory. Press  
/
to cycle through the saved songs. When the  
song appears in the display that you would like to delete, press OK.  
The song will appear in the display for confirmation. Press OK again  
and the display will read SONG DELETED. If you do not want to  
delete the currently listed song, press  
RETURN or CANCEL.  
/
to select either  
Note: If there are no songs presently saved, the display will read NO  
SONGS.  
DELETE ALL SONGS: Press OK to delete all song’s from the  
system’s memory. The display will read ARE YOU SURE ? Press OK to  
confirm deletion of all saved songs and the display will read ALL  
DELETED.  
Note: If there are no songs presently saved, the display will read NO  
SONGS.  
ENABLE ALERTS / DISABLE ALERTS: Press OK to enable/disable  
the satellite alert status which alerts you when your selected songs are  
playing on a satellite radio channel. (The system default is disabled.)  
SONG ALERTS ENABLED/DISABLED will appear in the display. The  
menu listing will display the opposite state. For example, if you have  
chosen to enable the song alerts, the menu listing will read DISABLE  
as the alerts are currently on, so your other option is to turn them off.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
AUTOSET: Press MENU until the display reads AUTOSET. Autoset  
allows you to set the strongest local radio stations without losing your  
original manually set preset stations for AM/FM1/FM2. Use  
turn on/off.  
/
to  
When the six strongest stations are filled, the station stored in preset 1  
will begin playing. If there are less than six strong stations, the system  
will store the last one in the remaining presets.  
33  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
RBDS: Available only in FM mode. This feature allows you to search  
RBDS-equipped stations for a certain category of music format:  
CLASSIC, COUNTRY, INFORM, JAZZ/RB, ROCK, etc.  
To activate, press MENU repeatedly until RBDS (ON/OFF) appears in  
the display. Use  
/
to toggle RBDS ON/OFF. When RBDS is OFF,  
you will not be able to search for RBDS equipped stations or view the  
station name or type.  
To search for specific RBDS music categories: When the desired  
category appears in the display, press  
/
to find the desired type,  
then press and release  
begin the search.  
SEEK, SEEK  
or press and hold SCAN to  
To view the station name or type: When the desired category appears  
in the display, press TEXT/SCAN to toggle between displaying the station  
type (COUNTRY, ROCK, etc.) or the station name (WYCD, WXYZ, etc.).  
BASS: Press MENU to reach the bass setting. Use  
/
to adjust.  
TREB (Treble): Press MENU to reach the treble setting. Use  
/
to  
adjust.  
BAL (Balance): Press MENU to reach the balance setting. Use  
/
to adjust the audio between the left (L) and right (R) speakers. Press  
OK to close and return to the main menu.  
FADE (If equipped with four speaker audio system): Press MENU  
to reach the fade setting. Use  
/
to adjust the audio between the  
back (B) and front (F) speakers.  
SPEED VOL (Speed sensitive volume, if equipped): Press MENU to  
reach the SPEEDVOL setting. Radio volume automatically gets louder  
with increasing vehicle speed to compensate for road and wind noise.  
Use  
/
to adjust.  
The default setting is off; increasing your vehicle speed will not change  
the volume level.  
Adjust 1–7: Increasing this setting from 1 (lowest setting) to 7 (highest  
setting) allows the radio volume to automatically change slightly with  
vehicle speed to compensate for road and wind noise.  
Recommended level is 1–3; SPEED OFF turns the feature off and level 7  
is the maximum setting.  
34  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
TRACK/FOLDER MODE: Available only on MP3 discs in CD mode.  
In track mode, press  
the disc.  
SEEK, SEEK  
to scroll through all tracks on  
In folder mode, press  
within the selected folder.  
SEEK, SEEK  
to scroll through tracks  
Press  
FOLDER, FOLDER  
to access the previous/next folder (if  
available).  
COMPRESS (Compression): Available only in CD/MP3 mode. Press  
MENU until COMPRESS ON/OFF appears in the display. Use  
/
to  
toggle ON/OFF. When COMPRESS is ON, the system will bring the soft  
and loud CD passages together for a more consistent listening level.  
4. AUX: Press repeatedly to cycle  
through LINE IN (auxiliary audio  
mode), SYNC, SAT1, SAT2 and  
SAT3 modes (satellite radio, if equipped).  
For location and further information on auxiliary audio mode, refer to  
Auxiliary input jack later in this chapter.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
5. SEEK: In radio mode,  
press  
previous/next strong station.  
In CD mode, press  
/
to access the  
/
to  
access the previous/next CD track.  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press  
SEEK, SEEK  
to  
seek to the previous/next channel. If a specific category is selected,  
(Jazz, Rock, News, etc.), press SEEK, SEEK to seek to the  
previous/next channel in the selected category. Press and hold  
SEEK, SEEK to fast seek through the previous /next channels.  
In TEXT MODE, press SEEK, SEEK to view the  
previous/additional display text.  
In CATEGORY MODE, press  
category.  
SEEK, SEEK  
to select a  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS subscription.  
Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
35  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
6.  
/
OK  
(Play/Pause): This control is  
operational in CD/MP3 mode. When  
a CD/MP3 is playing, press to pause or play the current CD/MP3. The  
CD/MP3 status will display in the radio display.  
OK: Use in various menu selections.  
7. SHUFFLE: Press SHUFFLE to  
engage shuffle mode. SHUFFLE ON  
will appear in the display. If you  
wish to engage shuffle mode right away, press SEEK to begin random  
play. Otherwise, random play will begin when the current track is  
finished playing. CD SHUF will appear in the display.  
To disengage, press SHUFFLE. SHUFFLE OFF will appear in the display.  
Note: In track mode, all tracks on the current disc will shuffle in  
random order. In MP3 folder mode, the system will randomly play all  
tracks within the current folder.  
8. FOLDER  
press FOLDER  
: In folder mode,  
to access next  
folder on MP3 discs, if available.  
9.  
FOLDER: In folder mode,  
press  
FOLDER to access the  
previous folder on MP3 discs, if  
available.  
10. FF (Fast forward): Press FF  
to manually advance in a CD/MP3  
track.  
11. REW (Rewind): Press REW to  
manually reverse in a CD/MP3 track.  
12. Memory presets: To set a  
station, select the desired frequency  
band, AM, FM1 or FM2. Tune to the  
desired station. Press and hold a preset button until sound returns and  
PRESET # SAVED appears in the display. You can save up to 18 stations,  
six in AM, six in FM1 and FM2.  
36  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), there are 18 available presets,  
six each for SAT1, SAT2 and SAT3. To save satellite channels in your  
memory presets, tune to the desired channel then press and hold a  
preset control until sound returns.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
13. TEXT/SCAN: In radio and  
CD/MP3 mode, press and hold for  
a brief sampling of radio stations or  
CD tracks. Press again to stop.  
In MP3 mode, press and release to display track title, artist name, and  
disc title.  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press and release to enter  
TEXT MODE and display the current song title. While in TEXT MODE,  
press again to scroll through the current song title, artist, channel  
category and the SIRIUS long channel name.  
In TEXT MODE, sometimes the display requires additional text to be  
displayed. When the “>” indicator is active, press SEEK  
additional display text. When the “<” indicator is active, press  
to view the previous display text.  
to view the  
SEEK  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press and hold to hear a brief  
sampling of the next channels. Press again to stop. In CATEGORY  
MODE, press SCAN to hear a brief sampling of the channels in the  
selected category. Press again to stop.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
14. AM/FM: Press to select  
AM/FM1/FM2 frequency band.  
15. ON/OFF/Volume: Press to turn  
ON/OFF. Turn to increase/decrease  
volume.  
Note: If the volume is set above a  
certain level and the ignition is  
turned off, the volume will come back on at a “nominal” listening level  
when the ignition switch is turned back on.  
16. CD: Press to enter CD/MP3  
mode. If a CD/MP3 is already loaded  
into the system, CD/MP3 play will  
begin where it ended last. If no CD is loaded, NO DISC will appear in the  
display.  
37  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
17.  
CD.  
(CD eject): Press to eject a  
18. CD slot: Insert a CD label side  
up in the CD slot.  
Auxiliary input jack (if equipped)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
Your vehicle may be equipped with  
an Auxiliary Input Jack (AIJ). The  
Auxiliary Input Jack, located on the  
instrument panel near the radio,  
provides a way to connect your  
portable music player to the  
in-vehicle audio system. This allows  
the audio from a portable music  
player to be played through the  
vehicle speakers with high fidelity.  
To achieve optimal performance,  
please observe the following  
instructions when attaching your  
portable music device to the audio  
system.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a  
navigation system, refer to  
Auxiliary input jack section in the  
Audio features chapter of your  
Navigation system supplement.  
Required equipment:  
1. Any portable music player designed to be used with headphones  
38  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
2. An audio extension cable with stereo male 1/8 in. (3.5 mm)  
connectors at each end  
To play your portable music player using the auxiliary input jack:  
1. Begin with the vehicle parked and the radio turned off.  
2. Ensure that the battery in your portable music player is new or fully  
charged and that the device is turned off.  
3. Attach one end of the audio extension cable to the headphone output  
of your player and the other end of the audio extension cable to the AIJ  
in your vehicle.  
4. Turn the radio on, using either a tuned FM station or a CD loaded into  
the system. Adjust the volume to a comfortable listening level.  
5. Turn the portable music player on and adjust the volume to 1/2 the  
volume.  
6. Press AUX on the vehicle radio repeatedly until LINE, LINE IN or  
SYNC LINE IN appears in the display.  
You should hear audio from your portable music player although it may  
be low.  
7. Adjust the sound on your portable music player until it reaches the  
level of the FM station or CD by switching back and forth between the  
AUX and FM or CD controls.  
Troubleshooting:  
1. Do not connect the audio input jack to a line level output. Line level  
outputs are intended for connection to a home stereo and are not  
compatible with the AIJ. The AIJ will only work correctly with devices  
that have a headphone output with a volume control.  
2. Do not set the portable music player’s volume level higher than is  
necessary to match the volume of the CD or FM radio in your audio  
system as this will cause distortion and will reduce sound quality. Many  
portable music players have different output levels, so not all players  
should be set at the same levels. Some players will sound best at full  
volume and others will need to be set at a lower volume.  
3. If the music sounds distorted at lower listening levels, turn the  
portable music player volume down. If the problems persist, replace or  
recharge the batteries in the portable music player.  
4. The portable music player must be controlled in the same manner  
when it is used with headphones as the AIJ does not provide control  
(play, pause, etc.) over the attached portable music player.  
5. For safety reasons, connecting or adjusting the settings on your  
portable music player should not be attempted while the vehicle is  
39  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
moving. Also, the portable music player should be stored in a secure  
location, such as the center console or the glove box, when the vehicle is  
in motion. The audio extension cable must be long enough to allow the  
portable music player to be safely stored while the vehicle is in motion.  
USB port (if equipped)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a  
USB port located on the instrument  
panel. This feature allows you to  
plug in media playing devices,  
memory sticks, and also to charge  
devices if they support this feature.  
For further information on this  
feature, refer to Accessing and  
using your USB port in the SYNC௡  
supplement or Navigation system  
supplement.  
GENERAL AUDIO INFORMATION  
Radio frequencies:  
AM and FM frequencies are established by the Federal Communications  
Commission (FCC) and the Canadian Radio and Telecommunications  
Commission (CRTC). Those frequencies are:  
AM: 530, 540–1700, 1710 kHz  
FM: 87.7, 87.9–107.7, 107.9 MHz  
40  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Radio reception factors:  
There are three factors that can affect radio reception:  
Distance/strength: The further you travel from an FM station, the  
weaker the signal and the weaker the reception.  
Terrain: Hills, mountains, tall buildings, power lines, electric fences,  
traffic lights and thunderstorms can interfere with your reception.  
Station overload: When you pass a broadcast tower, a stronger signal  
may overtake a weaker one and play while the weak station frequency  
is displayed.  
CD/CD player care  
Do:  
Handle discs by their edges only.  
(Never touch the playing  
surface).  
Inspect discs before playing.  
Clean only with an approved CD  
cleaner.  
Wipe discs from the center out.  
Don’t:  
Expose discs to direct sunlight or heat sources for extended periods  
of time.  
Clean using a circular motion.  
CD units are designed to play commercially pressed 4.75 in  
(12 cm) audio compact discs only. Due to technical  
incompatibility, certain recordable and re-recordable compact  
discs may not function correctly when used in Ford CD players.  
41  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Do not use any irregular shaped  
CDs or discs with a scratch  
protection film attached.  
CDs with homemade paper  
(adhesive) labels should not be  
inserted into the CD player as  
the label may peel and cause the  
CD to become jammed. It is  
recommended that homemade  
CDs be identified with  
permanent felt tip marker rather  
than adhesive labels. Ballpoint pens may damage CDs. Please  
contact your authorized dealer for further information.  
Audio system warranty and service  
Refer to the Warranty Guide/Customer Information Guide for audio  
system warranty information. If service is necessary, see your dealer or  
qualified technician.  
MP3 track and folder structure  
Your MP3 system recognizes MP3 individual tracks and folder structure  
as follows:  
There are two different modes for MP3 disc playback: MP3 track mode  
(system default) and MP3 folder mode. For more information on track  
and folder mode, refer to Sample MP3 structure in the following  
section.  
MP3 track mode ignores any folder structure on the MP3 disc. The  
player numbers each MP3 track on the disc (noted by the .mp3 file  
extension) from T001 to a maximum of T255.  
Note: The maximum number of playable MP3 files may be less  
depending on the structure of the CD and exact model of radio  
present.  
MP3 folder mode represents a folder structure consisting of one level  
of folders. The CD player numbers all MP3 tracks on the disc (noted  
by the .mp3 file extension) and all folders containing MP3 files, from  
F001 (folder) T001 (track) to F253 T255.  
Creating discs with only one level of folders will help with navigation  
through the disc files.  
42  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Sample MP3 structure  
If you are burning your own MP3  
discs, it is important to understand  
how the system will read the  
structures you create. While various  
files may be present, (files with  
extensions other than mp3), only  
files with the .mp3 extension will be  
played. Other files will be ignored  
by the system. This enables you to  
use the same MP3 disc for a variety  
of tasks on your work computer,  
home computer and your in vehicle  
system.  
.mp3  
.mp3  
1
1
2
3
.mp3  
2
3
4
5
.mp3  
.mp3  
.mp3  
4
6
7
.mp3  
.doc  
.ppt  
.xls  
In track mode, the system will display and play the structure as if it were  
only one level deep (all .mp3 files will be played, regardless of being in a  
specific folder). In folder mode, the system will only play the .mp3 files  
in the current folder.  
Satellite radio information (if equipped)  
Satellite radio channels: SIRIUSbroadcasts a variety of music, news,  
sports, weather, traffic and entertainment satellite radio channels. For  
more information and a complete list of SIRIUSsatellite radio channels,  
visit www.sirius.com in the United States, www.sirius-canada.ca in  
Canada, or call SIRIUSat 1–888–539–7474.  
Satellite radio reception factors: To receive the satellite signal, your  
vehicle has been equipped with a satellite radio antenna located on the  
roof of your vehicle. The vehicle roof provides the best location for an  
unobstructed, open view of the sky, a requirement of a satellite radio  
system. Like AM/FM, there are several factors that can affect satellite  
radio reception performance:  
Antenna obstructions: For optimal reception performance, keep the  
antenna clear of snow and ice build-up and keep luggage and other  
material as far away from the antenna as possible.  
43  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Terrain: Hills, mountains, tall buildings, bridges, tunnels, freeway  
overpasses, parking garages, dense tree foliage and thunderstorms can  
interfere with your reception.  
Station overload: When you pass a ground based broadcast repeating  
tower, a stronger signal may overtake a weaker one and result in an  
audio mute.  
Unlike AM/FM audible static, you will hear an audio mute when there is  
a satellite radio signal interference. Your radio display may display NO  
SIGNAL to indicate the interference.  
SIRIUSsatellite radio service: SIRIUSsatellite radio is a  
subscription based satellite radio service that broadcasts music, sports,  
news and entertainment programming. A service fee is required in order  
to receive SIRIUSservice. Vehicles that are equipped with a factory  
installed SIRIUSsatellite radio system include hardware and a limited  
subscription term, which begins on the date of sale or lease of the  
vehicle.  
For information on extended subscription terms, the online media player  
and other SIRIUSfeatures, please contact SIRIUSat 1–888–539–7474.  
Note: SIRIUSreserves the unrestricted right to change, rearrange, add  
or delete programming including canceling, moving or adding particular  
channels, and its prices, at any time, with or without notice to you. Ford  
Motor Company shall not be responsible for any such programming  
changes.  
Satellite radio electronic serial number (ESN): This 12–digit  
Satellite Serial Number is needed to activate, modify or track your  
satellite radio account. You will need this number when communicating  
with SIRIUS. While in satellite radio mode, you can view this number  
on the radio display by pressing the AUX and preset 1 controls  
simultaneously.  
44  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Radio Display  
Condition  
Action Required  
ACQUIRING  
Radio requires more No action required. This  
than two seconds to message should disappear  
produce audio for  
the selected  
channel.  
shortly.  
SAT FAULT  
Internal module or  
system failure  
present.  
If this message does not  
clear within a short period  
of time, or with an ignition  
key cycle, your receiver  
may have a fault. See your  
authorized dealer for  
service.  
INVALID CHNL  
Channel no longer  
available.  
This previously available  
channel is no longer  
available. Tune to another  
channel. If the channel was  
one of your presets, you  
may choose another  
channel for that preset  
button.  
UNSUBSCRIBED  
NO TEXT  
Subscription not  
available for this  
channel.  
Contact SIRIUSat  
1–888–539–7474 to  
subscribe to the channel or  
tune to another channel.  
Artist information not  
available at this time on  
this channel. The system is  
working properly.  
Artist information  
not available.  
NO TEXT  
Song title  
information not  
available.  
Song title information not  
available at this time on  
this channel. The system is  
working properly.  
45  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Radio Display  
NO TEXT  
Condition  
Action Required  
Category information not  
available at this time on  
this channel. The system is  
working properly.  
Category  
information not  
available.  
NO SIGNAL  
Loss of signal from You are in a location that is  
the SIRIUSsatellite blocking the SIRIUSsignal  
or SIRIUStower to  
the vehicle antenna.  
(i.e., tunnel, under an  
overpass, dense foliage,  
etc). The system is  
working properly. When  
you move into an open  
area, the signal should  
return.  
UPDATING  
Update of channel  
programming in  
progress.  
No action required. The  
process may take up to  
three minutes.  
CALL SIRIUS௡  
1–888–539–7474  
Satellite service has  
been deactivated by  
SIRIUSsatellite  
radio.  
Call SIRIUSat  
1–888–539–7474 to  
re-activate or resolve  
subscription issues.  
NAVIGATION SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a navigation system. Refer to the  
Navigation System supplement for further information.  
SYNC(IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with SYNC, a hands-free communications  
and entertainment system with special phone and media features. For  
more information, please refer to the SYNCsupplement.  
46  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Climate Controls  
HEATER ONLY SYSTEM  
(IF EQUIPPED)  
1. Fan speed adjustment: Controls  
the volume of air circulated in the  
vehicle.  
2. Temperature selection:  
Controls the temperature of the  
airflow in the vehicle.  
3. Air flow selections: Controls the direction of the airflow in the  
vehicle. See the following for a brief description on each control.  
VENT: Distributes outside air through the instrument panel vents.  
FLR: Distributes outside air through the floor vents.  
OFF: Outside air is shut out and the climate system is turned off.  
MIX: Distributes outside air through the windshield defroster vents and  
the floor vents.  
: Distributes outside air through the windshield defroster vents.  
Operating tips  
To reduce fog build up on the windshield during humid weather, place  
the air flow selector in the  
position.  
To reduce humidity build up inside the vehicle during cold or warm  
weather, do not drive with the air flow selector in the OFF position.  
Do not put objects under the front seats that will interfere with the air  
flow to the back seats.  
Remove any snow, ice or leaves from the air intake area at the base of  
the windshield.  
To aid in side window defogging/demisting in cold weather:  
1. Select MIX.  
2. Set the temperature control to maintain comfort.  
3. Set the fan speed to HI.  
47  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Climate Controls  
MANUAL HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM  
(IF EQUIPPED)  
1. Fan speed adjustment: Controls  
the volume of air circulated in the  
vehicle.  
2. Temperature selection:  
Controls the temperature of the  
airflow in the vehicle.  
3. Air flow selections: Controls the direction of the airflow in the  
vehicle. Also controls the airflow for the rear auxiliary system (if  
equipped). See the following for a brief description on each control.  
MAX A/C: Uses recirculated air to cool the vehicle. Air flows from the  
instrument panel vents only. If equipped with auxiliary A/C, auxiliary  
airflow will be from the rear headliner vents.  
NORM A/C: Uses outside air to cool the vehicle. Air flows from the  
instrument panel vents only. If equipped with auxiliary A/C, auxiliary  
airflow will be from the rear headliner vents.  
VENT: Distributes outside air through the instrument panel vents.  
OFF: Outside air is shut out and the climate system is turned off.  
FLR: Distributes outside air through the floor vents. If equipped with  
rear auxiliary heater or A/C, auxiliary airflow will be from the rear floor  
vents.  
MIX: Distributes outside air through the windshield defroster vents and  
floor vents. If equipped with rear auxiliary heater or A/C, auxiliary  
airflow will be from the rear floor vents.  
: Distributes outside air through the windshield defroster vents. If  
equipped with rear auxiliary heater or A/C, auxiliary airflow will be from  
the rear floor vents.  
48  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Climate Controls  
Operating tips  
To reduce fog build up on the windshield during humid weather, place  
the air flow selector in the position.  
To reduce humidity build up inside the vehicle: do not drive with the  
air flow selector in the OFF position.  
Do not put objects under the front seats that will interfere with the  
airflow to the back seats.  
Remove any snow, ice or leaves from the air intake area at the base of  
the windshield.  
During extreme high ambient temperatures when idling stationary for  
extended periods of time in gear, it is recommended to run the A/C in  
the MAX A/C position, turn off the rear A/C unit (if equipped), reduce  
blower fan speed from the highest setting and put the vehicle’s  
transmission into the PARK gear position to continue to receive cool air  
from your A/C system.  
To aid in side window defogging/demisting in cold weather:  
1. Select MIX.  
2. Set the temperature control to maintain comfort.  
3. Set the fan speed to HI.  
REAR FAN SPEED ADJUSTMENT (IF EQUIPPED)  
The rear fan controls adjust the  
volume of air circulated in the rear  
of the vehicle.  
49  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
HEADLAMP CONTROL  
Turns the lamps off.  
Turns on the parking lamps,  
instrument panel lamps, license  
plate lamps and tail lamps.  
Turns the headlamps on.  
Daytime running lamps (DRL) (if equipped)  
Turns the headlamps on with a reduced output.  
To activate:  
the ignition must be in the on position and  
the headlamp control is in the off or parking lamp position.  
WARNING: Always remember to turn on your headlamps at  
dusk or during inclement weather. The Daytime Running Lamp  
(DRL) system does not activate the tail lamps and generally may not  
provide adequate lighting during these conditions. Failure to activate  
your headlamps under these conditions may result in a collision.  
High beams  
Push the lever toward the  
instrument panel to activate. Pull  
the lever toward you to deactivate.  
50  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Flash to pass  
Pull toward you slightly to activate  
and release to deactivate.  
PANEL DIMMER CONTROL  
Use to adjust the brightness of the  
instrument panel and all applicable  
illuminated switches in the vehicle  
during headlamp and parklamp  
operation.  
Move the control to the full upright  
position, past detent, to turn on the  
interior lamps.  
Note: If the battery is disconnected,  
discharged, or a new battery is  
installed, the dimmer switch requires re-calibration. Rotate the dimmer  
switch from the full dim position to the full dome/on position to reset.  
This will ensure that your displays are visible under all lighting  
conditions  
The dome lamp will not illuminate if the control switch is not rotated  
past the detent.  
VERTICAL AND HORIZONTAL AIM ADJUSTMENT  
(SEALED BEAM HEADLAMPS)  
The headlamps on your vehicle are intended to be aimed using  
mechanical aimers. If mechanical aimers are used and the cross-car sight  
line is in any way blocked, set the legs of the universal adaptor all to the  
same setting, such that the cross-car sight line is no longer blocked, per  
the instructions for the brand of mechanical aimer used. You can also  
aim the headlamps visually using the procedure below.  
51  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
To adjust the headlamps:  
1. Park your vehicle on a level surface about 25 feet (7.6 meters) away  
from a vertical plain surface (3). Check your headlamp alignment at  
night or in a dark area so that you can see the headlamp beam pattern.  
(1) 8 feet (2.4 meters)  
(2) Center height of lamp to  
ground  
(3) 25 feet (7.6 meters)  
(4) Horizontal reference line  
(5) Center of headlamps  
(6) Center line of the vehicle  
2. The center of the headlamp is  
marked either on the lens (a circle  
or cross marker) or on the bulb shield, internal to the lamp (mark or  
feature). Measure the height from the center of your headlamp to the  
ground (2) and mark an 8 foot (2.4 meter) long horizontal line on the  
wall or screen (1) at this height (masking tape works well).  
3. Turn on the low beam headlamps  
and open the hood.  
4. Locate the high intensity area of  
the beam pattern and place the top  
edge of the intensity zone even with  
the horizontal reference line (4). If  
the top edge of the high intensity  
area is not even with the horizontal  
line, follow the next step to adjust  
it.  
5. Locate the vertical adjuster (1)  
for each headlamp. Adjust the aim  
by turning the adjuster control  
either clockwise (to adjust up) or  
counterclockwise (to adjust down).  
6. In addition to the horizontal line  
marked in step 2, a pair of vertical  
lines (5) must be marked at the  
center line of the headlamps on the  
wall or screen.  
52  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
7. On the wall or screen, locate the high intensity area of the beam  
pattern. The left edge of the high intensity area should be even with the  
vertical line corresponding to the headlamp under adjustment. If the left  
edge of the high intensity area is not even with the vertical line, follow  
the next step to adjust it.  
8. Locate the horizontal adjuster (2) for each headlamp. Turn it  
clockwise or counterclockwise, to place the left edge of the high  
intensity area even with the vertical line corresponding to the headlamp  
under adjustment.  
VERTICAL AIM ADJUSTMENT (AERODYNAMIC HEADLAMPS)  
The headlamps on your vehicle can only be vertically adjusted. Your  
vehicle does not require horizontal aim adjustments.  
To adjust the headlamps:  
1. Park the vehicle directly in front of a wall or screen on a level surface,  
approximately 25 feet (7.6 meters) away.  
(1) 8 feet (2.4 meters)  
(2) Center height of lamp to  
ground  
(3) 25 feet (7.6 meters)  
(4) Horizontal reference line  
2. Measure the height from the  
center of your headlamp (indicated  
by a 3.0 mm circle on the lens) to  
the ground and mark an 8 foot  
(2.4 meter) horizontal reference line  
on the vertical wall or screen at this height (a piece of masking tape  
works well).  
3. Turn on the low beam headlamps to illuminate the wall or screen and  
open the hood. Cover one of the headlamps so no light hits the wall.  
4. On the wall or screen you will  
observe a light pattern with a  
distinct horizontal edge towards the  
right. If this edge is not at the  
horizontal reference line, the beam will need to be adjusted so the edge  
is at the same height as the horizontal reference line.  
53  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
5. Locate the vertical adjuster on  
the back of each headlamp, then use  
a long Phillips #2 screwdriver to  
turn the adjuster either  
counterclockwise (to adjust down)  
or clockwise (to adjust up) aligning  
the upper edge of the light pattern  
up to the horizontal line.  
6. Repeat step 3–5 for the other  
headlamp.  
7. Close the hood and turn off the lamps.  
TURN SIGNAL CONTROL  
Push down to activate the left  
turn signal.  
Push up to activate the right turn  
signal.  
INTERIOR LAMPS  
Dome lamps with rear headliner  
Dome lamps equipped with an  
ON/OFF/DOOR control will light  
when:  
doors are closed and the control  
is in the ON position  
control is in the DOOR position  
and any door is open  
headlamp control is rotated fully counterclockwise  
When the control is in the OFF position, it will not illuminate when you  
open the doors or fully rotate the headlamp control.  
54  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Cargo lamps  
The dome portion of the cargo  
lamp, the center light, can be turned  
on when the headlamp control is  
rotated fully counterclockwise or  
when any door is opened.  
With the ignition key in the accessory or on position, the rear lamp can  
be turned on or off by sliding the control.  
Front and rear courtesy/reading  
lamps  
The dome portion of the lamp, the  
center light, can be turned on when  
the headlamp control is rotated fully  
counterclockwise or when any door  
is opened.  
The reading lamp portion, the two outer lights, can only be toggled on  
and off at the lamp.  
BULB REPLACEMENT  
Lamp assembly condensation  
Exterior lamps are vented to accommodate normal changes in pressure.  
Condensation can be a natural by-product of this design. When moist air  
enters the lamp assembly through the vents, there is a possibility that  
condensation can occur when the temperature is cold. When normal  
condensation occurs, a thin film of mist can form on the interior of the  
lens. The thin mist eventually clears and exits through the vents during  
normal operation. Clearing time may take as long as 48 hours under dry  
weather conditions.  
Examples of acceptable condensation are:  
Presence of thin mist (no streaks, drip marks or droplets)  
Fine mist covers less than 50% of the lens  
55  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Examples of unacceptable moisture (usually caused by a lamp water  
leak) are:  
Water puddle inside the lamp  
Large water droplets, drip marks or streaks present on the interior of  
the lens  
Take your vehicle to dealer for service if any of the above conditions of  
unacceptable moisture are present.  
Using the right bulbs  
Replacement bulbs are specified in the chart below. Headlamp bulbs  
must be marked with an authorized “D.O.T.” for North America and an  
“E” for Europe to ensure lamp performance, light brightness and pattern  
and safe visibility. The correct bulbs will not damage the lamp assembly  
or void the lamp assembly warranty and will provide quality bulb burn  
time.  
Function  
Number of Trade number  
bulbs  
Headlamps (aerodynamic)  
Headlamps (sealed beam)  
Park lamp with aerodynamic  
2
2
2
H13/9008  
H6054  
3157A or  
3157AK  
3157K  
168  
Park lamp with sealed beam  
Side marker with aerodynamic  
Side marker with sealed beam  
Back-up lamps  
2
2
2
2
1
2
2
1
1
2
194  
3156K or 3156  
168  
License plate lamp  
Stop/tail/turn/side marker lamp  
High-mount brakelamp  
Cargo lamp  
Dome lamp (standard)  
Map/reading lamp  
3157K  
912  
211-2  
912  
211-2  
All replacement bulbs are clear in color except where noted.  
To replace all instrument panel lights - see your authorized dealer  
56  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Replacing exterior bulbs  
Check the operation of all bulbs frequently.  
Replacing headlamp bulbs (aerodynamic)  
1. Make sure the headlamp switch is in the off position, then open the  
hood.  
2. Remove the three screws from  
the headlamp assembly and pull the  
assembly straight out.  
3. Disconnect the electrical  
connector by squeezing the release  
tab and pushing the connector  
forward, then pulling it rearward.  
4. Remove the bulb assembly by  
turning it counterclockwise and  
pulling it straight out.  
WARNING: Handle a halogen headlamp bulb carefully and keep  
out of children’s reach. Grasp the bulb only by its plastic base  
and do not touch the glass. The oil from your hand could cause the  
bulb to break the next time the headlamps are operated.  
Note: If the bulb is accidentally touched, it should be cleaned with  
alcohol before being used.  
To install the new bulb, follow the removal procedures in reverse order.  
57  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Replacing headlamps (sealed beam)  
1. Make sure the headlamp switch is in the off position, then open the  
hood.  
2. Remove the four screws from the  
headlamp assembly and carefully  
remove the lamp/bezel.  
3. Remove the four screws and the  
retaining ring.  
4. Disconnect the electrical  
connector from the lamp and  
remove the lamp.  
To install the new lamp, follow the  
removal procedures in reverse order.  
Replacing front parking lamp/turn signal bulbs  
1. Make sure the headlamp control is in the off position.  
2. Remove the headlamp assembly. Refer to Replacing headlamp bulbs  
in this section.  
Aerodynamic  
Sealed beam  
3. Rotate the bulb socket counterclockwise and remove.  
58  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
4. Carefully pull the bulb straight out of the socket.  
To complete installation, follow the removal procedures in reverse order.  
Replacing side marker bulbs  
1. Make sure the headlamp control is in the off position.  
2. Remove the headlamp assembly. Refer to Replacing headlamp bulbs  
in this section.  
Aerodynamic  
Sealed beam  
3. Rotate the bulb socket counterclockwise and remove.  
4. Carefully pull the bulb straight out of the socket.  
To complete installation, follow the removal procedures in reverse order.  
59  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
Replacing high-mount brakelamp bulbs  
On vehicles without a rear headliner, the interior cargo lamp (if  
equipped) must be removed from under the high-mount brakelamp  
assembly located inside the vehicle. Then, do the following:  
1. Remove the two screws from the  
high-mount brakelamp assembly and  
lift the lamp from the vehicle.  
2. Remove the bulb socket from the  
lamp assembly by turning it  
counterclockwise.  
3. Carefully pull the bulb straight  
out of the socket.  
To install the new bulb, follow the removal procedure in reverse order.  
Replacing license plate lamp bulbs  
1. Turn the headlamp switch to the  
off position.  
2. Remove the two screws and the  
license plate lamp assembly from  
the rear door.  
3. Remove bulb socket from lamp  
assembly by turning it  
counterclockwise.  
4. Pull the bulb out from socket and  
push in the new bulb.  
To install the new bulb, follow the removal procedures in reverse order.  
60  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
Replacing stop/turn/tail/side marker/backup lamp bulbs  
The stop/turn/tail/side marker/backup lamp bulbs are located in the tail  
lamp assembly. Follow the same steps to replace any of the bulbs:  
1. Turn the headlamp switch to the  
off position, then remove the four  
screws and the lamp assembly from  
the vehicle.  
2. Rotate the bulb socket  
counterclockwise and remove it  
from lamp assembly.  
3. Carefully pull the bulb straight  
out of the socket and push in the  
new bulb.  
To install the lamp, follow the removal procedures in reverse order.  
61  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
MULTI-FUNCTION LEVER  
Windshield wiper: Rotate the end  
of the control away from you to  
increase the speed of the wipers;  
rotate towards you to decrease the  
speed of the wipers.  
Windshield washer: Press the end  
of the stalk:  
briefly: causes a single swipe of  
the wipers without washer fluid.  
a quick press and hold: the  
wipers will swipe three times with  
washer fluid.  
a long press and hold: the wipers  
and washer fluid will be activated  
for up to ten seconds.  
Courtesy wipe feature: One extra wipe will occur a few seconds after  
washing the front window to clear any excess washer fluid remaining on  
the windshield.  
Note: Do not operate the washer when the washer reservoir is empty.  
This may cause the washer pump to overheat. Check the washer fluid  
level frequently. Do not operate the wipers when the windshield is dry.  
This may scratch the glass, damage the wiper blades and cause the wiper  
motor to burn out. Before operating the wiper on a dry windshield,  
always use the windshield washer. In freezing weather, be sure the wiper  
blades are not frozen to the windshield before operating the wipers.  
62  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
TILT STEERING WHEEL  
To adjust the steering wheel:  
1. Pull and hold the steering wheel  
release control toward you.  
2. Move the steering wheel up or  
down until you find the desired  
location.  
3. Release the steering wheel  
release control. This will lock the  
steering wheel in position.  
WARNING: Never adjust the steering wheel when the vehicle is  
moving.  
ILLUMINATED VISOR MIRROR (IF EQUIPPED)  
Lift the mirror cover to turn on the  
visor mirror lamp.  
AUXILIARY POWER POINT (12VDC)  
Power outlets are designed for accessory plugs only. Do not insert  
any other object in the power outlet as this will damage the  
outlet and blow the fuse. Do not hang any type of accessory or  
accessory bracket from the plug. Improper use of the power  
outlet can cause damage not covered by your warranty.  
Auxiliary power points can be found in the following locations:  
On the instrument panel, equipped with a cover or a cap plug  
Behind the driver’s seat on the upper trim panel (if equipped)  
In the glove box (if equipped)  
Do not use the power point for operating the cigarette lighter element (if  
equipped).  
63  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
To prevent the fuse from being blown, do not use the power point(s)  
over the vehicle capacity of 12 VDC/180W. If the power point is not  
working, a fuse may have blown. Refer to Fuses and relays in the  
Roadside Emergencies chapter for information on checking and  
replacing fuses.  
To have full capacity usage of your power point, the engine is required to  
be running to avoid unintentional discharge of the battery. To prevent  
the battery from being discharged:  
do not use the power point longer than necessary when the engine is  
not running,  
do not leave battery chargers, video game adapters, computers and  
other devices plugged in overnight or when the vehicle is parked for  
extended periods.  
Always keep the power point caps closed when not being used.  
POWER WINDOWS (IF EQUIPPED)  
WARNING: Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle and  
do not let children play with the power windows. They may  
seriously injure themselves.  
WARNING: When closing the power windows, you should verify  
they are free of obstructions and ensure that children and/or  
pets are not in the proximity of the window openings.  
Press and pull the window switches  
to open and close windows.  
Press down (to the first detent)  
and hold the switch to open.  
Pull up (to the first detent) and  
hold the switch to close.  
64  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
One-touch down  
Allows the driver’s window to open  
fully without holding the control  
down. Press the switch completely  
down to the second detent and  
release quickly. The window will  
open fully. Momentarily press the  
switch to any position to stop the  
window operation.  
Accessory delay  
With accessory delay, the window switches and radio may be used for up  
to 10 minutes after the ignition switch is turned to the off position, or  
until any door is opened.  
INTERIOR MIRROR  
The interior rear view mirror has two pivot points on the support arm  
which lets you adjust the mirror up or down and from side to side.  
WARNING: Do not adjust the mirror while the vehicle is in  
motion.  
Automatic dimming interior rear view mirror (if equipped)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with an interior rear view mirror that has  
an auto-dimming function. The electronic day/night mirror will change  
from the normal (high reflective) state to the non-glare (darkened) state  
when bright lights (glare) reach the mirror. When the mirror detects  
bright light from behind the vehicle, it will automatically adjust (darken)  
to minimize glare.  
The mirror will automatically return to the normal state whenever the  
vehicle is placed in R (Reverse) to ensure a bright clear view when  
backing up.  
Do not block the sensors on the front and back of the interior  
rear view mirror since this may impair proper mirror  
performance.  
65  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Do not clean the housing or glass of any mirror with harsh  
abrasives, fuel or other petroleum-based cleaning products.  
Note: If equipped with a reverse camera system, a video image will  
display in the mirror or the Navigation system display (if equipped)  
when the vehicle is put in R (Reverse). As you shift into any other gear  
from R (Reverse), the image will remain for a few seconds and then turn  
off. Refer to Rearview camera system in the Driving chapter.  
EXTERIOR MIRRORS  
Power side view mirrors (if equipped)  
To adjust your mirrors:  
1. Rotate the control clockwise to  
adjust the right mirror and rotate  
the control counterclockwise to  
adjust the left mirror.  
2. Move the control in the direction  
you wish to tilt the mirror.  
3. Return to the center position to lock mirrors in place.  
Spotter mirror (if equipped)  
Note: New spotter mirrors may be stiff, requiring several cycles before  
the spotter adjustment effort eases.  
Spotter mirror on standard  
mirror (if equipped)  
The spotter mirror only can be tilted  
from top to bottom. Move the lower  
mirror manually up/down to increase  
side and rear visibility. Apply  
pressure only in the center of the  
spotter mirror along the top or  
bottom edges to adjust the tilt feature. Do not apply any force on the  
left or right edges of the standard mirror spotter section, as this  
may lead to a mirror fracture.  
66  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Spotter mirror on telescoping  
mirror (if equipped)  
The spotter mirror has a swivel that  
allows it to tilt up and down, and  
also to tilt left and right to increase  
side and rear visibility.  
Fold-away mirrors  
The mirrors can be manually folded forward or backwards for narrow  
spaces like driving through an automatic car wash or backing out of a  
garage with the trailer tow mirror.  
The telescoping feature (if  
equipped) allows the mirror to  
extend approximately 3.15 inches  
(80 mm). This feature is especially  
useful to the driver when towing a  
trailer.  
SPEED CONTROL (IF EQUIPPED)  
With speed control set, you can maintain a set speed without keeping  
your foot on the accelerator pedal.  
67  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
WARNING: Do not use the speed control in heavy traffic or on  
roads that are winding, slippery or unpaved.  
Using speed control  
The speed controls are located on the steering wheel. The following  
buttons work with speed control.  
ON: Press to turn on speed control.  
OFF: Press to turn off speed  
control.  
RES (Resume): Press to resume a  
set speed.  
SET/ACCEL: Press to set a speed  
or increase a set speed.  
COAST: Press to reduce a set speed.  
Setting speed control  
1. Press and release ON.  
2. Accelerate to the desired speed.  
3. Press and release SET/ACCEL.  
4. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal.  
5. The indicator  
light on the instrument cluster will turn on.  
Note:  
Vehicle speed may vary momentarily when driving up and down a  
steep hill.  
If the vehicle speed increases above the set speed on a downhill, you  
may want to apply the brakes to reduce the speed.  
If the vehicle speed decreases more than 10 mph (16 km/h) below  
your set speed on an uphill, your speed control will disengage.  
Disengaging speed control  
To disengage speed control, press the brake pedal. Disengaging speed  
control will not erase the previous set speed.  
Resuming a set speed  
Press and release RES. This will automatically return the vehicle to the  
previously set speed.  
68  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Increasing speed while using speed control  
To increase the set speed:  
Press and hold SET/ACCEL until you get to the desired speed, then  
release. You can also use SET/ACCEL to operate the tap-up function.  
Press and release SET/ACCEL to increase the vehicle set speed in  
1 mph (1.6 km/h) increments.  
Use the accelerator pedal to get to the desired speed. When the  
vehicle reaches that speed, press and release SET/ACCEL.  
Reducing speed while using speed control  
To reduce the set speed:  
Press and hold COAST until you get to the desired speed, then  
release. You can also use COAST to operate the tap-down function.  
Press and release COAST to decrease the vehicle set speed in 1 mph  
(1.6 km/h) increments.  
Press the brake pedal until the desired vehicle speed is reached, then  
press and release SET/ACCEL.  
Turning off speed control  
To turn off the speed control, press OFF or turn off the ignition.  
Note: When you turn off the speed control or the ignition, your speed  
control set speed memory is erased.  
STEERING WHEEL CONTROLS (IF EQUIPPED)  
SYNCsystem hands free  
control feature (if equipped)  
Press  
briefly to use the voice  
command feature. You will hear a  
tone and LISTENING will appear in  
the radio display. Press and  
hold  
to exit voice command.  
Press  
hold  
to activate phone mode or answer a phone call. Press and  
to end a call or exit phone mode.  
For further information on the SYNCsystem, refer to the SYNC௡  
supplement.  
69  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Navigation system/SYNChands  
free control features (if  
equipped)  
Press  
voice  
control briefly until the  
icon appears on the  
Navigation display to use the voice  
command feature.  
Press  
hold  
to activate phone mode or answer a phone call. Press and  
to exit phone mode or end a call.  
For further information on the Navigation system/SYNCsystem, refer to  
the Navigation System and SYNCsupplements.  
UPFITTER CONTROLS (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with  
the Upfitter option package which  
will provide four switches, mounted  
in the center of the instrument  
panel, labeled AUX 1, AUX 2, AUX 3  
and AUX 4. These switches will only  
operate while the ignition is in the  
on position, whether the engine is  
running or not. It is, however, recommended that the engine remain  
running to maintain battery charge when using the Upfitter switches for  
extended duration or higher current draws. (This is even more important  
for vehicles with diesel engines since the glow plugs are also draining  
battery power when the ignition key is in the on position.)  
When switched on by the operator they provide 10 amps, 15 amps or  
30 amps of electrical battery power for a variety of personal or  
commercial uses.  
If your vehicle is equipped with this option, a relay/fuse kit will be  
included. This kit contains the required fuses and relays that need to be  
installed into the Power Distribution Box located under the hood. Refer  
to the instruction sketch included in the kit and Fuses and Relays in  
the Roadside Emergencies chapter. See your authorized dealer for  
service.  
There will also be one power lead for each switch found as a blunt-cut  
and sealed wire located in the underhood cowl shield above the engine  
block PCM.  
70  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
They are coded as follows:  
Switch Circuit number  
AUX 1  
Wire color  
Yellow  
Fuse  
30A  
30A  
CAC05  
CAC06  
AUX 2  
AUX 3  
AUX 4  
Green with  
Brown Trace  
Violet with  
Green Trace  
Brown  
CAC07  
10A  
CAC08  
15A  
More detailed information about Upfitter switches can be found at  
https://www.fleet.ford.com/truckbbas/.  
71  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
KEYS  
The key operates all locks on your vehicle. You should always carry a  
second key with you in a safe place in case you require it in an  
emergency.  
If your vehicle is equipped with the SecuriLockPassive Anti-theft  
system, your keys are electronically coded to your vehicle; using a  
non-coded key will not permit your vehicle to start. If you lose your  
dealer supplied keys, replacement keys are available through your  
authorized dealer.  
POWER DOOR LOCKS (IF EQUIPPED)  
Press control to unlock all doors.  
Press control to lock all doors.  
Memory lock  
If you lock your doors with the power lock switch or the remote  
transmitter while the sliding door is open, the door will automatically  
lock after it is closed.  
Autolock feature  
Note: Your vehicle comes with the autolock feature disabled.  
The autolock feature will lock all the doors when:  
all the doors are closed,  
the ignition is in the on position,  
you shift into any gear putting the vehicle in motion, and  
the vehicle attains a speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h) for greater  
than two seconds.  
72  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
The autolock feature repeats when:  
any door is opened then closed while the ignition is in the on position  
and the vehicle speed is 9 mph (15 km/h) or lower, and  
the vehicle then attains a speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h) for  
greater than two seconds.  
Deactivating/activating autolock feature  
Your vehicle comes with the autolock feature disabled; there are three  
methods to enable/disable this feature:  
Through your authorized dealer, or  
by using a power door unlock/lock procedure, or  
by using the instrument cluster message center (if equipped). Refer to  
Message center in the Instrument Cluster chapter.  
Note: The autolock feature can be activated/deactivated independently  
of the autounlock feature.  
Power door lock switch autolock enable/disable procedure  
Before starting, ensure the ignition is in the off position and all vehicle  
doors are closed. You must complete Steps 1–5 within 30 seconds or the  
procedure will have to be repeated. If the procedure needs to be  
repeated, wait a minimum of 30 seconds before beginning again.  
1. Place the key in the ignition and turn the ignition to the on position.  
2. Press the power door unlock  
control on the door panel three  
times.  
3. Turn the ignition from the on  
position to the off position.  
4. Press the power door unlock  
control on the door panel three  
times.  
5. Turn the ignition back to the on position. The horn will chirp one time  
to confirm programming mode has been entered and is active.  
6. To enable/disable the autolock feature, press the unlock control, then  
press the lock control. The horn will chirp once if autolock was  
deactivated or twice (one short and one long chirp) if autolock was  
activated.  
7. Turn the ignition to the off position. The horn will chirp once to  
confirm the procedure is complete.  
73  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
Autounlock feature  
The autounlock feature will unlock all the doors when:  
the ignition is on, all the doors are closed, and the vehicle has been in  
motion at a speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h);  
the vehicle has then come to a stop and the ignition is turned off or to  
accessory; and  
the driver door is opened within 10 minutes of the ignition being  
turned off or to accessory.  
Note: The doors will not autounlock if the vehicle has been  
electronically locked before the driver door is opened.  
Deactivating/activating autounlock feature  
Your vehicle comes with the autounlock features disabled; there are  
three methods to enable/disable this feature:  
Through your authorized dealer, or  
by using a power door unlock/lock sequence, or  
by using the instrument cluster message center (if equipped). Refer to  
Message center in the Instrument Cluster chapter.  
Note: The autounlock feature can be activated/deactivated  
independently of the autolock feature.  
Power door lock switch autounlock enable/disable procedure  
Before starting, ensure the ignition is off and all vehicle doors are closed.  
You must complete Steps 1–5 within 30 seconds or the procedure will  
have to be repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait a  
minimum of 30 seconds before beginning again.  
1. Turn the ignition on.  
2. Press the power door unlock  
control on the door panel three  
times.  
3. Turn the ignition off.  
4. Press the power door unlock  
control on the door panel three  
times.  
5. Turn the ignition back on. The horn will chirp one time to confirm  
programming mode has been entered and is active.  
74  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
6. To enable/disable the autounlock feature, press the lock control, then  
press the unlock control. The horn will chirp once if autounlock was  
deactivated or twice (one short and one long chirp) if autounlock was  
activated.  
7. Turn the ignition off. The horn will chirp once to confirm the  
procedure is complete.  
Back cargo door lock (if equipped)  
The passenger side rear cargo door  
has a power door lock control  
mounted on the inside of the door.  
When this lock is pressed, all doors  
will lock/unlock.  
E-Guard Cargo Protection System™ (if equipped)  
The E-Guard Cargo Protection System™ insures that the side and cargo  
doors are double locked for extra security.  
E-Guard Cargo Protection System™ features  
The E-Guard Cargo Protection System™ is available with either power  
or manual door locks.  
The E-Guard Cargo Protection System™ provides extra security via a  
double-locked design.  
The cargo doors can only be unlocked from the outside by using the  
keys.  
The power unlock feature (if equipped with power door locks) will  
only unlock the front doors.  
The E-Guard Cargo Protection System™ is equipped with an  
emergency unlock handle installed in the door inner panel.  
E-Guard Cargo Protection System™ procedure  
For vehicles equipped with power door locks:  
Lock the vehicle with the key, manual door lock, key fob or use the  
power door lock on the front door trim panel. The front doors are  
locked and the cargo doors are double-locked.  
75  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
Unlock the vehicle with the key fob or use the power door lock on the  
front door. The front doors are unlocked and the cargo doors remain  
double-locked.  
The only way to unlock the side or back cargo doors from  
outside vehicle is with the key.  
For vehicles equipped with manual door locks:  
The front door locks can be locked by using either the key or the  
manual door lock.  
In order to activate the E-Guard Cargo Protection System™, use the  
key or the manual door lock to lock the side and back cargo doors.  
The cargo doors cannot be unlocked using the manual door  
lock.  
WARNING: If equipped with E-Guard Cargo Protection  
System™ occupants may become trapped in the cargo area  
unless the exit procedure is followed. The cargo doors cannot be  
unlocked using manual or power door locks or key fob. In an  
emergency, to exit the cargo area, locate the emergency handle in the  
rear door or side door, pull the emergency handle to unlock the door,  
then unlatch the door using the inside release handle.  
Emergency lock release  
The emergency handle in the door trim panel unlocks the E-Guard Cargo  
Protection System™.  
The emergency handles are located in the following areas:  
The side door emergency handle  
is located on the door inner trim  
panel in the speaker cup.  
76  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
The rear door handle is located in  
the rear door below the glass.  
To open the side or back cargo doors from the inside:  
1. Unlock the E-Guard Cargo Protection System™ using the emergency  
handle.  
2. Unlatch the door using the inside release handle.  
REMOTE ENTRY SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC rules and with RSS-210 of  
Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) This device  
must accept any interference received, including interference that may  
cause undesired operation.  
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party  
responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to  
operate the equipment.  
The typical operating range for your remote entry transmitter is  
approximately 33 feet (10 meters). A decrease in operating range could  
be caused by:  
weather conditions,  
nearby radio towers,  
structures around the vehicle, or  
other vehicles parked next to your vehicle.  
77  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
The remote entry system allows you  
to lock or unlock all vehicle doors  
without a key.  
Note: The lock and unlock features  
work when the ignition is in any  
position. The panic feature is active  
when the ignition is in either the  
accessory, off or on positions.  
If there are problems with the  
remote entry system, make sure to  
take ALL remote entry transmitters with you to the authorized dealer  
in order to aid in troubleshooting the problem.  
Note: If the vehicle is equipped with the E-Guard Cargo Protection  
System™ the remote transmitter Unlock command will only unlock the  
front doors; the only way to unlock the side or rear cargo doors from  
outside the vehicle is with the key.  
Two step door unlocking  
1. Press  
and release to unlock the driver’s door. Note: The interior  
lamps will illuminate if the control on the overhead lamp is not set to  
the off position.  
2. Press  
and release again within three seconds to unlock the  
passenger doors and the rear cargo doors.  
The battery saver feature will turn off the interior lamp 10 minutes after  
the ignition is turned to the off position.  
One step door unlocking  
If the one step door unlocking feature is activated, press  
and release  
once to unlock the passenger doors and the rear cargo doors. Note: The  
interior lamps will illuminate (refer to the Illuminated entry feature  
later in this section), if the control on the overhead lamp is not set to  
the off position.  
Switching from two step to one step door unlocking  
Your vehicle comes with two step unlocking enabled. With the vehicle  
locked, unlocking can be switched between two step and one step door  
unlocking by pressing and holding both the  
and  
buttons  
simultaneously on the remote entry transmitter for approximately four  
seconds and release. The park lamps will flash twice to indicate that the  
78  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
vehicle has switched to one step unlocking. Repeat the procedure to  
switch back to two-step unlocking.  
Locking the doors  
1. Press  
and release to lock all the doors. If all doors are closed the  
parking lamps illuminate.  
2. Press  
and release again within three seconds to confirm that all  
the doors are closed and locked. Note: The doors will lock again, the  
turn lamps will flash and the horn will chirp once. If any door is ajar the  
lamps will not flash and the horn will chirp twice.  
Car finder  
Press  
twice within three seconds. The horn will chirp and the turn  
lamps will flash. It is recommended that this method be used to locate  
your vehicle, rather than using the panic alarm.  
Sounding a panic alarm  
Press  
to activate the alarm. Press the control again, or turn the  
ignition to the accessory or on position to deactivate the alarm.  
Note: The panic alarm will only operate when the ignition is in the off  
position.  
Replacing the battery  
The remote entry transmitter uses one coin type three-volt lithium  
battery CR2032 or equivalent.  
To replace the battery:  
1. Twist a thin coin between the two  
halves of the remote entry  
transmitter near the key ring. DO  
NOT TAKE THE RUBBER COVER  
AND CIRCUIT BOARD OFF THE  
FRONT HOUSING OF THE  
REMOTE ENTRY TRANSMITTER.  
79  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
2. Do not wipe off any grease on the  
battery terminals on the back  
surface of the circuit board.  
3. Remove the old battery.  
Note: Please refer to local  
regulations when disposing of  
transmitter batteries.  
4. Insert the new battery. Refer to  
the diagram inside the remote entry  
transmitter for the correct  
orientation of the battery. Press the battery down to ensure that the  
battery is fully seated in the battery housing cavity.  
5. Snap the two halves back together.  
Note: Replacement of the battery will not cause the remote transmitter  
to become deprogrammed from your vehicle. The remote transmitter  
should operate normally after battery replacement.  
Replacing lost remote entry transmitters  
If you would like to have your remote entry transmitter reprogrammed  
because you lost one, or would like to buy additional remote entry  
transmitters, you can either reprogram them yourself, or take all  
remote entry transmitters to your authorized dealer for  
reprogramming.  
How to reprogram your remote entry transmitters  
You must have all remote entry transmitters (maximum of four)  
available before beginning this procedure. If all remote entry transmitters  
are not present during programming procedure, the ones missing during  
programming will no longer operate the vehicle.  
Note: Ensure the brake pedal is not  
4
depressed during this sequence.  
3
To reprogram the remote entry  
transmitters:  
5
2
1. Ensure the vehicle is  
electronically unlocked.  
2. Place the key in the ignition and  
1
turn from the 2 (lock) position to 3  
(off).  
80  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
3. Cycle eight times rapidly (within 10 seconds) between the 3 (off)  
position and 4 (on). Note: The eighth turn must end in the 4 (on)  
position.  
4. The doors will lock, then unlock, to confirm that the programming  
mode has been activated.  
5. Within 20 seconds press any button on the remote entry transmitter.  
Note: If more than 20 seconds have passed you will need to start the  
procedure over again.  
6. The doors will lock, then unlock, to confirm that this remote entry  
transmitter has been programmed.  
7. Repeat step 5 to program each additional remote entry transmitter  
(up to four transmitters).  
8. Turn the ignition to the 3 (off) position after you have finished  
programming all of the remote entry transmitters.  
9. The doors will lock, then unlock, to confirm that the programming  
mode has been exited.  
Illuminated entry  
The interior lamps and parking lamps illuminate when the remote entry  
system is used to unlock the door(s) or sound the personal alarm.  
The illuminated entry system will turn off the lights if:  
the ignition switch is turned to the on or accessory position, or  
the remote transmitter lock control is pressed, or  
after 25 seconds of illumination.  
The dome lamp control (if equipped) must not be set to the off position  
for the illuminated entry system to operate.  
The lights will not turn off if:  
they have been turned on with the dimmer control, or  
any door is open.  
SECURILOCKPASSIVE ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
SecuriLockpassive anti-theft system is an engine immobilization  
system. This system is designed to help prevent the engine from being  
started unless a coded key programmed to your vehicle is used. The  
use of the wrong type of coded key may lead to a “no-start” condition.  
Your vehicle comes with two coded keys; additional coded keys may be  
purchased from your authorized dealer. The authorized dealer can  
81  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
program your spare keys to your vehicle or you can program the keys  
yourself. Refer to Programming spare keys for instructions on how to  
program the coded key.  
Note: The SecuriLockpassive anti-theft system is not compatible with  
non-Ford aftermarket remote start systems. Use of these systems may  
result in vehicle starting problems and a loss of security protection.  
Note: Large metallic objects, electronic devices that are used to  
purchase gasoline or similar items, or a second coded key on the same  
key chain may cause vehicle starting issues. You need to prevent these  
objects from touching the coded key while starting the engine. These  
objects will not cause damage to the coded key, but may cause a  
momentary issue if they are too close to the key when starting the  
engine. If a problem occurs, turn the ignition off, remove all objects on  
the key chain away from the coded key and restart the engine.  
Note: Do not leave a duplicate coded key in the vehicle. Always  
take your keys and lock all doors when leaving the vehicle.  
Anti-theft indicator  
The anti-theft indicator is located in the instrument cluster.  
Vehicles equipped with the  
SecuriLockPassive Anti-theft  
system behave as follows:  
When the ignition is in the off  
position, the indicator will flash once every two seconds for a total of  
10 seconds to indicate the SecuriLocksystem is functioning as a  
theft deterrent.  
When the ignition is in the on position, the indicator will glow for  
three seconds to indicate a programmed key has been validated and  
the SecuriLockPassive Anti-theft system has enabled the engine.  
Vehicles without the SecuriLockPassive Anti-theft system behave as  
follows:  
When the ignition is in the off position, the indicator will not flash.  
When the ignition is in the on position, the indicator will glow for  
three seconds to indicate the engine is enabled.  
Automatic arming  
The vehicle is armed immediately after switching the ignition to the off  
position.  
Automatic disarming  
Switching the ignition to the on position with a coded key disarms the  
vehicle.  
82  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
Replacement keys  
If your keys are lost or stolen and you don’t have an extra coded key,  
you will need to have your vehicle towed to an authorized dealer. The  
key codes need to be erased from your vehicle and new coded keys will  
need to be programmed.  
Replacing coded keys can be very costly. Store an extra programmed key  
away from the vehicle in a safe place to help prevent any  
inconveniences. Please visit an authorized dealer to purchase additional  
spare or replacement keys.  
Programming spare keys  
A maximum of eight keys can be coded to your vehicle. Only  
SecuriLockkeys can be used. To program a coded key yourself, you  
will need two previously programmed coded keys (keys that already  
operate your vehicle’s engine) and the new unprogrammed key(s) readily  
accessible for timely implementation of each step in the procedure.  
If two previously programmed coded keys are not available, you must  
bring your vehicle to your authorized dealer to have the spare coded  
key(s) programmed.  
Please read and understand the entire procedure before you begin.  
1. Insert the first previously  
4
programmed coded key into the  
ignition and turn the ignition from  
3
5
the 3 (off) position to the 4 (on)  
position (maintain ignition in the 4  
(on) position for at least one  
second, but no more than  
10 seconds).  
2
1
2. Turn ignition from the 4 (on)  
position back to the 3 (off) position  
in order to remove the first coded key from the ignition.  
3. After three seconds but within 10 seconds of removing the first coded  
key, insert the second previously programmed coded key into the  
ignition and turn the ignition from the 3 (off) position to the 4 (on)  
position (maintain ignition in the 4 (on) position for at least one second  
but no more than 10 seconds).  
83  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
4. Turn the ignition from the 4 (on) position back to the 3 (off) position  
in order to remove the second coded key from the ignition.  
5. After three seconds but within 10 seconds of removing the second  
coded key, insert the new unprogrammed key (new key/valet key) into  
the ignition and turn the ignition from the 3 (off) position to the 4 (on)  
position (maintain ignition in the 4 (on) position for at least one second,  
but no more than 10 seconds). This step will program your new key to a  
coded key.  
6. To program additional new unprogrammed key(s), repeat Steps 1  
through 5.  
If successful, the new coded key(s) will start the vehicle’s engine and the  
theft indicator will illuminate for three seconds and then go out.  
If not successful, the new coded key(s) will not start the vehicle’s engine  
and the theft indicator will flash on and off and you may repeat Steps 1  
through 5. If failure repeats, bring your vehicle to your authorized dealer  
to have the new spare key(s) programmed.  
84  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
SEATING  
WARNING: Reclining the seatback can cause an occupant to  
slide under the seat’s safety belt, resulting in severe personal  
injuries in the event of a collision.  
WARNING: Do not pile cargo higher than the seatbacks to  
reduce the risk of injury in a collision or sudden stop.  
WARNING: Before returning the seatback to its original  
position, make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped  
behind the seatback. After returning the seatback to its original  
position, pull on the seatback to ensure that it has fully latched. An  
unlatched seat may become dangerous in the event of a sudden stop or  
collision.  
Non-adjustable head restraints  
Your vehicle is equipped with front row outboard non-adjustable head  
restraints.  
WARNING: To minimize the risk of neck injury in the event of a  
crash, the driver and passenger occupants should not sit in  
and/or operate the vehicle, until the seatback is placed in its proper  
position. The driver should never adjust the seatback while the vehicle  
is in motion.  
The non-adjustable head restraints  
consist of a trimmed foam covering  
over the upper structure of the  
seatback.  
Properly adjust the seatback to an upright driving/riding position, so that  
the head restraint is positioned as close as possible to the back of your  
head.  
85  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Adjusting the front manual seat (if equipped)  
WARNING: Never adjust the driver’s seat or seatback when the  
vehicle is moving.  
WARNING: Always drive and ride with your seatback upright  
and the lap belt snug and low across the hips.  
Lift handle to move seat forward or  
backward.  
Pull lever up to adjust seatback.  
WARNING: Before  
returning the seatback to its  
original position, make sure that  
cargo or any objects are not  
trapped behind the seatback. After  
returning the seatback to its  
original position, pull on the  
seatback to ensure that it has fully  
latched. An unlatched seat may  
become dangerous in the event of  
a sudden stop or collision.  
86  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Using the manual lumbar support (if equipped)  
The lumbar support control is  
located on the inboard side of the  
driver’s seat.  
Turn the lumbar support control  
clockwise to increase firmness.  
Turn the lumbar support control  
counterclockwise to increase  
softness.  
Adjusting the front power seat (if equipped)  
The control is located on the outboard side of the seat cushion.  
Press to raise or lower the front  
portion of the seat cushion.  
Press to raise or lower the rear  
portion of the seat cushion.  
87  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Press the control to move the seat  
forward, backward, up or down.  
REAR SEATS  
Rear captains chair adjust — passenger side only  
Pull the lever to adjust the seat  
forward or backward.  
88  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Quick-release captains chair  
(7 passenger configuration- second row only)  
To remove the seat:  
1. Disengage the lap/shoulder belt  
from the seat by inserting a key or  
small screwdriver into the slot in the  
detachable anchor and lifting  
upward.  
2. Pull the seat latch handle, then  
pull the seat toward the right side of  
the vehicle to disengage four pins  
from the floor mount.  
3. Remove the seat.  
To install the seat:  
WARNING: Check to see that the seat and seatback is latched  
securely in position. Keep floor area free of objects that would  
prevent proper seat engagement. Never attempt to adjust the seat  
while the vehicle is in motion.  
WARNING: Ensure that the seat is latched to the vehicle floor  
by pushing/pulling on the seat. If not latched, the seat may cause  
injury during a sudden stop.  
89  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
1. Position the seat to the floor  
mount.  
2. Pull the seat latch handle downward to lock the seat in position.  
3. Make sure the safety belt is not twisted, then insert the safety belt  
tongue into detachable anchor until you hear a “click” and feel the latch  
engage.  
Rear bench seat  
To remove the seats:  
1. Disengage the lap/shoulder belt  
from the seat by inserting a key or  
small screwdriver into the slot in the  
detachable anchor and lifting  
upward (2nd row passenger side  
only).  
90  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
2. Find the clips attached near the  
ends of the lap/shoulder belts.  
3. Clip the end of the belt to the  
stationary portion of the shoulder  
belt coming out of the trim panel.  
The end of the shoulder belt must  
be clipped in order to keep it from  
striking anything during vehicle  
operation.  
91  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
4. With assistance, pull the LH/RH seat latch release straps (1) (located  
behind the latch mechanisms) to release the latch from the rear strikers.  
5. Lift the rear end of seat upward and rearward by pushing on the  
seatback (2) and lifting the seat cushion (3) to disengage the front seat  
hook and the rear seat latch from the striker.  
6. With assistance, remove the seat assembly.  
To remove the 3rd, 4th, and 5th row seats (if equipped), repeat  
Steps 1 through 6.  
To install the seat:  
WARNING: Ensure that the seat is installed or removed from  
the striker pins with adequate ergonomic assistance. Due to the  
weight of the seat, it must be handled by at least two adults during  
installation or removal from the vehicle.  
WARNING: Ensure that the seat is latched to the vehicle floor  
by pushing/pulling on the seat or seatback (2). If not latched,  
the seat may cause injury during a sudden stop.  
1. Please make sure the floor striker area is clean of any debris that  
would prevent the seat from latching.  
2. With assistance, position the seat in the vehicle.  
3. Align the front hooks to the LH/RH front striker pins prior to lowering  
the rear latch mechanism and aligning them with the rear striker pins.  
92  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
4. Engage the front LH/RH hooks to the LH/RH front striker pins.  
5. After the front LH/RH hooks are engaged to the LH/RH front striker  
pins, pull LH/RH seat latch release straps to allow engagement of the  
latch to the striker pins. Refer to the illustration in To remove the rear  
seats above.  
6. Pull/push seat back forward/backward to check for proper seat  
installation.  
WARNING: Always latch the vehicle seat to the floor, whether  
the seat is occupied or empty. If not latched, the seat may cause  
injury during a sudden stop.  
WARNING: Do not hang or attach any cargo to the release  
straps of the rear bench seats. Doing so could cause the release  
straps to inadvertently unlatch the rear bench seat. If not latched, the  
seat may cause serious injury during a sudden stop.  
SAFETY RESTRAINTS  
Safety restraints precautions  
WARNING: Always drive and ride with your seatback upright  
and the lap belt snug and low across the hips.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of injury, make sure children sit  
in a rear seating position where they can be properly restrained.  
WARNING: Never let a passenger hold a child on his or her lap  
while the vehicle is moving. The passenger cannot protect the  
child from injury in a collision.  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle, including the driver,  
should always properly wear their safety belts, even when an  
airbag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is provided.  
93  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,  
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in  
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured or killed. Do not  
allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped  
with seats and safety belts. Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a  
seat and using a safety belt properly.  
WARNING: In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is  
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a safety  
belt.  
WARNING: Each seating position in your vehicle has a specific  
safety belt assembly which is made up of one buckle and one  
tongue that are designed to be used as a pair. 1) Use the shoulder belt  
on the outside shoulder only. Never wear the shoulder belt under the  
arm. 2) Never swing the safety belt around your neck over the inside  
shoulder. 3) Never use a single belt for more than one person.  
WARNING: When possible, all children 12 years old and under  
should be properly restrained in a rear seating position.  
WARNING: Safety belts and seats can become hot in a vehicle  
that has been closed up in sunny weather; they could burn a  
small child. Check seat covers and buckles before you place a child  
anywhere near them.  
WARNING: Front and rear seat occupants, including pregnant  
women, should wear safety belts for optimum protection in an  
accident.  
Combination lap and shoulder belts  
1. Insert the belt tongue into the proper buckle (the buckle closest to  
the direction the tongue is coming from) until you hear a snap and feel it  
latch. Make sure the tongue is securely fastened in the buckle.  
94  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Front and rear seats  
2. To unfasten, push the release button and remove the tongue from the  
buckle.  
Front and rear seats  
All safety restraints in the vehicle are combination lap and shoulder  
belts. All of the passenger combination lap and shoulder belts have three  
types of locking modes described below:  
Vehicle sensitive mode  
This is the normal retractor mode, which allows free shoulder belt length  
adjustment to your movements and locking in response to vehicle  
movement. For example, if the driver brakes suddenly or turns a corner  
sharply, or the vehicle receives an impact of approximately 5 mph  
(8 km/h) or more, the combination safety belts will lock to help reduce  
forward movement of the driver and passengers.  
Automatic locking mode  
When to use the automatic locking mode  
In this mode, the shoulder belt is automatically pre-locked. The belt will  
still retract to remove any slack in the shoulder belt. The automatic  
locking mode is not available on the driver safety belt.  
This mode should be used any time a child safety seat, except a  
booster, is installed in passenger front or rear seating position (if  
95  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
equipped). Children 12 years old and under should be properly  
restrained in a rear seating position whenever possible. Refer to Safety  
restraints for children or Safety seats for children later in this chapter.  
How to use the automatic locking mode  
Buckle the combination lap and  
shoulder belt.  
Grasp the shoulder portion and  
pull downward until the entire  
belt is pulled out.  
Allow the belt to retract. As the belt retracts, you will hear a clicking  
sound. This indicates the safety belt is now in the automatic locking  
mode.  
How to disengage the automatic locking mode  
Disconnect the combination lap/shoulder belt and allow it to retract  
completely to disengage the automatic locking mode and activate the  
vehicle sensitive (emergency) locking mode.  
WARNING: After any vehicle collision, the safety belt systems  
at all seating positions (except the driver position, which does  
not have this feature) must be checked by an authorized dealer to  
verify that the automatic locking retractor feature for child seats is still  
functioning properly. In addition, all safety belts should be checked for  
proper function.  
96  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: BELT AND RETRACTOR ASSEMBLY MUST BE  
REPLACED if the safety belt assembly “automatic locking  
retractor” feature or any other safety belt function is not operating  
properly when checked by an authorized dealer. Failure to replace the  
Belt and Retractor assembly could increase the risk of injury in  
collisions.  
Safety belt pretensioner  
Your vehicle is equipped with safety belt pretensioners at the driver and  
front outboard passenger seating positions.  
The safety belt pretensioner tightens the safety belts firmly against the  
occupant’s body at the start of the crash.  
WARNING: The driver and front passenger safety belt system  
(including retractors, buckles and height adjusters) must be  
replaced if the vehicle is involved in a collision that results in  
deployment of front airbags and safety belt pretensioners.  
Front safety belt height adjustment  
The front seat and outboard  
positions are equipped with a height  
adjuster. Adjust the height of the  
shoulder belt so the belt rests  
across the middle of your shoulder.  
To adjust the shoulder belt height,  
push the button and slide the height  
adjuster down. Release the button  
and pull down on the height  
adjuster to make sure it is locked in  
place. To adjust the belt upward,  
slide the adjuster up. Pull down on the height adjuster to make sure it is  
locked in place.  
WARNING: Position the safety belt height adjusters so that the  
belt rests across the middle of your shoulder. Failure to adjust  
the safety belt properly could reduce the effectiveness of the seat belt  
and increase the risk of injury in a collision.  
97  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Safety belt warning light and indicator chime  
The safety belt warning light illuminates in the instrument cluster and a  
chime sounds to remind the occupants to fasten their safety belts.  
Conditions of operation  
If...  
Then...  
The driver’s safety belt is not  
buckled before the ignition  
switch is turned to the on  
position...  
The safety belt warning light  
illuminates and the warning chime  
sounds 4-8 seconds.  
The driver’s safety belt is  
buckled while the indicator  
light is illuminated and the  
warning chime is sounding...  
The driver’s safety belt is  
buckled before the ignition  
switch is turned to the on  
position...  
The safety belt warning light and  
warning chime turn off.  
The safety belt warning light and the  
warning chime will remain off.  
Belt-Minderா  
The Belt-Minderfeature is a supplemental warning to the safety belt  
warning function. This feature provides additional reminders to the  
driver that the driver’s safety belt is unbuckled by intermittently  
sounding a chime and illuminating the safety belt warning lamp in the  
instrument cluster.  
98  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
If...  
Then...  
The driver’s safety belt is not  
buckled approximately  
The Belt-Minderfeature is activated  
- the safety belt warning light  
5 seconds after the safety belt illuminates and the warning chime  
warning light has turned off...  
sounds for 6 seconds every  
30 seconds, repeating for  
approximately 5 minutes or until  
safety belt is buckled.  
The driver’s safety belt is  
buckled while the safety belt  
indicator light is illuminated  
and the safety belt warning  
chime is sounding...  
The Belt-Minderfeature will not  
activate.  
The driver’s safety belt is  
buckled before the ignition  
switch is turned to the ON  
position...  
The Belt-Minderfeature will not  
activate.  
The following are reasons most often given for not wearing safety belts:  
(All statistics based on U.S. data)  
Reasons given...  
Consider...  
“Crashes are rare events”  
36700 crashes occur every day. The  
more we drive, the more we are  
exposed to “rare” events, even for  
good drivers. 1 in 4 of us will be  
seriously injured in a crash during  
our lifetime.  
“I’m not going far”  
3 of 4 fatal crashes occur within 25  
miles of home.  
“Belts are uncomfortable”  
We design our safety belts to enhance  
comfort. If you are uncomfortable -  
try different positions for the safety  
belt upper anchorage and seatback  
which should be as upright as  
possible; this can improve comfort.  
99  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Reasons given...  
Consider...  
“I was in a hurry”  
Prime time for an accident.  
Belt-Minderreminds us to take a few  
seconds to buckle up.  
“Safety belts don’t work”  
Safety belts, when used properly,  
reduce risk of death to front seat  
occupants by 45% in cars, and by  
60% in light trucks.  
“Traffic is light”  
Nearly 1 of 2 deaths occur in  
single-vehicle crashes, many when  
no other vehicles are around.  
Possibly, but a serious crash can do  
much more than wrinkle your clothes,  
particularly if you are unbelted.  
Set the example, teen deaths occur 4  
times more often in vehicles with  
TWO or MORE people. Children and  
younger brothers/sisters imitate  
behavior they see.  
“Belts wrinkle my clothes”  
“The people I’m with don’t  
wear belts”  
“I have an airbag”  
Airbags offer greater protection when  
used with safety belts. Frontal airbags  
are not designed to inflate in rear and  
side crashes or rollovers.  
“I’d rather be thrown clear”  
People who are ejected are 40  
times more likely to DIE. Safety  
belts help prevent ejection, WE CAN’T  
“PICK OUR CRASH”.  
WARNING: Do not sit on top of a buckled safety belt or insert a  
latchplate into the buckle to avoid the Belt-Minderchime. To  
do so may adversely affect the performance of the vehicle’s air bag  
system  
One-time disable  
Any time the safety belt is buckled and then unbuckled during an  
ignition on cycle, the Belt-Minderwill be disabled for that ignition cycle  
only.  
100  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Deactivating/activating the Belt-Minderfeature  
Read Steps 1 - 5 thoroughly before proceeding with the  
deactivation/activation programming procedure.  
The Belt-Minderfeature can be deactivated/activated by performing the  
following procedure:  
Before following the procedure, make sure that:  
the parking brake is set  
the gearshift is in P (Park)  
the ignition switch is in the off position  
all vehicle doors and the hood are closed  
the driver’s safety belt is unbuckled  
the parklamps/headlamps are in the off position  
WARNING: While the design allows you to deactivate your  
Belt-Minder, this system is designed to improve your chances of  
being safely belted and surviving an accident. We recommend you  
leave the Belt-Mindersystem activated for yourself and others who  
may use the vehicle. To reduce the risk of injury, do not  
deactivate/activate the Belt-Minderfeature while driving the vehicle.  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. DO NOT START THE  
ENGINE.  
2. Wait until the safety belt warning light turns off (Approximately one  
minute).  
Step 3 must be completed within 30 seconds after the safety belt  
warning light turns off.  
3. Buckle then unbuckle the safety belt three times at a moderate speed,  
ending with the safety belt in the unbuckled state.  
After Step 3 is complete, the safety belt warning light will be turned  
on for three seconds.  
Belt-Minderwill automatically exit programming mode without  
changing its enable status if Step 4 does not occur within 10 seconds  
of the end of Step 3.  
4. Within approximately seven seconds of the light turning off, buckle  
then unbuckle the safety belt.  
This will disable the Belt-Minderfeature for that seating position if it  
is currently enabled. As confirmation, the safety belt warning light will  
flash four times per second for three seconds.  
101  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
This will enable the Belt-Minderfeature for that seating position if it  
is currently disabled. As confirmation, the safety belt warning light will  
flash four times per second for three seconds, followed by three  
seconds with the light off, then followed by the safety belt warning  
light flashing four times per second for three seconds again.  
5. After receiving confirmation, the deactivation/activation procedure is  
complete.  
Safety belt extension assembly  
If the safety belt is too short when fully extended, there is a 9 inch  
(23 cm) or 12 inch (31 cm) safety belt extension assembly that can be  
added (part number 611C22). This assembly can be obtained from an  
authorized dealer.  
Use only extensions manufactured by the same supplier as the safety  
belt. Manufacturer identification is located at the end of the webbing on  
the label. Also, use the safety belt extension only if the safety belt is too  
short for you when fully extended.  
Use the shortest extender assembly that will provide adequate fit.  
WARNING: Do not use extensions to change the fit of the  
shoulder belt across the torso.  
AIRBAG SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS)  
102  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Important SRS precautions  
The SRS is designed to work with  
the safety belt to help protect the  
driver and right front passenger  
from certain upper body injuries.  
Airbags DO NOT inflate slowly;  
there is a risk of injury from a  
deploying airbag.  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle, including the driver,  
should always properly wear their safety belts, even when an air  
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is provided.  
WARNING: Always transport children 12 years old and under in  
a rear seating position, and always properly use appropriate child  
restraints. Never place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active  
airbag. If you must transport a forward-facing child in the front seat,  
move the seat all the way back and use appropriate restraints.  
WARNING: National Highway Traffic Safety Administration  
(NHTSA) recommends a minimum distance of at least 10 inches  
(25 cm) between an occupant’s chest and the driver airbag module.  
WARNING: Never place your arm over the air bag module as a  
deploying air bag can result in serious arm fractures or other  
injuries.  
To properly position yourself away from the airbag:  
Move your seat to the rear as far as you can while still reaching the  
pedals comfortably.  
Recline the seat slightly one or two degrees from the upright position.  
103  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Do not put anything on or over the air bag module.  
Placing objects on or over the air bag inflation area may cause  
those objects to be propelled by the air bag into your face and torso  
causing serious injury.  
WARNING: Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the  
airbag supplemental restraint systems or its fuses. Contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
WARNING: Modifying or adding equipment to the front end of  
the vehicle (including frame, bumper, front end body structure  
and tow hooks) may affect the performance of the airbag system,  
increasing the risk of injury. Do not modify the front end of the  
vehicle.  
WARNING: Additional equipment may affect the performance of  
the airbag sensors increasing the risk of injury.  
Children and airbags  
Children must always be properly  
restrained. Accident statistics  
suggest that children are safer when  
properly restrained in the rear  
seating positions than in the front  
seating position. Failure to follow  
these instructions may increase the  
risk of injury in a collision.  
WARNING: Airbags can kill  
or injure a child in a child  
seat. NEVER place a rear-facing  
child seat in front of an active  
airbag. If you must use a  
forward-facing child seat in the  
front seat, move the seat all the  
way back.  
104  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
How does the airbag supplemental restraint system work?  
The airbag SRS is designed to  
activate when the vehicle sustains a  
longitudinal deceleration sufficient  
to cause the airbag sensors to close  
an electrical circuit that initiates  
airbag inflation. The fact that the  
airbags did not inflate in a collision  
does not mean that something is  
wrong with the system. Rather, it  
means the forces were not sufficient  
enough to cause activation. Airbags  
are designed to inflate in frontal and  
near-frontal collisions, not rollover, side-impact, or rear-impacts unless  
the collision causes sufficient longitudinal deceleration.  
The airbags inflate and deflate  
rapidly upon activation. After airbag  
deployment, it is normal to notice a  
smoke-like, powdery residue or  
smell the burnt propellant. This may  
consist of cornstarch, talcum  
powder or sodium compounds which  
may irritate the skin and eyes, but  
none of the residue is toxic.  
While the SRS is designed to help  
reduce serious injuries, contact with  
a deploying airbag may also cause  
abrasions, swelling or temporary  
hearing loss. Because airbags must  
inflate rapidly and with considerable  
force, there is the risk of death or  
serious injuries such as fractures, facial and eye injuries or internal  
injuries, particularly to occupants who are not properly restrained or are  
otherwise out of position at the time of airbag deployment. It is  
extremely important that occupants be properly restrained as far away  
from the airbag module as possible while maintaining vehicle control.  
The SRS consists of:  
driver and passenger airbag modules (which include the inflators and  
airbags)  
one or more impact and safing sensors  
105  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
safety belt pretensioners  
a readiness light and tone  
a diagnostic module  
and the electrical wiring which connects the components  
The diagnostic module monitors its own internal circuits and the  
supplemental airbag electrical system wiring (including the impact  
sensors), the system wiring, the airbag system readiness light, the airbag  
back up power and the airbag ignitors.  
WARNING: Several air bag system components get hot after  
inflation. Do not touch them after inflation.  
WARNING: If the air bag has deployed, the air bag will not  
function again and must be replaced immediately. If the air  
bag is not replaced, the unrepaired area will increase the risk of injury  
in a collision.  
Determining if the system is operational  
The SRS uses a readiness light in the instrument cluster or a tone to  
indicate the condition of the system. Refer to Airbag readiness section  
in the Instrument Cluster chapter. Routine maintenance of the airbag is  
not required.  
A difficulty with the system is indicated by one or more of the following:  
The readiness light will either  
flash or stay lit.  
The readiness light will not  
illuminate immediately after ignition is turned on.  
A series of five beeps will be heard. The tone pattern will repeat  
periodically until the problem and/or light are repaired.  
If any of these things happen, even intermittently, contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible. Unless serviced, the system may  
not function properly in the event of a collision.  
SOS Post-Crash Alert System™  
The system automatically flashes the turn signal lamps and sounds the  
horn three times at four second intervals in the event of a serious impact  
that deploys an airbag (front, side, side curtain or Safety Canopy) or  
the safety belt pretensioners.  
106  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The system can be turned off when any one of the following actions are  
taken by the driver or any other person:  
pressing the hazard control button,  
or pressing the panic button on the remote entry transmitter.  
The feature will continue to operate until the vehicle runs out of power.  
Disposal of airbags and airbag equipped vehicles  
(including pretensioners)  
Contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible. Airbags MUST BE  
disposed of by qualified personnel.  
Passenger airbag ON/OFF switch (if equipped)  
Note: The passenger airbag ON/OFF  
switch (if equipped) may be on  
vehicles with no rear seats and a  
gross vehicle weight rating (GVWR)  
greater than 8500 lb (3856 kg). See  
Vehicle loading – with and  
without a trailer in the Tires,  
Wheels and loading chapter.  
WARNING: An airbag  
ON/OFF switch (if  
equipped) may have been installed  
in this vehicle. Before driving,  
always look at the face of the  
switch to be sure the switch is in  
the proper position in accordance  
with these instructions and  
warnings. Failure to put the  
switch in a proper position can  
increase the risk of serious injury  
or death in a collision.  
107  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Turning the passenger airbag off  
1. Insert the ignition key, turn the  
switch to OFF position and hold in  
OFF position while removing the  
key.  
2. When the ignition is turned to the  
ON position the OFF light  
illuminates briefly, momentarily  
shuts off and then turns back on.  
This indicates that the passenger  
airbag is deactivated.  
WARNING: If the light fails to illuminate when the passenger air  
bag switch is in the OFF position and the ignition switch is in  
ON, contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
WARNING: In order to avoid inadvertent activation of the  
switch, always remove the ignition key from the passenger air  
bag ON/OFF switch.  
WARNING: An infant in a rear-facing seat faces a high risk of  
serious or fatal injuries from a deploying passenger airbag. Rear  
facing infant seats should NEVER be placed in the front seats, unless  
the passenger airbag is turned off.  
Turning the passenger airbag back on  
The passenger airbag remains OFF until you turn it back ON.  
1. Insert the ignition key and turn  
the switch to ON.  
2. The OFF light will briefly  
illuminate when the ignition is  
turned to On. This indicates that the  
passenger airbag is operational.  
108  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: If the OFF light is illuminated when the passenger  
airbag switch is in the ON position and the ignition switch is in  
ON, have the passenger airbag switch serviced at an authorized dealer  
immediately.  
The passenger side airbag should always be ON (the airbag OFF light  
should not be illuminated) unless the passenger is a person who meets  
the requirements stated either in Category 1, 2 or 3 of the  
NHTSA/Transport Canada deactivation criteria which follows.  
WARNING: The safety belts for the driver and right front  
passenger seating positions have been specifically designed to  
function together with the airbags in certain types of crashes. When  
you turn OFF your airbag, you not only lose the protection of the  
airbag, you also may reduce the effectiveness of your safety belt  
system, which was designed to work with the airbag. If you are not a  
person who meets the requirements stated in the NHTSA/Transport  
Canada deactivation criteria turning OFF the airbag can increase the  
risk of serious injury or death in a collision.  
WARNING: If your vehicle has rear seats, always transport  
children who are 12 and younger in a rear seating position.  
Always use safety belts and child restraints properly. DO NOT place a  
child in a rear facing infant seat in the front seat unless your vehicle is  
equipped with an airbag ON/OFF switch and the passenger airbag is  
turned OFF. This is because the back of the infant seat is too close to  
the inflating airbag and the risk of a fatal injury to the infant when the  
airbag inflates is substantial.  
The vast majority of drivers and passengers are much safer with an  
airbag than without. To do their job and reduce the risk of life  
threatening injuries, airbags must open with great force, and this force  
can pose a potentially deadly risk in some situations, particularly when a  
front seat occupant is not properly buckled up. The most effective way  
to reduce the risk of unnecessary airbag injuries without reducing the  
overall safety of the vehicle is to make sure all occupants are properly  
restrained in the vehicle, especially in the front seat. This provides the  
protection of safety belts and permits the airbags to provide the  
additional protection they were designed to provide. If you choose to  
deactivate your airbag, you are losing the very significant risk reducing  
benefits of the airbag and you are also reducing the effectiveness of the  
109  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
safety belts, because safety belts in modern vehicles are designed to  
work as a safety system with the airbags.  
Read all airbag warning labels in the vehicle as well as the other  
important airbag instructions and warnings in this Owner’s Guide.  
NHTSA deactivation criteria (excluding Canada)  
1. Infant. An infant (less than 1 year old) must ride in the front seat  
because:  
the vehicle has no rear seat;  
the vehicle has a rear seat too small to accommodate a rear-facing  
infant seat; or  
the infant has a medical condition which, according to the infant’s  
physician, makes it necessary for the infant to ride in the front so that  
the driver can constantly monitor the child’s condition.  
2. Child age 1 to 12. A child age 1 to 12 must ride in the front seat  
because:  
the vehicle has no rear seat;  
although children ages 1 to 12 ride in the rear seat(s) whenever  
possible, children ages 1 to 12 sometimes must ride in the front  
because no space is available in the rear seat(s) of the vehicle; or  
the child has a medical condition which, according to the child’s  
physician, makes it necessary for the child to ride in the front seat so  
that the driver can constantly monitor the child’s condition.  
3. Medical condition. A passenger has a medical condition which,  
according to his or her physician:  
causes the passenger airbag to pose a special risk for the passenger;  
and  
makes the potential harm from the passenger airbag in a crash greater  
than the potential harm from turning OFF the airbag and allowing the  
passenger, even if belted, to hit the dashboard or windshield in a  
crash.  
110  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: This vehicle has special energy management safety  
belts for the driver and right front passenger. These particular  
belts are specifically designed to work with airbags to help reduce the  
risk of injury in a collision. The energy management safety belt is  
designed to give or release additional belt webbing in some accidents  
to reduce concentration of force on an occupant’s chest and reduce the  
risk of certain bone fractures and injuries to underlying organs. In a  
crash, if the airbag is turned OFF, this energy management safety belt  
might permit the person wearing the belt to move forward enough to  
incur a serious or fatal injury. The more severe the crash, and the  
heavier the occupant, the greater the risk is. Be sure the airbag is  
turned ON for any person who does not qualify under the NHTSA  
deactivation criteria.  
Transport Canada deactivation criteria (Canada Only)  
1. Infant: An infant (less than 1 year old) must ride in the front seat  
because:  
my vehicle has no rear seat;  
the rear seat in my vehicle cannot accommodate a rear-facing infant  
seat; or  
the infant has a medical condition which, according to the infant’s  
physician, makes it necessary for the infant to ride in the front seat so  
that the driver can monitor the infant’s condition.  
2. Child age 12 or under: A child age 12 or under must ride in the  
front seat because:  
my vehicle has no rear seat;  
although children age 12 and under ride in the rear seat whenever  
possible, children age 12 and under have no option but to sometimes  
ride in the front seat because rear seat space is insufficient; or  
the child has a medical condition that, according to the child’s  
physician, makes it necessary for the child to ride in the front seat so  
that the driver can monitor the child’s condition.  
111  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
3. Medical condition: A passenger has a medical condition that,  
according to his or her physician:  
poses a special risk for the passenger if the airbag deploys; and  
makes the potential harm from the passenger airbag deployment  
greater than the potential harm from turning OFF the airbag and  
experiencing a crash without the protection offered by the airbag  
WARNING: This vehicle has special energy management safety  
belts for the driver and right front passenger. These particular  
belts are specifically designed to work with airbags to help reduce the  
risk of injury in a collision. The energy management safety belt is  
designed to give or release additional belt webbing in some accidents  
to reduce concentration of force on an occupant’s chest and reduce the  
risk of certain bone fractures and injuries to underlying organs. In a  
crash, if the airbag is turned OFF, this energy management safety belt  
might permit the person wearing the belt to move forward enough to  
incur a serious or fatal injury. The more severe the crash, and the  
heavier the occupant, the greater the risk is. Be sure the airbag is  
turned ON for any person who does not qualify under the NHTSA  
deactivation criteria.  
SAFETY RESTRAINTS FOR CHILDREN  
See the following sections for directions on how to properly use safety  
restraints for children. Also see Airbag supplemental restraint system  
(SRS) in this chapter for special instructions about using airbags.  
112  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Important child restraint precautions  
WARNING: Always make sure your child is secured properly in  
a device that is appropriate for their height, age and weight.  
Child safety restraints must be purchased separately from the vehicle.  
Failure to follow these instructions and guidelines may result in an  
increased risk of serious injury or death to your child.  
WARNING: All children are shaped differently. The  
Recommendations for Safety Restraints are based on probable  
child height, age and weight thresholds from NHTSA and other safety  
organizations or are the minimum requirements of law. Ford  
recommends checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger Safety  
Technician (CPST) and consult your pediatrician to make sure your  
child seat is appropriate for your child, and is compatible with and  
properly installed in the vehicle. To locate a child seat fitting station  
and CPST contact the NHTSA toll free at 1-888-327-4236 or on the  
internet at http://www.nhtsa.dot.gov. In Canada, check with your local  
St. John Ambulance office for referral to a CPST or for further  
information, contact your provincial ministry of transportation, your  
local St. John Ambulance office at http://www.sfa.ca, or Transport  
Canada at 1–800–333–0371 (http://www.tc.gc.ca). Failure to properly  
restrain children in safety seats made especially for their height, age,  
and weight may result in an increased risk of serious injury or death to  
your child.  
113  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Recommendations for Safety Restraints for Children  
Recommended re-  
straint type  
Child size, height, weight, or age  
Infants Children weighing 40 lb (18 kg) or less Use a child safety  
or tod- (generally age four or younger)  
dlers  
seat (sometimes  
called an infant car-  
rier, convertible  
seat, or toddler  
seat).  
Small  
chil-  
dren  
Children who have outgrown or no  
Use a belt-  
longer properly fit in a child safety seat positioning booster  
(generally children who are less than  
4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters) tall, are  
greater than age four (4) and less than  
age twelve (12), and between 40 lb  
(18 kg) and 80 lb (36 kg) and upward  
to 100 lb (45 kg) if recommended by  
your child restraint manufacturer)  
seat.  
Larger Children who have outgrown or no  
Use a vehicle safety  
belt having the lap  
chil-  
dren  
longer properly fit in a belt-positioning  
booster seat (generally children who are belt snug and low  
at least 4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters)  
tall or greater than 80 lb (36 kg) or  
across the hips,  
shoulder belt cen-  
100 lb (45 kg) if recommended by child tered across the  
restraint manufacturer)  
shoulder and chest,  
and seatback up-  
right.  
You are required by law to properly use safety seats for infants and  
toddlers in the U.S. and Canada.  
Many states and provinces require that small children use approved  
booster seats until they reach age eight, a height of 4 ft 9 in  
(1.45 meters) tall, or 80 lb (36 kg). Check your local and state or  
provincial laws for specific requirements regarding the safety of  
children in your vehicle.  
When possible, always properly restrain children twelve (12) years of  
age and under in a rear seating position of your vehicle. Accident  
statistics suggest that children are safer when properly restrained in  
the rear seating positions than in a front seating position.  
114  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Recommendations for attaching child safety restraints for children  
Use any attachment method as indicated be-  
low by “X”  
LATCH LATCH Safety Safety  
(lower (lower belt belt and belt  
anchors and  
only) top  
Safety  
Re-  
straint  
Type  
an-  
chors  
and  
LATCH  
(lower  
only  
Child  
Weight  
tether anchors  
anchor and top  
tether  
top  
tether  
an-  
anchor)  
chor)  
Rear fac- Up to  
ing child 48 lb  
X
X
seat  
(21 kg)  
Forward Up to  
facing  
child seat (21 kg)  
Forward Over  
facing  
48 lb  
X
X
X
X
X
48 lb  
child seat (21 kg)  
WARNING: Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat.  
NEVER place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active airbag.  
If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move the  
vehicle seat all the way back. When possible, all children age 12 and  
under should be properly restrained in a rear seating position. If all  
children cannot be seated and restrained properly in a rear seating  
position, properly restrain the largest child in the front seat.  
115  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Always carefully follow the instructions and  
warnings provided by the manufacturer of any child restraint to  
determine if the restraint device is appropriate for your child’s size,  
height, weight, or age. Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s  
instructions and warnings provided for installation and use in  
conjunction with the instructions and warnings provided by the vehicle  
manufacturer. A safety seat that is improperly installed or utilized, is  
inappropriate for your child’s height, age, or weight or does not  
properly fit the child may increase the risk of serious injury or death.  
WARNING: Never let a passenger hold a child on his or her lap  
while the vehicle is moving. The passenger cannot protect the  
child from injury in a collision, which may result in serious injury or  
death.  
WARNING: Never use pillows, books, or towels to boost a child.  
They can slide around and increase the likelihood of injury or  
death in a collision.  
WARNING: Always restrain an unoccupied child seat or booster  
seat. These objects may become projectiles in a collision or  
sudden stop, which may increase the risk of serious injury.  
WARNING: Never place, or allow a child to place, the shoulder  
belt under a child’s arm or behind the back because it reduces  
the protection for the upper part of the body and may increase the risk  
of injury or death in a collision.  
WARNING: Do not leave children, unreliable adults, or pets  
unattended in your vehicle.  
Transporting children  
Always make sure your child is secured properly in a device that is  
appropriate for their age, height and weight. All children are shaped  
differently. The child height, age and weight thresholds provided are  
recommendations or the minimum requirements of law. The National  
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) provides education and  
116  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
training to ensure that all children ages 0 to 16 are properly restrained in  
the correct restraint system. Ford recommends checking with a NHTSA  
Certified Child Passenger Safety Technician (CPST) and your  
pediatrician to make sure your seat is appropriate for your child and  
properly installed in the vehicle. To locate a child seat fitting station and  
CPST contact the NHTSA toll free at 1-888-327-4236 or on the internet  
at http://www.nhtsa.dot.gov. In Canada, check with your local St. John  
Ambulance office for referral to a CPST or for further information,  
contact your provincial ministry of transportation, your local St. John  
Ambulance office at http://www.sfa.ca, or Transport Canada at  
1–800–333–0371 (http://www.tc.gc.ca).  
Follow all the safety restraint and airbag precautions that apply to adult  
passengers in your vehicle.  
If the child is the proper height, age, and weight (as specified by your  
child safety seat or booster manufacturer), fits the restraint and can be  
restrained properly, then restrain the child in the child safety seat or  
with the belt-positioning booster. Remember that child seats and  
belt-positioning boosters vary and may be designed to fit children of  
different heights, ages and weights. Children who are too large for child  
safety seats or belt-positioning boosters (as specified by your child safety  
seat manufacturer) should always properly wear safety belts.  
SAFETY SEATS FOR CHILDREN  
Infant and/or toddler seats  
Use a safety seat that is recommended for the size and weight of the  
child.  
When installing a child safety seat:  
Review and follow the information  
presented in the Airbag  
supplemental restraint system  
(SRS) section in this chapter.  
Carefully follow all of the  
manufacturer’s instructions  
included with the safety seat you  
put in your vehicle. If you do not  
install and use the safety seat  
properly, the child may be injured  
in a sudden stop or collision.  
117  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat. NEVER place a  
rear-facing child seat in front of an active airbag. If you must use a  
forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move the vehicle seat all the  
way back.  
Children 12 and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating  
position whenever possible. If all children cannot be seated and  
restrained properly in a rear seating position, properly restrain the  
largest child in the front seat.  
Installing child safety seats with combination lap and shoulder  
belts  
Check to make sure the child seat is properly secured before each use.  
Children 12 and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating  
position whenever possible. If all children cannot be seated and  
restrained properly in a rear seating position, properly restrain the  
largest child in the front seat.  
When installing a child safety seat with combination lap/shoulder belts:  
Use the correct safety belt buckle for that seating position.  
Insert the belt tongue into the proper buckle until you hear a snap  
and feel it latch. Make sure the tongue is securely fastened in the  
buckle.  
Keep the buckle release button pointing up and away from the safety  
seat, with the tongue between the child seat and the release button,  
to prevent accidental unbuckling.  
Place vehicle seat back in upright position.  
Put the safety belt in the automatic locking mode. Refer to step 5  
below. This vehicle does not require the use of a locking clip.  
WARNING: Depending on where you secure a child restraint,  
and depending on the child restraint design, you may block  
access to certain safety belt buckle assemblies and/or LATCH lower  
anchors, rendering those features potentially unusable. To avoid risk of  
injury, occupants should only use seating positions where they are able  
to be properly restrained.  
Perform the following steps when installing the child seat with  
combination lap/shoulder belts:  
Note: Although the child seat illustrated is a forward facing child seat,  
the steps are the same for installing a rear facing child seat.  
118  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
1. Position the child safety seat in a  
seat with a combination lap and  
shoulder belt.  
2. Pull down on the shoulder belt  
and then grasp the shoulder belt  
and lap belt together.  
3. While holding the shoulder and  
lap belt portions together, route the  
tongue through the child seat  
according to the child seat  
manufacturer’s instructions. Be sure  
the belt webbing is not twisted.  
119  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
4. Insert the belt tongue into the  
proper buckle (the buckle closest to  
the direction the tongue is coming  
from) for that seating position until  
you hear a snap and feel the latch  
engage. Make sure the tongue is  
latched securely by pulling on it.  
5. To put the retractor in the  
automatic locking mode, grasp the  
shoulder portion of the belt and pull  
downward until all of the belt is  
pulled out.  
6. Allow the belt to retract to remove slack. The belt will click as it  
retracts to indicate it is in the automatic locking mode.  
7. Try to pull the belt out of the retractor to make sure the retractor is  
in the automatic locking mode (you should not be able to pull more belt  
out). If the retractor is not locked, unbuckle the belt and repeat Steps 5  
and 6.  
8. Remove remaining slack from the  
belt. Force the seat down with extra  
weight, e.g., by pressing down or  
kneeling on the child restraint while  
pulling up on the shoulder belt in  
order to force slack from the belt.  
This is necessary to remove the  
remaining slack that will exist once  
the additional weight of the child is  
added to the child restraint. It also  
helps to achieve the proper  
snugness of the child seat to the  
vehicle. Sometimes, a slight lean  
120  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
towards the buckle will additionally help to remove remaining slack from  
the belt.  
9. Attach the tether strap (if the  
child seat is equipped). Refer to  
Attaching child safety seats with  
tether straps later in this chapter.  
10. Before placing the child in the  
seat, forcibly move the seat forward  
and back to make sure the seat is  
securely held in place. To check  
this, grab the seat at the belt path  
and attempt to move it side to side  
and forward and back. There should  
be no more than one inch (2.5 cm) of movement for proper installation.  
11. Ford recommends checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger  
Safety Technician (CPST) to make certain the child restraint is properly  
installed. In Canada, check with your local St. John Ambulance office for  
referral to a CPST.  
Attaching child safety seats with LATCH  
(Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) attachments  
The LATCH system is composed of three vehicle anchor points: two (2)  
lower anchors located where the vehicle seat back and seat cushion meet  
(called the “seat bight”) and one (1) top tether anchor located behind  
that seating position.  
LATCH compatible child safety seats have two rigid or webbing mounted  
attachments that connect to the two lower anchors at the LATCH  
equipped seating positions in your vehicle. This type of attachment  
method eliminates the need to use safety belts to attach the child seat,  
however the safety belt can still be used to attach the child seat. For  
forward-facing child seats, the top tether strap must also be attached to  
the proper top tether anchor, if a top tether strap has been provided  
with your child seat. Ford Motor Company recommends the use of a  
child safety seat having a top tether strap. See Attaching child safety  
seats with tether straps and Recommendations for attaching safety  
restraints for children in this chapter for more information.  
121  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Your vehicle has LATCH lower anchors for child seat installation at the  
following locations:  
Five passenger crew van  
Seven passenger wagon  
Eight passenger wagon  
Eleven passenger wagon  
122  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Twelve passenger wagon  
Fifteen passenger wagon  
The LATCH lower anchors are  
located at the rear section of the  
rear seat between the cushion and  
seatback. Follow the child seat  
manufacturer’s instructions to  
properly install a child seat with  
LATCH attachments.  
Follow the instructions on attaching child safety seats with tether straps.  
Refer to Attaching child safety seats with tether straps later in this  
chapter.  
Attach LATCH lower attachments of the child seat only to the anchors  
shown.  
WARNING: Never attach two child safety seats to the same  
anchor. In a crash, one anchor may not be strong enough to hold  
two child safety seat attachments and may break, causing serious  
injury or death.  
If you install a child seat with rigid LATCH attachments, and have  
attached the top tether strap to the proper top tether anchor, do not  
tighten the tether strap enough to lift the child seat off the vehicle seat  
cushion when the child is seated in it. Keep the tether strap just snug  
123  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
without lifting the front of the child seat. Keeping the child seat just  
touching the vehicle seat gives the best protection in a severe crash.  
Each time you use the safety seat, check that the seat is properly  
attached to the lower anchors and tether anchor, if applicable. Tug the  
child seat from side to side and forward and back where it is secured to  
the vehicle. The seat should move less than one inch when you do this  
for a proper installation.  
If the safety seat is not anchored properly, the risk of a child being  
injured in a crash greatly increases.  
Combining safety belt and LATCH lower anchors for attaching  
child safety seats  
When used in combination, either the safety belt or the LATCH lower  
anchors may be attached first, provided a proper installation is achieved.  
Attach the tether strap afterward, if included with the child seat. Refer  
to Recommendations for attaching child safety restraints for children  
in this chapter.  
Attaching child safety seats with tether straps  
WARNING: When using forward-facing child safety seats in  
vehicles with only two seating positions or the forward-facing  
child safety seat cannot be placed in the rear of the vehicle, move the  
passenger seat as far back from the instrument panel as possible.  
WARNING: Because the last row of seats in the 12 passenger  
and 15 passenger configuration is not equipped with LATCH  
anchors and is spaced closer to the row of seats in front, Do not use  
forward-facing or rear-facing child seats (other than belt-positioning  
boosters) in the last row.  
Many forward-facing child safety seats include a tether strap which  
extends from the back of the child safety seat and hooks to an anchoring  
point called the top tether anchor. Tether straps are available as an  
accessory for many older safety seats. Contact the manufacturer of your  
child seat for information about ordering a tether strap, or to obtain a  
longer tether strap if the tether strap on your safety seat does not reach  
the appropriate top tether anchor in the vehicle.  
The rear seats of your vehicle are equipped with built-in tether strap  
anchors located behind the seats as described below.  
Attach the tether strap only to the appropriate tether anchor as shown.  
The tether strap may not work properly if attached somewhere other  
than the correct tether anchor.  
124  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Once the child safety seat has been installed using either the safety belt,  
the lower anchors of the LATCH system, or both, you can attach the top  
tether strap.  
Perform the following steps to install a child safety seat with tether  
anchors:  
Front passenger seating position  
The tether can be attached directly  
to the rear of the front seat.  
1. Adjust the front right-hand  
passenger seat full forward.  
125  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
2. Route the child safety seat tether  
strap over the back of the front  
right-hand passenger seat as shown.  
3. Clip the tether strap hook to the  
seat pedestal at the location shown.  
If the tether strap is clipped  
incorrectly, the child safety seat may  
not be retained properly in the  
event of a collision.  
126  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
4. Adjust the front right hand  
passenger seat to the full rearward  
position.  
5. Tighten the child safety seat  
tether strap according to the  
manufacturer’s instructions.  
If the safety seat is not anchored properly, the risk of a child being  
injured in a collision greatly increases.  
Second row bucket seats (Quads)  
The tether strap can be attached  
directly to the tether bracket under  
the back edge of the seat cushion.  
1. Route the child safety tether strap over the back of the left hand or  
right hand second row bucket seat.  
127  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
2. Clip the tether strap hook to the  
seat pedestal at the location shown.  
If the tether strap is clipped  
incorrectly, the child safety seat may  
not be retained properly in the  
event of a collision.  
3. Tighten the child safety seat tether strap according to the  
manufacturer’s instructions.  
If the safety seat is not anchored properly, the risk of a child being  
injured in a collision greatly increases.  
Second, Third, Fourth, and Fifth row bench seats  
For the center position of a  
*
*
three-passenger bench seat, the  
tether strap can be attached directly  
to the tether bracket provided  
under the back edge of the seat  
cushion. For the outboard positions,  
the tether strap can be attached to  
the slot in the side of the seat pedestal.  
*: Although tether slots are provided on the seat pedestals of the  
four–passenger bench seat, use of child seats is not recommended for  
these seating position locations.  
1. For any three–passenger bench seat, place the child safety seat on the  
left hand outboard position, the center position, or the right hand  
outboard position as desired.  
128  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
2. Route the child safety tether  
strap over the back of the bench  
seat.  
3. Clip the center tether strap hook  
to the tether bracket mounted  
under rear rail of seat cushion  
frame. Clip the outboard tether  
strap hooks to the tether bracket  
slot provided on the left side of each  
seat pedestal. The slot is located  
between the two holes.  
If the tether strap is clipped  
incorrectly, the child safety seat may not be retained properly in the  
event of a collision.  
4. Tighten the child safety seat tether strap according to the  
manufacturer’s instructions.  
If the safety seat is not anchored properly, the risk of a child being  
injured in a collision greatly increases.  
If your child restraint system is equipped with a tether strap, and the  
child restraint manufacturer recommends its use, Ford also recommends  
its use.  
Child booster seats  
The belt-positioning booster (booster seat) is used to improve the fit of  
the vehicle safety belt. Children outgrow a typical child seat (e.g.,  
convertible or toddler seat) when they weigh about 40 lb (18 kg) and are  
around four (4) years of age. Consult your child safety seat owner guide  
for the weight, height, and age limits specific to your child safety seat.  
Keep your child in the child safety seat if it properly fits the child,  
remains appropriate for their weight, height and age AND if properly  
secured to the vehicle.  
Although the lap/shoulder belt will provide some protection, children  
who have outgrown a typical child seat are still too small for lap/shoulder  
belts to fit properly, and wearing an improperly fitted vehicle safety belt  
could increase the risk of serious injury in a crash. To improve the fit of  
both the lap and shoulder belt on children who have outgrown child  
safety seats, Ford Motor Company recommends use of a belt-positioning  
booster.  
129  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Booster seats position a child so that vehicle lap/shoulder safety belts fit  
better. They lift the child up so that the lap belt rests low across the hips  
and the knees bend comfortably at the edge of the cushion, while  
minimizing slouching. Booster seats may also make the shoulder belt fit  
better and more comfortably. Try to keep the belt near the middle of the  
shoulder and across the center of the chest. Moving the child closer (a  
few centimeters or inches) to the center of the vehicle, but remaining in  
the same seating position, may help provide a good shoulder belt fit.  
When children should use booster seats  
Children need to use booster seats from the time they outgrow the  
toddler seat until they are big enough for the vehicle seat and  
lap/shoulder belt to fit properly. Generally this is when they reach a  
height of at least 4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters) tall (around age eight to  
age twelve and between 40 lb (18 kg) and 80 lb (36 kg) or upward to  
100 lb (45 kg) if recommended by your child restraint manufacturer).  
Many state and provincial laws require that children use approved  
booster seats until they reach age eight, a height of 4 feet 9 inches  
(1.45 meters) tall, or 80 lb (36 kg).  
Booster seats should be used until you can answer YES to ALL of these  
questions when seated without a booster seat:  
Can the child sit all the way back  
against the vehicle seat back with  
knees bent comfortably at the  
edge of the seat cushion?  
Can the child sit without  
slouching?  
Does the lap belt rest low across the hips?  
Is the shoulder belt centered on the shoulder and chest?  
Can the child stay seated like this for the whole trip?  
130  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Types of booster seats  
There are generally two types of belt-positioning booster seats: backless  
and high back. Always use booster seats in conjunction with the vehicle  
lap/shoulder belt.  
Backless booster seats  
If your backless booster seat has a  
removable shield, remove the  
shield. If a vehicle seating position  
has a low seat back or no head  
restraint, a backless booster seat  
may place your child’s head (as  
measured at the tops of the ears)  
above the top of the seat. In this  
case, move the backless booster  
to another seating position with a  
higher seat back or head restraint and lap/shoulder belts, or consider  
using a high back booster seat.  
High back booster seats  
If, with a backless booster seat,  
you cannot find a seating position  
that adequately supports your  
child’s head, a high back booster  
seat would be a better choice.  
131  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Children and booster seats vary in size and shape. Choose a booster that  
keeps the lap belt low and snug across the hips, never up across the  
stomach, and lets you adjust the shoulder belt to cross the chest and  
rest snugly near the center of the shoulder. The drawings below compare  
the ideal fit (center) to a shoulder belt uncomfortably close to the neck  
and a shoulder belt that could slip off the shoulder. The drawings below  
also show how the lap belt should be low and snug across the child’s  
hips.  
If the booster seat slides on the vehicle seat, placing a rubberized mesh  
sold as shelf or carpet liner under the booster seat may improve this  
condition. Do not introduce any item thicker than this under the booster  
seat. Check with the booster seat manufacturer’s instructions.  
The importance of shoulder belts  
Using a booster without a shoulder belt increases the risk of a child’s  
head hitting a hard surface in a collision. For this reason, you should  
never use a booster seat with a lap belt only. It is generally best to use a  
booster seat with lap/shoulder belts in the back seat.  
132  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Move a child to a different seating location if the shoulder belt does not  
stay positioned on the shoulder during use.  
Follow all instructions provided by the manufacturer of the booster seat.  
WARNING: Never place, or allow a child to place, the shoulder  
belt under a child’s arm or behind the back because it reduces  
the protection for the upper part of the body and may increase the risk  
of injury or death in a collision.  
Child restraint and safety belt maintenance  
Inspect the vehicle safety belts and child safety seat systems periodically  
to make sure they work properly and are not damaged. Inspect the  
vehicle and child seat safety belts to make sure there are no nicks, tears  
or cuts. Replace if necessary. All vehicle safety belt assemblies, including  
retractors, buckles, front safety belt buckle assemblies, buckle support  
assemblies (slide bar-if equipped), shoulder belt height adjusters (if  
equipped), shoulder belt guide on seatback (if equipped), child safety  
seat LATCH and tether anchors, and attaching hardware, should be  
inspected after a collision. Refer to the child restraint manufacturer’s  
instructions for additional inspection and maintenance information  
specific to the child restraint. Ford Motor Company recommends that all  
safety belt assemblies in use in vehicles involved in a collision be  
replaced. However, if the collision was minor and an authorized dealer  
finds that the belts do not show damage and continue to operate  
properly, they do not need to be replaced. Safety belt assemblies not in  
use during a collision should also be inspected and replaced if either  
damage or improper operation is noted.  
For proper care of soiled safety belts, refer to Interior in the Cleaning  
chapter.  
WARNING: Failure to inspect and if necessary replace the  
safety belt assembly or child restraint system under the above  
conditions could result in severe personal injuries in the event of a  
collision.  
133  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
NOTICE TO UTILITY VEHICLE AND TRUCK OWNERS  
Utility vehicles and trucks handle  
differently than passenger cars in  
the various driving conditions that  
are encountered on streets,  
highways and off-road. Utility  
vehicles and trucks are not designed  
for cornering at speeds as high as  
passenger cars any more than  
low-slung sports cars are designed  
to perform satisfactorily under  
off-road conditions.  
WARNING: Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover  
rate than other types of vehicles. To reduce the risk of serious  
injury or death from a rollover or other crash you must:  
Avoid sharp turns and abrupt maneuvers;  
Drive at safe speeds for the conditions;  
Keep tires properly inflated;  
Never overload or improperly load your vehicle; and  
Make sure every passenger is properly restrained.  
WARNING: In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is  
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt.  
All occupants must wear seat belts and children/infants must use  
appropriate restraints to minimize the risk of injury or ejection.  
Study your owner’s guide and any supplements for specific information  
about equipment features, instructions for safe driving and additional  
precautions to reduce the risk of an accident or serious injury.  
134  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
VEHICLE CHARACTERISTICS  
How your vehicle differs from other vehicles  
SUV and trucks can differ from  
some other vehicles in a few  
noticeable ways. Your vehicle may  
be:  
Higher – to allow higher load  
carrying capacity and to allow it  
to travel over rough terrain  
without getting hung up or  
damaging underbody components.  
Shorter – to give it the capability  
to approach inclines and drive  
over the crest of a hill without  
getting hung up or damaging  
underbody components. All other  
things held equal, a shorter  
wheelbase may make your vehicle  
quicker to respond to steering inputs than a vehicle with a longer  
wheelbase.  
Narrower — to provide greater  
maneuverability in tight spaces,  
particularly in off-road use.  
As a result of the above dimensional  
differences, SUV’s and trucks often  
will have a higher center of gravity  
and a greater difference in center of  
gravity between the loaded and  
unloaded condition.  
These differences that make your  
vehicle so versatile also make it  
handle differently than an ordinary  
passenger car.  
135  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
INFORMATION ABOUT UNIFORM TIRE QUALITY GRADING  
Tire Quality Grades apply to new  
pneumatic passenger car tires. The  
Quality grades can be found where  
applicable on the tire sidewall  
between tread shoulder and  
maximum section width. For  
example:  
Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A  
These Tire Quality Grades are determined by standards that the United  
States Department of Transportation has set.  
Tire Quality Grades apply to new pneumatic passenger car tires. They do  
not apply to deep tread, winter-type snow tires, space-saver or  
temporary use spare tires, light truck or “LT” type tires, tires with  
nominal rim diameters of 10 to 12 inches or limited production tires as  
defined in Title 49 Code of Federal Regulations Part 575.104(c)(2).  
U.S. Department of Transportation-Tire quality grades: The U.S.  
Department of Transportation requires Ford Motor Company to give you  
the following information about tire grades exactly as the government  
has written it.  
Treadwear  
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of  
the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified  
government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one  
and one-half (112) times as well on the government course as a tire  
graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual  
conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the  
norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices, and  
differences in road characteristics and climate.  
Traction AA A B C  
The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B, and C. The  
grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement as measured  
under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of  
asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction  
performance.  
136  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on  
straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include  
acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning or peak traction characteristics.  
Temperature A B C  
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C, representing the  
tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat  
when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory  
test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire  
to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to  
sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance  
which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle  
Safety Standard No. 139. Grades B and A represent higher levels of  
performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by  
law.  
WARNING: The temperature grade for this tire is established  
for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive  
speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in  
combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure.  
TIRES  
Tires are designed to give many thousands of miles of service, but they  
must be maintained in order to get the maximum benefit from them.  
Glossary of tire terminology  
Tire label: A label showing the OE (Original Equipment) tire sizes,  
recommended inflation pressure and the maximum weight the vehicle  
can carry.  
Tire Identification Number (TIN): A number on the sidewall of  
each tire providing information about the tire brand and  
manufacturing plant, tire size and date of manufacture. Also referred  
to as DOT code.  
Inflation pressure: A measure of the amount of air in a tire.  
kPa: Kilopascal, a metric unit of air pressure.  
PSI: Pounds per square inch, a standard unit of air pressure.  
Cold inflation pressure: The tire pressure when the vehicle has  
been stationary and out of direct sunlight for an hour or more and  
prior to the vehicle being driven for 1 mile (1.6 km).  
137  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Recommended inflation pressure: The cold inflation pressure found  
on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label located on  
the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door.  
B-pillar: The structural member at the side of the vehicle behind the  
front door.  
Bead area of the tire: Area of the tire next to the rim.  
Sidewall of the tire: Area between the bead area and the tread.  
Tread area of the tire: Area of the perimeter of the tire that  
contacts the road when mounted on the vehicle.  
Rim: The metal support (wheel) for a tire or a tire and tube assembly  
upon which the tire beads are seated.  
INFLATING YOUR TIRES  
Safe operation of your vehicle requires that your tires are properly  
inflated. Every day before you drive, check your tires. If one looks lower  
than the others, use a tire gauge to check pressure of all tires and adjust  
if required. Remember that a tire can lose up to half of its air pressure  
without appearing flat.  
At least once a month and before long trips, inspect each tire and check  
the tire pressure with a tire gauge (including spare, if equipped). Inflate  
all tires to the inflation pressure recommended by Ford Motor Company.  
You are strongly urged to buy a reliable tire pressure gauge, as automatic  
service station gauges may be inaccurate. Ford Motor Company  
recommends the use of a digital or dial-type tire pressure gauge rather  
than a stick-type tire pressure gauge.  
Use the recommended cold inflation pressure for optimum tire  
performance and wear. Under-inflation or over-inflation may cause  
uneven treadwear patterns.  
WARNING: Under-inflation is the most common cause of tire  
failures and may result in severe tire cracking, tread separation  
or ЉblowoutЉ, with unexpected loss of vehicle control and increased risk  
of injury. Under-inflation increases sidewall flexing and rolling  
resistance, resulting in heat buildup and internal damage to the tire. It  
also may result in unnecessary tire stress, irregular wear, loss of  
vehicle control and accidents. A tire can lose up to half of its air  
pressure and not appear to be flat!  
138  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Always inflate your tires to the Ford recommended inflation pressure  
even if it is less than the maximum inflation pressure information found  
on the tire. The Ford recommended tire inflation pressure is found on  
the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label which is located  
on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. Failure to follow the tire  
pressure recommendations can cause uneven treadwear patterns and  
adversely affect the way your vehicle handles.  
Maximum Permissible Inflation Pressure is the tire manufacturer’s  
maximum permissible pressure and/or the pressure at which the  
maximum load can be carried by the tire. This pressure is normally  
higher than the manufacturer’s recommended cold inflation pressure  
which can be found on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire  
Label which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door.  
The cold inflation pressure should never be set lower than the  
recommended pressure on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or  
Tire Label.  
When weather temperature changes occur, tire inflation pressures also  
change. A 10° F (6° C) temperature drop can cause a corresponding  
drop of 1 psi (7 kPa) in inflation pressure. Check your tire pressures  
frequently and adjust them to the proper pressure which can be found  
on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label.  
To check the pressure in your tire(s):  
1. Make sure the tires are cool, meaning they are not hot from driving  
even a mile.  
If you are checking tire pressure when the tire is hot, (i.e. driven more  
than 1 mile [1.6 km]), never “bleed” or reduce air pressure. The tires are  
hot from driving and it is normal for pressures to increase above  
recommended cold pressures. A hot tire at or below recommended cold  
inflation pressure could be significantly under-inflated.  
139  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Note: If you have to drive a distance to get air for your tire(s), check  
and record the tire pressure first and add the appropriate air pressure  
when you get to the pump. It is normal for tires to heat up and the air  
pressure inside to go up as you drive.  
2. Remove the cap from the valve on one tire, then firmly press the tire  
gauge onto the valve and measure the pressure with the tire gauge.  
3. Add enough air to reach the recommended air pressure.  
Note: If you overfill the tire, release air by pushing on the metal stem in  
the center of the valve. Then recheck the pressure with your tire gauge.  
4. Replace the valve cap.  
5. Repeat this procedure for each tire, including the spare.  
Note: Some spare tires operate at a higher inflation pressure than the  
other tires. For T-type/mini-spare tires (see Dissimilar Spare  
Tire/Wheel Information section for description): Store and maintain at  
60 psi (4.15 bar). For Full Size and Dissimilar spare tires (see  
Dissimilar Spare Tire/Wheel Information section for description):  
Store and maintain at the higher of the front and rear inflation pressure  
as shown on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or the Tire Label.  
6. Visually inspect the tires to make sure there are no nails or other  
objects embedded that could poke a hole in the tire and cause an air  
leak.  
7. Check the sidewalls to make sure there are no gouges, cuts or bulges.  
140  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Tire inflation information  
All tires with Steel Carcass Plies (if equipped):  
This type of tire utilizes steel cords in the sidewalls. As such, they  
cannot be treated like normal light truck tires. Tire service, including  
adjusting tire pressure, must be performed by personnel trained,  
supervised and equipped according to Federal Occupational Safety and  
Health Administration (OSHA) regulations. For example, during any  
procedure involving tire inflation, the technician or individual must  
utilize a remote inflation device, and ensure that all persons are clear of  
the trajectory area.  
WARNING: An inflated tire and rim can be very dangerous if  
improperly used, serviced or maintained. To reduce the risk of  
serious injury, never attempt to re-inflate a tire which has been run flat  
or seriously under-inflated without first removing the tire from the  
wheel assembly for inspection. Do not attempt to add air to tires or  
replace tires or wheels without first taking precautions to protect  
persons and property.  
141  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: Stay out of the trajectory (1) as indicated in the  
illustration.  
TIRE CARE  
Inspecting your tires and wheel valve stems  
Periodically inspect the tire treads for uneven or excessive wear and  
remove objects such as stones, nails or glass that may be wedged in the  
tread grooves. Check the tire and valve stems for holes, cracks, or cuts  
that may permit air leakage and repair or replace the tire and replace  
the valve stem. Inspect the tire sidewalls for cracking, cuts, bruises and  
other signs of damage or excessive wear. If internal damage to the tire is  
suspected, have the tire demounted and inspected in case it needs to be  
repaired or replaced. For your safety, tires that are damaged or show  
signs of excessive wear should not be used because they are more likely  
to blow out or fail.  
142  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Improper or inadequate vehicle maintenance can cause tires to wear  
abnormally. Inspect all your tires, including the spare, frequently, and  
replace them if one or more of the following conditions exist:  
Tire wear  
When the tread is worn down to  
1/16th of an inch (2 mm), tires must  
be replaced to help prevent your  
vehicle from skidding and  
hydroplaning. Built-in treadwear  
indicators, or “wear bars”, which  
look like narrow strips of smooth  
rubber across the tread will appear  
on the tire when the tread is worn  
down to 1/16th of an inch (2 mm).  
When the tire tread wears down to  
the same height as these “wear bars”, the tire is worn out and must be  
replaced.  
Damage  
Periodically inspect the tire treads and sidewalls for damage (such as  
bulges in the tread or sidewalls, cracks in the tread groove and  
separation in the tread or sidewall). If damage is observed or suspected  
have the tire inspected by a tire professional. Tires can be damaged  
during off-road use, so inspection after off-road use is also  
recommended.  
WARNING: Age  
Tires degrade over time depending on many factors such as  
weather, storage conditions, and conditions of use (load, speed,  
inflation pressure, etc.) the tires experience throughout their lives.  
In general, tires should be replaced after six years regardless of tread  
wear. However, heat caused by hot climates or frequent high loading  
conditions can accelerate the aging process and may require tires to be  
replaced more frequently.  
You should replace your spare tire when you replace the road tires or  
after six years due to aging even if it has not been used.  
143  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN)  
Both U.S. and Canada Federal regulations require tire manufacturers to  
place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires. This  
information identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of  
the tire and also provides a U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number for  
safety standard certification and in case of a recall.  
This begins with the letters “DOT” and indicates that the tire meets all  
federal standards. The next two numbers or letters are the plant code  
designating where it was manufactured, the next two are the tire size  
code and the last four numbers represent the week and year the tire was  
built. For example, the numbers 317 mean the 31st week of 1997. After  
2000 the numbers go to four digits. For example, 2501 means the 25th  
week of 2001. The numbers in between are identification codes used for  
traceability. This information is used to contact customers if a tire defect  
requires a recall.  
Tire Replacement Requirements  
Your vehicle is equipped with tires designed to provide a safe ride and  
handling capability.  
WARNING: Only use replacement tires and wheels that are the  
same size, load index, speed rating and type (such as P-metric  
versus LT-metric or all-season versus all-terrain) as those originally  
provided by Ford. The recommended tire and wheel size may be found  
on either the Safety Compliance Certification Label or the Tire Label  
which is located on the B-Pillar or edge of the driver’s door. If this  
information is not found on these labels then you should contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible. Use of any tire or wheel not  
recommended by Ford can affect the safety and performance of your  
vehicle, which could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle  
control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death. Additionally the use  
of non-recommended tires and wheels could cause steering,  
suspension, axle or transfer case/power transfer unit failure. If you  
have questions regarding tire replacement, contact your authorized  
dealer as soon as possible.  
144  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: When mounting replacement tires and wheels, you  
should not exceed the maximum pressure indicated on the  
sidewall of the tire to set the beads without additional precautions  
listed below. If the beads do not seat at the maximum pressure  
indicated, re-lubricate and try again.  
When inflating the tire for mounting pressures up to 20 psi (138 kPa)  
greater than the maximum pressure on the tire sidewall, the following  
precautions must be taken to protect the person mounting the tire:  
1. Make sure that you have the correct tire and wheel size.  
2. Lubricate the tire bead and wheel bead seat area again.  
3. Stand at a minimum of 12 ft. (3.66 m) away from the tire wheel  
assembly.  
4. Use both eye and ear protection.  
For a mounting pressure more than 20 psi (138 kPa) greater than the  
maximum pressure, a Ford Dealer or other tire service professional  
should do the mounting.  
Always inflate steel carcass tires with a remote air fill with the person  
inflating standing at a minimum of 12 ft. (3.66 m) away from the tire  
wheel assembly.  
Important: Remember to replace the wheel valve stems when the road  
tires are replaced on your vehicle.  
It is recommended that the two front tires or two rear tires generally be  
replaced as a pair.  
The tire pressure sensors mounted in the wheels are not designed to be  
used in aftermarket wheels.  
The use of wheels or tires not recommended by Ford Motor Company  
may affect the operation of your Tire Pressure Monitoring System (if  
equipped).  
If the TPMS indicator is flashing, your TPMS is malfunctioning. Your  
replacement tire might be incompatible with your TPMS, or some  
component of the TPMS may be damaged (if equipped).  
Safety practices  
Driving habits have a great deal to do with your tire mileage and safety.  
Observe posted speed limits  
Avoid fast starts, stops and turns  
Avoid potholes and objects on the road  
145  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Do not run over curbs or hit the tire against a curb when parking  
WARNING: If your vehicle is stuck in snow, mud, sand, etc., do  
not rapidly spin the tires; spinning the tires can tear the tire and  
cause an explosion. A tire can explode in as little as three to five  
seconds.  
WARNING: Do not spin the wheels at over 35 mph (56 km/h).  
The tires may fail and injure a passenger or bystander.  
Highway hazards  
No matter how carefully you drive there’s always the possibility that you  
may eventually have a flat tire on the highway. Drive slowly to the  
closest safe area out of traffic. This may further damage the flat tire, but  
your safety is more important.  
If you feel a sudden vibration or ride disturbance while driving, or you  
suspect your tire or vehicle has been damaged, immediately reduce your  
speed. Drive with caution until you can safely pull off the road. Stop and  
inspect the tires for damage. If a tire is under-inflated or damaged,  
deflate it, remove wheel and replace it with your spare tire and wheel. If  
you cannot detect a cause, have the vehicle towed to the nearest repair  
facility or tire dealer to have the vehicle inspected.  
Tire and wheel alignment  
A bad jolt from hitting a curb or pothole can cause the front end of your  
vehicle to become misaligned or cause damage to your tires. If your  
vehicle seems to pull to one side when you’re driving, the wheels may be  
out of alignment. Have an authorized dealer check the wheel alignment  
periodically.  
Wheel misalignment in the front or the rear can cause uneven and rapid  
treadwear of your tires and should be corrected by an authorized dealer.  
Front wheel drive (FWD) vehicles and those with an independent rear  
suspension (if equipped) may require alignment of all four wheels.  
The tires should also be balanced periodically. An unbalanced tire and  
wheel assembly may result in irregular tire wear.  
Tire rotation  
Rotating your tires at the recommended interval (as indicated in the  
scheduled maintenance information that comes with your vehicle) will  
help your tires wear more evenly, providing better tire performance and  
longer tire life.  
146  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Rear Wheel Drive (RWD)  
vehicles/Four Wheel Drive  
(4WD)/All Wheel Drive (AWD)  
vehicles (front tires at top of  
diagram)  
Sometimes irregular tire wear can be corrected by rotating the tires.  
Note: If your tires show uneven wear ask an authorized dealer to check  
for and correct any wheel misalignment, tire imbalance or mechanical  
problem involved before tire rotation.  
Note: Your vehicle may be equipped with a dissimilar spare tire/wheel. A  
dissimilar spare tire/wheel is defined as a spare tire and/or wheel that is  
different in brand, size or appearance from the road tires and wheels. If  
you have a dissimilar spare tire/wheel it is intended for temporary use  
only and should not be used in a tire rotation.  
Note: After having your tires rotated, inflation pressure must be checked  
and adjusted to the vehicle requirements.  
WARNING: If the tire label shows different tire pressures for  
the front and rear tires and the vehicle is equipped with TPMS  
(tire pressure monitoring system), then the settings for the TPMS  
sensors need to be updated. Always perform the TPMS reset procedure  
after tire rotation. If the system is not reset, it may not provide a low  
tire pressure warning when necessary. See the TPMS reset procedure  
in this chapter.  
147  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
DRW – Six tire rotation  
If your vehicle is equipped with dual  
rear wheels it is recommended that  
the front and rear tires (in pairs) be  
rotated only side to side. We do not  
recommend splitting up the dual  
rear wheels. Rotate them side to  
side as a set/pair. After tire rotation,  
inflation pressures must be adjusted  
for the tires new positions in  
accordance with vehicle  
requirements.  
Sometimes irregular tire wear can be corrected by rotating the tires.  
Note: If your tires show uneven wear ask your authorized dealer to  
check for and correct any wheel misalignment, tire imbalance or  
mechanical problem involved before tire rotation.  
Note: Your vehicle may be equipped with a dissimilar spare tire/wheel. A  
dissimilar spare tire/wheel is defined as a spare tire and/or wheel that is  
different in brand, size or appearance from the road tires and wheels. If  
you have a dissimilar spare tire/wheel it is intended for temporary use  
only and should not be used in a tire rotation.  
Note: After having your tires rotated, inflation pressure must be checked  
and adjusted to the vehicle requirements.  
INFORMATION CONTAINED ON THE TIRE SIDEWALL  
Both U.S. and Canada Federal regulations require tire manufacturers to  
place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires. This  
information identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of  
the tire and also provides a U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number for  
safety standard certification and in case of a recall.  
148  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Information on “P” type tires  
P215/65R15 95H is an example of a  
tire size, load index and speed  
rating. The definitions of these  
items are listed below. (Note that  
the tire size, load index and speed  
rating for your vehicle may be  
different from this example.)  
1. P: Indicates a tire, designated by  
the Tire and Rim Association  
(T&RA), that may be used for  
service on cars, SUVs, minivans and  
light trucks.  
Note: If your tire size does not  
begin with a letter this may mean it  
is designated by either ETRTO  
(European Tire and Rim Technical Organization) or JATMA (Japan Tire  
Manufacturing Association).  
2. 215: Indicates the nominal width of the tire in millimeters from  
sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general, the larger the number, the  
wider the tire.  
3. 65: Indicates the aspect ratio which gives the tire’s ratio of height to  
width.  
4. R: Indicates a “radial” type tire.  
5. 15: Indicates the wheel or rim diameter in inches. If you change your  
wheel size, you will have to purchase new tires to match the new wheel  
diameter.  
6. 95: Indicates the tire’s load index. It is an index that relates to how  
much weight a tire can carry. You may find this information in your  
Owner’s Guide. If not, contact a local tire dealer.  
Note: You may not find this information on all tires because it is not  
required by federal law.  
7. H: Indicates the tire’s speed rating. The speed rating denotes the  
speed at which a tire is designed to be driven for extended periods of  
time under a standard condition of load and inflation pressure. The tires  
on your vehicle may operate at different conditions for load and inflation  
pressure. These speed ratings may need to be adjusted for the difference  
in conditions. The ratings range from 81 mph (130 km/h) to 186 mph  
(299 km/h). These ratings are listed in the following chart.  
149  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Note: You may not find this information on all tires because it is not  
required by federal law.  
Letter rating  
Speed rating - mph (km/h)  
81 mph (130 km/h)  
87 mph (140 km/h)  
99 mph (159 km/h)  
106 mph (171 km/h)  
112 mph (180 km/h)  
118 mph (190 km/h)  
124 mph (200 km/h)  
130 mph (210 km/h)  
149 mph (240 km/h)  
168 mph (270 km/h)  
186 mph (299 km/h)  
M
N
Q
R
S
T
U
H
V
W
Y
Note: For tires with a maximum speed capability over 149 mph  
(240 km/h), tire manufacturers sometimes use the letters ZR. For  
those with a maximum speed capability over 186 mph (299 km/h), tire  
manufacturers always use the letters ZR.  
8. U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN): This begins with the  
letters “DOT” and indicates that the tire meets all federal standards. The  
next two numbers or letters are the plant code designating where it was  
manufactured, the next two are the tire size code and the last four  
numbers represent the week and year the tire was built. For example,  
the numbers 317 mean the 31st week of 1997. After 2000 the numbers  
go to four digits. For example, 2501 means the 25th week of 2001. The  
numbers in between are identification codes used for traceability. This  
information is used to contact customers if a tire defect requires a recall.  
9. M+S or M/S: Mud and Snow, or  
AT: All Terrain, or  
AS: All Season.  
150  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
10. Tire Ply Composition and Material Used: Indicates the number of  
plies or the number of layers of rubber-coated fabric in the tire tread and  
sidewall. Tire manufacturers also must indicate the ply materials in the  
tire and the sidewall, which include steel, nylon, polyester, and others.  
11. Maximum Load: Indicates the maximum load in kilograms and  
pounds that can be carried by the tire. Refer to the Safety Compliance  
Certification Label, which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the  
driver’s door, for the correct tire pressure for your vehicle.  
12. Treadwear, Traction and Temperature Grades  
Treadwear: The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the  
wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a  
specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150  
would wear one and one-half (112) times as well on the government  
course as a tire graded 100.  
Traction: The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B,  
and C. The grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement  
as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test  
surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor  
traction performance.  
Temperature: The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C,  
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its  
ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a  
specified indoor laboratory test wheel.  
13. Maximum Permissible Inflation Pressure: Indicates the tire  
manufacturers’ maximum permissible pressure and/or the pressure at  
which the maximum load can be carried by the tire. This pressure is  
normally higher than the manufacturer’s recommended cold inflation  
pressure which can be found on the Safety Compliance Certification  
Label or Tire Label which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the  
driver’s door. The cold inflation pressure should never be set lower than  
the recommended pressure on the vehicle label.  
The tire suppliers may have additional markings, notes or warnings such  
as standard load, radial tubeless, etc.  
151  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Additional information contained on the tire sidewall for “LT” type  
tires  
“LT” type tires have some additional  
information beyond those of “P”  
type tires; these differences are  
described below.  
Note: Tire Quality Grades do not  
apply to this type of tire.  
1. LT: Indicates a tire, designated by  
the Tire and Rim Association  
(T&RA), that is intended for service  
on light trucks.  
2. Load Range/Load Inflation  
Limits: Indicates the tire’s  
load-carrying capabilities and its  
inflation limits.  
3. Maximum Load Dual lb (kg) at psi (kPa) cold: Indicates the  
maximum load and tire pressure when the tire is used as a dual; defined  
as four tires on the rear axle (a total of six or more tires on the vehicle).  
4. Maximum Load Single lb (kg) at psi (kPa) cold: Indicates the  
maximum load and tire pressure when the tire is used as a single;  
defined as two tires (total) on the rear axle.  
152  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Information on “T” type tires  
“T” type tires have some additional  
information beyond those of “P”  
type tires; these differences are  
described below:  
T145/80D16 is an example of a tire  
size.  
Note: The temporary tire size for  
your vehicle may be different from  
this example. Tire Quality Grades do  
not apply to this type of tire.  
1. T: Indicates a type of tire,  
designated by the Tire and Rim  
Association (T&RA), that is  
intended for temporary service on  
cars, SUVs, minivans and light  
trucks.  
2. 145: Indicates the nominal width  
of the tire in millimeters from sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general,  
the larger the number, the wider the tire.  
3. 80: Indicates the aspect ratio which gives the tire’s ratio of height to  
width. Numbers of 70 or lower indicate a short sidewall.  
4. D: Indicates a “diagonal” type tire.  
R: Indicates a “radial” type tire.  
5. 16: Indicates the wheel or rim diameter in inches. If you change your  
wheel size, you will have to purchase new tires to match the new wheel  
diameter.  
Location of the tire label  
You will find a Tire Label containing tire inflation pressure by tire size  
and other important information located on the B-Pillar or the edge of  
the driver’s door. Refer to the payload description and graphic in the  
Vehicle loading — with and without a trailer section.  
153  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS) (IF EQUIPPED)  
Each tire, including the spare (if  
provided), should be checked  
monthly when cold and inflated to  
the inflation pressure recommended  
by the vehicle manufacturer on the  
vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires  
of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire  
inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation  
pressure for those tires.)  
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire  
pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure  
telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.  
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should  
stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the  
proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the  
tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces  
fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling  
and stopping ability.  
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire  
maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain correct tire  
pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger  
illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.  
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator  
to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS  
malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale.  
When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for  
approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated.  
This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as  
the malfunction exists.  
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be  
able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions  
may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of  
replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the  
TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction  
telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to  
ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the  
TPMS to continue to function properly.  
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System complies with part 15 of the FCC  
rules and with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the  
154  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful  
interference, and (2) This device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
WARNING: The Tire Pressure Monitoring System is NOT a  
substitute for manually checking tire pressure. The tire pressure  
should be checked periodically (at least monthly) using a tire gauge,  
see Inflating your tires in this chapter. Failure to properly maintain  
your tire pressure could increase the risk of tire failure, loss of control,  
vehicle rollover and personal injury.  
Changing tires with TPMS  
Each road tire is equipped with a tire pressure sensor located  
inside the tire/wheel cavity. There are two different types of  
pressure sensors:  
Snap-in sensor — the pressure  
sensor is attached to the back of  
the valve stem.  
Banded sensor — the pressure  
sensor is banded to the wheel.  
155  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
In either case, the pressure sensor is covered by the tire and is  
not visible unless the tire is removed. Care must be taken when  
changing the tire to avoid damaging the sensor. It is recommended  
that you always have your tires serviced by an authorized dealer.  
The tire pressure should be checked periodically (at least monthly) using  
an accurate tire gauge, refer to Inflating your tires in this chapter.  
How to identify which type of pressure sensor is on your vehicle  
The wheel could have either type of pressure sensor depending on the  
appearance of the valve stem:  
Rubber valve stem with snap-in  
sensor- the valve stem has a  
rubber seal (1) and an extra  
brass shoulder, larger in diameter  
and with no treads, that can be  
seen when the cap is removed.  
1
Rubber valve stem with banded  
sensor- the valve stem has a  
rubber seal (1) with brass of a  
uniform diameter all the way  
down to the seal.  
1
156  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Metal valve stem with banded  
sensor- the valve stem is  
completely metal.  
Understanding your Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)  
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System measures pressure in your four  
road tires and sends the tire pressure readings to your vehicle. The Low  
Tire Warning Lamp will turn ON if the tire pressure is significantly low.  
Once the light is illuminated, your tires are under inflated and need to be  
inflated to the manufacturer’s recommended tire pressure. Even if the  
light turns ON and a short time later turns OFF, your tire pressure still  
needs to be checked. Visit www.checkmytires.org for additional  
information.  
When your temporary spare tire is installed  
When one of your road tires needs to be replaced with the temporary  
spare, the TPMS system will continue to identify an issue to remind you  
that the damaged road wheel/tire needs to be repaired and put back on  
your vehicle.  
To restore the full functionality of the Tire Pressure Monitoring System,  
have the damaged road wheel/tire repaired and remounted on your  
vehicle. For additional information, refer to Changing tires with TPMS  
in this section.  
157  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
When you believe your system is not operating properly  
The main function of the Tire Pressure Monitoring System is to warn you  
when your tires need air. It can also warn you in the event the system is  
no longer capable of functioning as intended. Please refer to the  
following chart for information concerning your Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System:  
Low Tire Pres- Possible  
Customer Action Required  
sure Warning  
Light  
cause  
Solid Warning  
Light  
Tire(s)  
under-  
inflated  
1. Check your tire pressure to ensure  
tires are properly inflated; refer to  
Inflating your tires in this chapter.  
2. After inflating your tires to the  
manufacturer’s recommended infla-  
tion pressure as shown on the Tire  
Label (located on the edge of driver’s  
door or the B-Pillar), the vehicle  
must be driven for at least two min-  
utes over 20 mph (32 km/h) before  
the light will turn OFF.  
Spare tire in Your temporary spare tire is in use.  
use  
Repair the damaged road wheel/tire  
and reinstall it on the vehicle to re-  
store system functionality. For a de-  
scription on how the system func-  
tions, refer to When your temporary  
spare tire is installed in this section.  
TPMS mal-  
function  
If your tires are properly inflated and  
your spare tire is not in use and the  
light remains ON, contact your autho-  
rized dealer as soon as possible.  
Tire rotation On vehicles with different front and  
without sen- rear tire pressures, the TPMS system  
sor training  
must be retrained following every tire  
rotation. Refer to Tire rotation in  
this chapter.  
158  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Low Tire Pres- Possible  
Customer Action Required  
sure Warning  
Light  
cause  
Flashing Warning Spare tire in Your temporary spare tire is in use.  
Light  
use  
Repair the damaged road wheel and  
re-mount it on the vehicle to restore  
system functionality. For a descrip-  
tion of how the system functions un-  
der these conditions, refer to When  
your temporary spare tire is in-  
stalled in this section.  
TPMS mal-  
function  
If your tires are properly inflated and  
your spare tire is not in use and the  
TPMS warning light still flashes, con-  
tact your authorized dealer as soon  
as possible.  
When inflating your tires  
When putting air into your tires (such as at a gas station or in your  
garage), the Tire Pressure Monitoring System may not respond  
immediately to the air added to your tires.  
It may take up to two minutes of driving over 20 mph (32 km/h) for the  
light to turn OFF after you have filled your tires to the recommended  
inflation pressure.  
How temperature affects your tire pressure  
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) monitors tire pressure in  
each pneumatic tire. While driving in a normal manner, a typical  
passenger tire inflation pressure may increase approximately 2 to 4 psi  
(14 to 28 kPa) from a cold start situation. If the vehicle is stationary  
over night with the outside temperature significantly lower than the  
daytime temperature, the tire pressure may decrease approximately 3 psi  
(20.7 kPa) for a drop of 30° F (16.6° C) in ambient temperature. This  
lower pressure value may be detected by the TPMS as being significantly  
lower than the recommended inflation pressure and activate the TPMS  
warning for low tire pressure. If the low tire pressure warning light is  
ON, visually check each tire to verify that no tire is flat. If one or more  
tires are flat, repair as necessary. Check air pressure in the road tires. If  
any tire is under-inflated, carefully drive the vehicle to the nearest  
location where air can be added to the tires. Inflate all the tires to the  
recommended inflation pressure.  
159  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
TPMS reset procedure  
The TPMS reset procedure needs to be performed after each tire  
rotation on vehicles that require different recommended tire  
pressures in the front tires as compared to the rear tires.  
WARNING: To determine the required pressure(s) for your  
vehicle – refer to the Safety Compliance Certification Label or  
Tire Label located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. See  
Vehicle Loading in this chapter for more information.  
Overview  
Note: Before performing either of the TPMS reset procedures below  
refer to Changing tires with TPMS earlier in this section to familiarize  
yourself with the type of wheels and pressure sensors on your vehicle.  
To provide the vehicle’s load carrying capability, some vehicles require  
different recommended tire pressures in the front tires as compared to  
the rear tires. The Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) equipped on  
these vehicles is designed to illuminate the Low Tire Pressure Warning  
indicator at two different pressures; one for the front tires and one for  
the rear tires.  
Since tires need to be rotated to provide consistent performance and  
maximum tire life, the Tire Pressure Monitoring System needs to know  
when the tires are rotated to determine which set of tires are on the  
front and which are on the rear. With this information, the system can  
detect and properly warn of low tire pressures.  
TPMS reset tips:  
To reduce the chances of interference from another vehicle, the TPMS  
reset procedure should be performed at least 3 feet (1 meter) away  
from another Ford Motor Company vehicle undergoing the TPMS reset  
procedure at the same time.  
Do not wait more than two (2) minutes between resetting each tire  
sensor or the system will timeout and the entire procedure will have  
to be repeated on all four wheels.  
A double horn chirp indicates the need to repeat the procedure.  
Note: Two TPMS reset procedures are given below: one for tires with  
snap-in sensors and one for tires with banded sensors.  
160  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Performing the TPMS reset procedure  
(Vehicles that have wheels with snap-in pressure sensors)  
It is recommended that you read the entire procedure before attempting.  
1. Drive the vehicle above 20 mph (32 km/h) for at least 2 minutes and  
then park in a safe location where you can easily get to all four tires and  
have access to an air pump.  
2. Place the ignition in the off position and keep the key in the ignition.  
3. Cycle the ignition to the on  
position with the engine off.  
4. Turn the hazard flashers on then  
off 3 times. This must be  
accomplished within ten seconds.  
If the reset mode has been entered successfully, the horn will sound  
once, the TPMS indicator  
will flash and the message center (if  
equipped) will display TRAIN LEFT FRONT TIRE. If this does not  
occur, please try again starting at step 2.  
If after repeated attempts to enter the reset mode, the horn does not  
sound, the TPMS indicator  
does not flash and the message center (if  
equipped) does not display TRAIN LEFT FRONT TIRE, seek service  
from your authorized dealer.  
5. Train the TPMS sensors in the tires using the following TPMS reset  
sequence starting with the left front tire in the following clockwise  
order:  
Left front (Driver’s side front tire)  
Right front (Passenger’s side front tire)  
Right rear (Passenger’s side rear tire)  
Left rear (Driver’s side rear tire)  
161  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
6. Remove the valve cap from the valve stem on the left front tire.  
Decrease the air pressure until the horn sounds.  
Note: The single horn chirp confirms that the sensor identification code  
has been learned by the module for this position. If a double horn is  
heard, the reset procedure was unsuccessful, and must be repeated.  
7. Remove the valve cap from the valve stem on the right front tire.  
Decrease the air pressure until the horn sounds.  
8. Remove the valve cap from the valve stem on the right rear tire.  
Decrease the air pressure until the horn sounds.  
9. Remove the valve cap from the valve stem on the left rear tire.  
Decrease the air pressure until the horn sounds.  
Training is complete after the horn sounds for the last tire trained  
(driver’s side rear tire), the TPMS tell tale stops flashing, and the  
message center (if equipped) displays:  
TRAINING COMPLETE.  
10. Turn the ignition off. If two short horn beeps are heard, the reset  
procedure was unsuccessful and must be repeated.  
If after repeating the procedure and two short beeps are heard when the  
ignition is turned to off, seek assistance from your authorized dealer.  
11. Set all four tires to the recommended air pressure as indicated on  
the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label located on the  
B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. See Vehicle Loading in this  
chapter for more information.  
Performing the TPMS reset procedure  
(Vehicles that have wheels with banded pressure sensors)  
TPMS reset tool  
A special TPMS reset tool to reset your TPMS after tire rotation is  
provided with vehicles that have different front and rear tire pressures.  
The tool is located with your Owner’s Guide materials.  
162  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Please take the tool with the  
provided Velcrostrip on the back  
and mount it in the bottom right  
corner of your Owner’s Guide case  
(as shown) for safe keeping.  
If you find that the reset tool was not provided when delivered, has been  
lost or no longer functions (the battery is not replaceable), please  
contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible to obtain a  
replacement.  
To verify that your TPMS reset tool is working, press and release the  
button on the center of the TPMS tool. The red light should illuminate  
and remain on for approximately five (5) seconds. If the light does not  
illuminate, the tool needs to be replaced.  
It is recommended that you read the entire procedure before attempting.  
Note: To enter the reset mode, Steps 1–6 MUST be completed within  
60 seconds.  
1. Place the ignition in the off position and keep the key in the ignition.  
2. Press and release the brake  
pedal.  
163  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
3. Cycle the ignition from off to on  
three (3) times ending in the on  
position—DO NOT start the engine.  
4. Press and hold the brake pedal  
for two (2) seconds, then release.  
5. Turn the ignition to off—DO  
NOT remove the key.  
6. Cycle the ignition from off to on three (3) times ending in on. DO  
NOT start the engine.  
If the reset mode has been entered successfully, the horn will sound  
once, the TPMS indicator  
will flash and the message center will  
display TRAIN LEFT FRONT TIRE.  
If after repeated attempts to enter the reset mode, the horn does not  
sound, the TPMS indicator  
does not flash and the message center  
does not display TRAIN LEFT FRONT TIRE, contact your authorized  
dealer as soon as possible.  
164  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
7. Train the TPMS sensors in the tires using the following TPMS reset  
sequence starting with the left front tire in the following clockwise  
order:  
1. Left front tire (Front driver’s side)  
2. Right front tire (Front passenger’s side)  
3. Right rear tire (Rear passenger’s side)  
4. Left rear tire (Rear driver’s side)  
8. Left front tire: Place the TPMS reset tool against the left front tire  
where the tire meets the rim, opposite from the valve stem (1) as shown.  
This is where the sensor is located inside the rim.  
The tool needs to be held against the tire sidewall opposite the  
valve stem as illustrated with the arrow on the tool pointing  
towards the rim; do not use the tool with the arrow pointing away  
from the rim as it may not activate the sensor.  
9. Press and release the green button and hold the tool to the tire  
sidewall until the horn sounds. The red light on the TPMS reset tool will  
illuminate while the tool is active. The horn will sound once within  
10 seconds to indicate the process was successful.  
165  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Note:  
If a double horn chirp is heard, repeat the procedure. If a single horn  
chirp is not heard, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least a  
1
4-turn and repeat the procedure starting with Step 1.  
If a double horn chirp is heard even after the wheels were  
repositioned, contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
10. Perform Steps 8 and 9 on the right front tire, right rear tire and  
finally the left rear tire. Training is complete after the horn sounds for  
the last tire trained (left rear tire) and the message center displays:  
TRAINING COMPLETE.  
Turn the ignition to off. If two short horn beeps are heard, the reset  
procedure was unsuccessful and must be repeated.  
If after repeating the procedure and two short beeps are heard when the  
ignition is turned to off, contact your authorized dealer as soon as  
possible.  
SNOW TIRES AND CHAINS  
WARNING: Snow tires must be the same size, load index, speed  
rating as those originally provided by Ford. Use of any tire or  
wheel not recommended by Ford can affect the safety and  
performance of your vehicle, which could result in an increased risk of  
loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
Additionally, the use of non-recommended tires and wheels could  
cause steering, suspension, axle or transfer case/power transfer unit  
failure.  
The tires on your vehicle have all weather treads to provide traction in  
rain and snow. However, in some climates, you may need to use snow  
tires and chains. If you need to use chains, it is recommended that steel  
wheels (of the same size and specifications) be used, as chains may chip  
aluminum wheels.  
Follow these guidelines when using snow tires and chains:  
Use only SAE Class S chains.  
Install chains securely, verifying that the chains do not touch any  
wiring, brake lines or fuel lines.  
Drive cautiously. If you hear the chains rub or bang against your  
vehicle, stop and re-tighten the chains. If this does not work, remove  
the chains to prevent damage to your vehicle.  
166  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
If possible, avoid fully loading your vehicle.  
Remove the tire chains when they are no longer needed. Do not use  
tire chains on dry roads.  
The suspension insulation and bumpers will help prevent vehicle  
damage. Do not remove these components from your vehicle when  
using snow tires and chains.  
VEHICLE LOADING – WITH AND WITHOUT A TRAILER  
This section will guide you in the proper loading of your vehicle and/or  
trailer, to keep your loaded vehicle weight within its design rating  
capability, with or without a trailer. Properly loading your vehicle will  
provide maximum return of vehicle design performance. Before loading  
your vehicle, familiarize yourself with the following terms for determining  
your vehicle’s weight ratings, with or without a trailer, from the vehicle’s  
Tire Label or Safety Compliance Certification Label:  
Base Curb Weight – is the weight of the vehicle including a full tank of  
fuel and all standard equipment. It does not include passengers, cargo, or  
optional equipment.  
Vehicle Curb Weight – is the weight of your new vehicle when you  
picked it up from your authorized dealer plus any aftermarket  
equipment.  
167  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Payload – is the combined weight of cargo and passengers that the  
vehicle is carrying. The maximum payload for your vehicle can be found  
on the Tire Label on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door  
(vehicles exported outside the US and Canada may not have a Tire  
Label). Look for “THE COMBINED WEIGHT OF OCCUPANTS AND  
CARGO SHOULD NEVER EXCEED XXX kg OR XXX lb.” for  
maximum payload. The payload listed on the Tire Label is the maximum  
payload for the vehicle as built by the assembly plant. If any aftermarket  
or authorized-dealer installed equipment has been installed on the  
vehicle, the weight of the equipment must be subtracted from the  
payload listed on the Tire Label in order to determine the new payload.  
WARNING: The appropriate loading capacity of your vehicle can  
be limited either by volume capacity (how much space is  
available) or by payload capacity (how much weight the vehicle should  
carry). Once you have reached the maximum payload of your vehicle,  
do not add more cargo, even if there is space available. Overloading or  
improperly loading your vehicle can contribute to loss of vehicle  
control and vehicle rollover.  
168  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Example only:  
Cargo Weight – includes all weight added to the Base Curb Weight,  
including cargo and optional equipment. When towing, trailer tongue load  
or king pin weight is also part of cargo weight.  
GAW (Gross Axle Weight) – is the total weight placed on each axle  
(front and rear) – including vehicle curb weight and all payload.  
169  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) – is the maximum allowable  
weight that can be carried by a single axle (front or rear). These  
numbers are shown on the Safety Compliance Certification Label  
located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. The total  
load on each axle must never exceed its GAWR.  
Note: For trailer towing information refer to Trailer towing found in  
this chapter or the RV and Trailer Towing Guide provided by your  
authorized dealer.  
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) – is the Vehicle Curb Weight + cargo +  
passengers.  
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) – is the maximum allowable  
weight of the fully loaded vehicle (including all options, equipment,  
passengers and cargo). The GVWR is shown on the Safety  
Compliance Certification Label located on the B-Pillar or the  
edge of the driver’s door. The GVW must never exceed the GVWR.  
170  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Example only:  
WARNING: Exceeding the Safety Compliance Certification Label  
vehicle weight rating limits could result in substandard vehicle  
handling or performance, engine, transmission and/or structural  
damage, serious damage to the vehicle, loss of control and personal  
injury.  
171  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GCW (Gross Combined Weight) – is the weight of the loaded vehicle  
(GVW) plus the weight of the fully loaded trailer.  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating) – is the maximum allowable  
weight of the vehicle and the loaded trailer – including all cargo and  
passengers – that the vehicle can handle without risking damage.  
(Important: The towing vehicle’s braking system is rated for operation at  
GVWR, not at GCWR.) Separate functional brakes should be used for  
safe control of towed vehicles and for trailers where the GCW of the  
towing vehicle plus the trailer exceed the GVWR of the towing vehicle.  
The GCW must never exceed the GCWR.  
Maximum Loaded Trailer Weight – is the highest possible weight of a  
fully loaded trailer the vehicle can tow. It assumes a vehicle with only  
mandatory options, no cargo (internal or external), a tongue load of  
10–15% (conventional trailer) or king pin weight of 15–25% (fifth wheel  
trailer), and driver only (150 lb. [68 kg]). Consult your authorized  
dealer (or the RV and Trailer Towing Guide provided by your  
authorized dealer) for more detailed information.  
Tongue Load or Fifth Wheel King Pin Weight – refers to the amount  
of the weight that a trailer pushes down on a trailer hitch.  
Examples: For a 5,000 lb. (2,268 kg) conventional trailer, multiply 5,000  
by 0.10 and 0.15 to obtain a proper tongue load range of 500 to 750 lb.  
(227 to 340 kg). For an 11,500 lb. (5,216 kg) fifth wheel trailer, multiply  
by 0.15 and 0.25 to obtain a proper king pin load range of 1,725 to  
2,875 lb. (782 to 1,304 kg)  
WARNING: Do not exceed the GVWR or the GAWR specified on  
the Safety Compliance Certification Label.  
WARNING: Do not use replacement tires with lower load  
carrying capacities than the original tires because they may  
lower the vehicle’s GVWR and GAWR limitations. Replacement tires  
with a higher limit than the original tires do not increase the GVWR  
and GAWR limitations.  
172  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: Exceeding any vehicle weight rating limitation could  
result in serious damage to the vehicle and/or personal injury.  
Steps for determining the correct load limit:  
1. Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and cargo  
should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lb.” on your vehicle’s placard.  
2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will  
be riding in your vehicle.  
3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kg  
or XXX lb.  
4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage  
load capacity. For example, if the “XXX” amount equals 1,400 lb. and  
there will be five 150 lb. passengers in your vehicle, the amount of  
available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lb. (1400-750 (5 x 150) =  
650 lb.). In metric units (635-340 (5 x 68) = 295 kg.)  
5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on  
the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and  
luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4.  
6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be  
transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this  
reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.  
The following gives you a few examples on how to calculate the available  
amount of cargo and luggage load capacity:  
Another example for your vehicle with 1,400 lb. (635 kg) of cargo and  
luggage capacity. You decide to go golfing. Is there enough load  
capacity to carry you, 4 of your friends and all the golf bags? You and  
four friends average 220 lb. (99 kg) each and the golf bags weigh  
approximately 30 lb. (13.5 kg) each. The calculation would be: 1400 -  
(5 x 220) - (5 x 30) = 1400 - 1100 - 150 = 150 lb. Yes, you have  
enough load capacity in your vehicle to transport four friends and  
your golf bags. In metric units, the calculation would be: 635 kg - (5 x  
99 kg) - (5 x 13.5 kg) = 635 - 495 - 67.5 = 72.5 kg.  
A final example for your vehicle with 1,400 lb. (635 kg) of cargo and  
luggage capacity. You and one of your friends decide to pick up  
cement from the local home improvement store to finish that patio  
you have been planning for the past 2 years. Measuring the inside of  
the vehicle with the rear seat folded down, you have room for  
12-100 lb. (45 kg) bags of cement. Do you have enough load capacity  
173  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
to transport the cement to your home? If you and your friend each  
weigh 220 lb. (99 kg), the calculation would be: 1400 - (2 x 220) - (12  
x 100) = 1400 - 440 - 1200 = - 240 lb. No, you do not have enough  
cargo capacity to carry that much weight. In metric units, the  
calculation would be: 635 kg - (2 x 99 kg) - (12 x 45 kg) = 635 - 198 -  
540 = -103 kg. You will need to reduce the load weight by at least  
240 lb. (104 kg). If you remove 3-100 lb. (45 kg) cement bags, then  
the load calculation would be:  
1400 - (2 x 220) - (9 x 100) = 1400 - 440 - 900 = 60 lb. Now you have  
the load capacity to transport the cement and your friend home. In  
metric units, the calculation would be: 635 kg - (2 x 99 kg) - (9 x  
45 kg) = 635 - 198 - 405 = 32 kg.  
The above calculations also assume that the loads are positioned in your  
vehicle in a manner that does not overload the Front or the Rear Gross  
Axle Weight Rating specified for your vehicle on the Safety Compliance  
Certification Label found on the edge of the driver’s door.  
Special loading instructions for owners of pickup trucks and  
utility-type vehicles  
WARNING: For important information regarding safe operation  
of this type of vehicle, see the Preparing to drive your vehicle  
section in the Driving chapter of this Owner’s Guide.  
WARNING: Loaded vehicles may handle differently than  
unloaded vehicles. Extra precautions, such as slower speeds and  
increased stopping distance, should be taken when driving a heavily  
loaded vehicle.  
Your vehicle can haul more cargo and people than most passenger cars.  
Depending upon the type and placement of the load, hauling cargo and  
people may raise the center of gravity of the vehicle.  
TRAILER TOWING  
Refer to 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Power Stroke Direct Injection Turbo Diesel  
Owner’s Guide Supplement for Diesel engine towing information.  
Your vehicle may tow a class I, II or III trailer, provided the maximum  
trailer weight is less than or equal to the maximum trailer weight listed  
for your engine and rear axle ratio on the following charts.  
174  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)/Trailer Weights  
Maximum  
Rear  
axle  
ratio  
Maximum Maximum Loaded  
GCWR - lb. Trailer Weight -  
frontal area of  
trailer - ft2  
(m2)  
Engine  
(kg)  
lb. (kg)  
E-150 Regular/RV Van (8520 GVWR)  
11500  
4.6L  
4.6L  
3.73  
4.10  
6000 (2722)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5216)  
12000  
(5443)  
6500 (2948)  
E-150 Regular Wagon (7/8 Passenger) (8520 GVWR)  
11500  
4.6L  
4.6L  
3.73  
4.10  
5600 (2540)  
6100 (2767)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5216)  
12000  
(5443)  
E-150 Regular/RV Van (8600 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
5.4L  
3.73  
4.10  
7400 (3357)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
13000  
(5897)  
7400 (3357)  
E-150 Extended Van (8600 GVWR)  
11500  
4.6L  
4.6L  
3.73  
4.10  
5900 (2676)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5216)  
12000  
(5443)  
6400 (2903)  
E-150 Extended Van (8600 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
5.4L  
3.73  
4.10  
7300 (3311)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
13000  
(5897)  
7300 (3311)  
E-150 Regular Wagon (7/8 Passenger) (8600 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
5.4L  
3.73  
4.10  
7000 (3175)  
7000 (3175)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
13000  
(5897)  
175  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)/Trailer Weights  
Maximum  
Rear  
axle  
ratio  
Maximum Maximum Loaded  
GCWR - lb. Trailer Weight -  
frontal area of  
trailer - ft2  
(m2)  
Engine  
(kg)  
lb. (kg)  
E-250 Regular/RV Van (8900 GVWR)  
11500  
4.6L  
4.6L  
3.73  
4.10  
6000 (2722)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5216)  
12000  
(5443)  
6500 (2948)  
E-250 Extended/RV Van (8900 GVWR)  
11500  
4.6L  
4.6L  
3.73  
5900 (2676)  
6400 (2903)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5216)  
12000  
(5443)  
4.10  
E-250 Regular/RV Van (9000 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
5.4L  
3.73  
4.10  
7400 (3357)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5896)  
13000  
(5896)  
7400 (3357)  
E-250 Cutaway (138” wheelbase, single rear wheel)  
(8600 GVWR)  
12000  
(5443)  
4.6L  
4.10  
7500 (3402)  
60 (5.52)  
E-250 Extended/RV Van (9000 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
5.4L  
3.73  
4.10  
7300 (3311)  
7300 (3311)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5896)  
13000  
(5896)  
176  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)/Trailer Weights  
Maximum  
Rear  
axle  
ratio  
Maximum Maximum Loaded  
GCWR - lb. Trailer Weight -  
frontal area of  
trailer - ft2  
(m2)  
Engine  
(kg)  
lb. (kg)  
E-350 Regular/RV Van (9500 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
5.4L  
6.8L  
6.8L  
3.73  
4.10  
3.73  
4.10  
7300 (3311)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
13000  
(5897)  
15000  
(6804)  
18500  
(8391)  
7300 (3311)  
9100 (4128)  
10000 (4536)  
E-350 Extended/RV Van (9500 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
5.4L  
6.8L  
6.8L  
3.73  
7200 (3266)  
7200 (3266)  
9000 (4082)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
13000  
(5897)  
15000  
(6804)  
18500  
(8391)  
4.10  
3.73  
4.10  
E-350 Regular Wagon (11/12 Passenger) (8800 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
5.4L  
3.73  
4.10  
6700 (3039)  
6700 (3039)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
13000  
(5897)  
E-350 Regular Wagon (11/12 Passenger) (8700 GVWR)  
15000  
6.8L  
6.8L  
3.73  
4.10  
8500 (3856)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(6804)  
18500  
(8391)  
177  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)/Trailer Weights  
Maximum  
Rear  
axle  
ratio  
Maximum Maximum Loaded  
GCWR - lb. Trailer Weight -  
frontal area of  
trailer - ft2  
(m2)  
Engine  
(kg)  
lb. (kg)  
E-350 Extended Wagon (11 Passenger) (9300 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
5.4L  
3.73  
4.10  
6500 (2948)  
6500 (2948)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
13000  
(5897)  
E-350 Extended Wagon (11 Passenger) (9500 GVWR)  
15000  
6.8L  
6.8L  
3.73  
4.10  
8300 (3765 )  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(6804)  
18500  
(8391)  
E-350 Extended Wagon (14/15 Passenger) (9100 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
5.4L  
3.73  
4.10  
6300 (2858)  
6300 (2858)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
13000  
(5897)  
E-350 Extended Wagon (14/15 Passenger) (9300 GVWR)  
15000  
6.8L  
6.8L  
3.73  
4.10  
8100 (3674)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(6804)  
18500  
(8391)  
E-350 Cutaway (138” wheelbase, single rear wheel)  
(9600 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
8000 (3629)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
18500  
(8391)  
E-350 Extended Cutaway (138” wheelbase, single rear wheel)  
(9600 GVWR)  
10600  
(4808)  
5.4L  
4.10  
5700 (2585)  
60 (5.52)  
178  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)/Trailer Weights  
Maximum  
Rear  
axle  
ratio  
Maximum Maximum Loaded  
GCWR - lb. Trailer Weight -  
frontal area of  
trailer - ft2  
(m2)  
Engine  
(kg)  
lb. (kg)  
E-350 Cutaway (138” wheelbase, single rear wheel, 4–speed  
automatic transmission) (9600 GVWR)  
5.4L  
3.73  
9600 (4355)  
4700 (2132)  
60 (5.52)  
E-350 Cutaway (138” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(10000 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
7700 (3492)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
18500  
(8391)  
E-350 Cutaway (138” wheelbase, dual rear wheel, 4–speed  
automatic transmission) (10000 GVWR)  
10050  
(4559)  
5.4L  
3.73  
4900 (2223)  
60 (5.52)  
E-350 Cutaway (138” wheelbase, single rear wheel)  
(10050 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
8000 (3629)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
18500  
(8391)  
E-350 Cutaway (138” wheelbase, dual rear wheel, 4–speed  
automatic transmission) (10050 GVWR)  
10050  
(4559)  
5.4L  
3.73  
4900 (2223)  
60 (5.52)  
E-350 Cutaway (138” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(11500 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
7700 (3493)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
18500  
(8391)  
E-350 Cutaway (158” wheelbase, single rear wheel, 4–speed  
automatic transmission) (9600 GVWR)  
5.4L  
3.73  
9600 (4355)  
4600 (2087)  
60 (5.52)  
179  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)/Trailer Weights  
Maximum  
Rear  
axle  
ratio  
Maximum Maximum Loaded  
GCWR - lb. Trailer Weight -  
frontal area of  
trailer - ft2  
(m2)  
Engine  
(kg)  
lb. (kg)  
E-350 Cutaway (158” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(10000 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
7700 (3493)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
18500  
(8391)  
E-350 Cutaway (158” wheelbase, dual rear wheel, 4–speed  
automatic transmission) (10000 GVWR)  
10050  
(4559)  
5.4L  
3.73  
4800 (2177)  
60 (5.52)  
E-350 Cutaway (158” wheelbase, single rear wheel)  
(10050 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
8000 (3629)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
18500  
(8391)  
E-350 Cutaway (158” wheelbase, dual rear wheel, 4–speed  
automatic transmission) (10050 GVWR)  
10050  
(4559)  
5.4L  
3.73  
4800 (2177)  
60 (5.52)  
E-350 Cutaway (158” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(11500 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
7700 (3493)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
18500  
(8391)  
E-350 Cutaway (158” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(12500 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
7700 (3493)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
18500  
(8391)  
180  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)/Trailer Weights  
Maximum  
Rear  
axle  
ratio  
Maximum Maximum Loaded  
GCWR - lb. Trailer Weight -  
frontal area of  
trailer - ft2  
(m2)  
Engine  
(kg)  
lb. (kg)  
E-350 Cutaway (176” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(10000 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
7700 (3493)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
18500  
(8391)  
E-350 Cutaway (176” wheelbase, dual rear wheel, 4–speed  
automatic transmission) (10000 GVWR)  
10050  
(4559)  
5.4L  
3.73  
4800 (2177)  
60 (5.52)  
E-350 Cutaway (176” wheelbase, dual rear wheel, 4–speed  
automatic transmission) (10050 GVWR)  
10050  
(4559)  
5.4L  
3.73  
4800 (2177)  
60 (5.52)  
E-350 Cutaway (176” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(12500 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
7700 (3493)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
18500  
(8391)  
E-350 Stripped Chassis (138” wheelbase, single rear wheel)  
(9000 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
5.4L  
3.73  
4.10  
8700 (3946)  
8700 (3946)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
13000  
(5897)  
E-350 Stripped Chassis (158” wheelbase, single rear wheel)  
(9600 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
5.4L  
3.73  
4.10  
8600 (3901)  
8600 (3901)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
13000  
(5897)  
181  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)/Trailer Weights  
Maximum  
Rear  
axle  
ratio  
Maximum Maximum Loaded  
GCWR - lb. Trailer Weight -  
frontal area of  
trailer - ft2  
(m2)  
Engine  
(kg)  
lb. (kg)  
E-350 Stripped Chassis (138” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(10000 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
8400 (3810)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
18500  
(8391)  
E-350 Stripped Chassis (138” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(11500 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
8400 (3810)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
18500  
(8391)  
E-350 Stripped Chassis (158” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(10000 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
8300 (3765)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
18500  
(8391)  
E-350 Stripped Chassis (158” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(12500 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
8300 (3765)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
18500  
(8391)  
E-350 Stripped Chassis (176” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(10000 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
8300 (3765)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
18500  
(8391)  
182  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)/Trailer Weights  
Maximum  
Rear  
axle  
ratio  
Maximum Maximum Loaded  
GCWR - lb. Trailer Weight -  
frontal area of  
trailer - ft2  
(m2)  
Engine  
(kg)  
lb. (kg)  
E-350 Stripped Chassis (176” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(12500 GVWR)  
13000  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
8300 (3765)  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
60 (5.52)  
(5897)  
18500  
(8391)  
E-450 Cutaway (158” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(14050 GVWR)  
14050  
5.4L  
5.4L  
6.8L  
6.8L  
4.56  
8500 (3855)  
60 (5.52)  
(6373)  
E-450 Cutaway (176” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(14050 GVWR)  
14050  
(6373)  
4.56  
8500 (3855)  
60 (5.52)  
E-450 Cutaway (158” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(14500 GVWR)  
20000  
(9072)  
4.56  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
E-450 Cutaway (176” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(14500 GVWR)  
20000  
(9072)  
4.56  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
E-450 Stripped Chassis (158” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(14050 GVWR)  
14050  
(6373)  
5.4L  
4.56  
9200 (4173)  
60 (5.52)  
E-450 Stripped Chassis (176” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(14050 GVWR)  
14050  
(6372)  
5.4L  
4.56  
9200 (4173)  
60 (5.52)  
183  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)/Trailer Weights  
Maximum  
Rear  
axle  
ratio  
Maximum Maximum Loaded  
GCWR - lb. Trailer Weight -  
frontal area of  
trailer - ft2  
(m2)  
Engine  
(kg)  
lb. (kg)  
E-450 Stripped Chassis (158” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(14500 GVWR)  
20000  
(9072)  
6.8L  
4.56  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
E-450 Stripped Chassis (176” wheelbase, dual rear wheel)  
(14500 GVWR)  
20000  
(9072)  
6.8L  
4.56  
10000 (4536)  
60 (5.52)  
Maximum trailer weight for all cutaway (E-350 and E-450) vehicles  
must be calculated by subtracting the weight of the vehicle (including  
incomplete vehicle weight and payload which includes second unit  
body weight, cargo and passengers) from the GCW. Otherwise,  
maximum trailer weight is 10,000 lb. (4,536 kg).  
For high altitude operation reduce GCWR by 2% per 1,000 ft.  
(300 meters) elevation.  
To determine the maximum trailer weight designed for your particular  
vehicle as equipped, follow the section Vehicle loading earlier in this  
chapter.  
Your vehicle’s load capacity is designated by weight, not by volume, so  
you cannot necessarily use all available space when loading a vehicle.  
Distribute the load so that only 10–15% of the total is on the tongue. Tie  
down the load so that it does not shift and change the weight on the  
hitch.  
Towing a trailer places an additional load on your vehicle’s engine,  
transmission, axle, brakes, tires and suspension. Inspect these  
components carefully after any towing operation.  
Do not exceed trailer weight of 5,000 lb (2,268 kg) when towing with  
bumper only.  
WARNING: Do not exceed the GVWR or the GAWR specified on  
the certification label.  
184  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: Towing trailers beyond the maximum recommended  
gross trailer weight exceeds the limit of the vehicle and could  
result in engine damage, transmission damage, structural damage, loss  
of vehicle control, vehicle rollover and personal injury.  
Preparing to tow  
Use the proper equipment for towing a trailer and make sure it is  
properly attached to your vehicle. Contact your authorized dealer or a  
reliable trailer dealer as soon as possible if you require assistance.  
Hitches  
Do not use or install hitches that clamp onto the bumper or to the axle.  
Underbody hitches are acceptable if installed properly.  
Safety chains  
Always connect the trailer’s safety chains to the frame or hook retainers  
of the vehicle hitch. To connect the trailer’s safety chains, cross the  
chains under the trailer tongue and allow slack for turning corners.  
If you use a rental trailer, follow the instructions that the rental agency  
gives to you.  
Do not attach safety chains to the bumper.  
Trailer brakes  
Electric brakes and manual, automatic or surge-type trailer brakes are  
safe if installed properly and adjusted to the manufacturer’s  
specifications. The trailer brakes must meet local and Federal  
regulations.  
WARNING: Do not connect a trailer’s hydraulic brake system  
directly to your vehicle’s brake system. Your vehicle may not  
have enough braking power and your chances of having a collision  
greatly increase.  
The braking system of the tow vehicle is rated for operation at the  
GVWR not GCWR.  
Integrated trailer brake controller (if equipped)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a fully integrated electronic Trailer  
Brake Controller (TBC). When used properly, the TBC helps ensure  
185  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
smooth and effective trailer braking by powering the trailer’s electric  
brakes with a proportional output based on the towing vehicle’s brake  
pressure.  
WARNING: The Ford TBC has only been verified to be  
compatible with trailers having electric-actuated drum brakes  
(one to four axles) and not hydraulic surge or electric-over-hydraulic  
types. It is the responsibility of the customer to ensure that the trailer  
brakes are adjusted appropriately, functioning normally and all electric  
connections are properly made.  
The TBC user interface consists of  
the following:  
1. +/- (GAIN adjustment  
buttons): Pressing these buttons  
will adjust the TBC’s power output  
to the trailer brakes (in  
0.5 increments). The GAIN setting  
can be increased to a maximum of  
10.0 or decreased to a minimum of 0 (no trailer braking). Pressing and  
holding a button will raise or lower the setting continuously. The gain  
setting will display in the message center as follows: TBC GAIN = XX.X.  
The trailer brake controller (TBC) is designed to display three items of  
information in the instrument cluster message center. These are: gain  
setting, output bar graph, and trailer connectivity status. They will  
appear as follows in the message center.  
TBC GAIN = XX.X NO TRAILER: The instrument cluster message  
center will display the current gain setting during a given ignition  
cycle and when adjusting the gain. This message is also displayed  
during manual activation without a trailer connected or when gain  
adjustments are made with no trailer connected.  
TBC GAIN = XX.X OUTPUT = //////: When the vehicle’s brake pedal  
is pushed, or when the manual control is activated, bar indicators will  
illuminate in the instrument cluster message center to indicate the  
amount of power going to the trailer brakes relative to the brake pedal  
or manual control input. One bar indicates the least amount of output  
with six bars indicating maximum output.  
TRAILER CONNECTED: This message is displayed when a correct  
trailer wiring connection (a trailer with electric trailer brakes) has  
been sensed during a given ignition cycle.  
186  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
TRAILER DISCONNECTED: This message is displayed and  
accompanied by a single chime, when a trailer connection was  
determined and then a disconnection, either intentionally or  
unintentionally, has been sensed during a given ignition cycle. It is also  
displayed if a truck or trailer wiring fault occurs causing the trailer to  
appear disconnected. This message is also displayed during manual  
activation without a trailer connected.  
2. Manual control lever: Slide the control lever to the left to activate  
power to the trailer’s electric brakes independent of the tow vehicle’s  
brakes (see the following Procedure for adjusting GAIN section for  
instructions on proper use of this feature). If the manual control is  
activated while the brake is also applied, the greater of the two inputs  
determines the power sent to the trailer brakes.  
Stop Lamps: Activating the TBC manual control lever will illuminate  
both the trailer brake lamps and the tow vehicle brake lamps except  
the Center High-Mount Stop Lamp (presuming proper trailer electrical  
connection). Pressing the vehicle brake pedal will also illuminate both  
trailer and vehicle brake lamps.  
Procedure for adjusting GAIN:  
The GAIN setting is used to set the TBC for the specific towing  
condition and should be changed as towing conditions change. Changes  
to towing conditions include trailer load, vehicle load, road conditions  
and weather.  
The GAIN should be set to provide the maximum trailer braking  
assistance while ensuring the trailer wheels do not lock when braking.  
Locked trailer wheels may lead to trailer instability.  
Note: This should only be performed in a traffic free environment at  
speeds of approximately 20–25 mph (30–40 km/h).  
1. Make sure the trailer brakes are in good working condition,  
functioning normally, and properly adjusted. See your trailer dealer if  
necessary.  
2. Hook up the trailer and make the electrical connections according to  
the trailer manufacturer’s instructions.  
3. When a trailer with electric brakes is plugged in, the TRAILER  
CONNECTED message will display in the instrument cluster message  
center.  
4. Use the GAIN adjustment (+/-) buttons to increase or decrease the  
GAIN setting to the desired starting point. A GAIN setting of 6.0 is a  
good starting point for heavier loads.  
187  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
5. In a traffic-free environment, tow the trailer on a dry, level surface at  
a speed of 20–25 mph (30–40 km/h) and squeeze the manual control  
lever completely.  
6. If the trailer wheels lock-up (indicated by squealing tires), reduce the  
GAIN setting; if the trailer wheels turn freely, increase the GAIN setting.  
Repeat Steps 5 and 6 until the GAIN setting is at a point just below  
trailer wheel lock-up. If towing a heavier trailer, trailer wheel lockup may  
not be attainable even with the maximum GAIN setting of 10.  
Explanation of instrument cluster warning messages:  
The TBC interacts with the instrument cluster message center to display  
the following messages:  
TRAILER BRAKE MODULE FAULT: This message is displayed and  
accompanied by a single chime, in response to faults sensed by the TBC.  
In the event this message is seen, please contact your authorized dealer  
as soon as possible for diagnosis and repair. The TBC may still function,  
but performance may be degraded.  
WIRING FAULT ON TRAILER: This message is displayed when a  
Short circuit on the electric brake output wire has occurred. If the  
WIRING FAULT ON TRAILER message is displayed and accompanied  
by a single chime, with no trailer connected, the problem is with the  
vehicle wiring from the TBC to the 7–pin connector in the bumper. If the  
message is only displayed with a trailer connected, the problem is related  
to the trailer wiring; consult your trailer dealer for assistance. This can  
be a short to ground (i.e., chaffed wire) or a short to voltage (i.e., pulled  
pin on trailer emergency break-away battery) or trailer brakes drawing  
too much current.  
Note: Your TBC can be diagnosed by your authorized dealer to  
determine exactly which trailer fault has occurred; however, if the fault  
is with the trailer this diagnosis is not covered under your Ford  
warranty.  
Points to Remember:  
Remember to adjust gain setting before using the TBC for the first  
time.  
Readjust GAIN setting on the TBC (according to procedure above)  
whenever road, weather and trailer or vehicle loading conditions  
change from those that existed when the gain was initially set.  
The sliding lever on the TBC should be used only for manual  
activation of trailer brakes to assist with proper adjustment of the  
GAIN. Misuse, such as application during trailer sway, could cause  
instability of trailer and/or tow vehicle.  
188  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Avoid towing in adverse weather conditions. The TBC does not  
provide anti-lock control of the trailer wheels. Trailer wheels can  
lock-up on slippery surfaces, resulting in reduced stability of trailer  
and tow vehicle.  
The TBC interacts with the brake system of the vehicle, including  
ABS, in order to reduce the likelihood of trailer wheel lockup.  
Therefore, if these systems are not functioning properly the TBC may  
not function at full performance.  
When the vehicle is turned off, the TBC Output is disabled and the  
display is shut down. Reactivation of the ignition from OFF to ON will  
awaken the TBC module.  
The TBC is only a factory or dealer installed item. Ford is not  
responsible for warranty or performance of the TBC due to misuse or  
customer installation.  
Do not attempt removal of the TBC without consulting the  
Workshop Manual. Damage to the unit may result.  
Trailer lamps  
Trailer lamps are required on most towed vehicles. Make sure all running  
lights, brake lights, turn signals and hazard lights are working. Contact  
your authorized dealer or trailer rental agency for proper instructions  
and equipment for hooking up trailer lamps.  
Using a step bumper (if equipped)  
The rear bumper is equipped with an integral hitch and only requires a  
ball with a one inch (25.4 mm) shank diameter. The bumper has a  
5,000 lb (2,270 kg) trailer weight and 500 lb (227 kg) tongue weight  
capacity.  
If it is necessary to relocate the trailer hitch ball position, a  
frame-mounted trailer hitch must be installed.  
Driving while you tow  
When towing a trailer:  
To ensure proper “break-in” of powertrain components, do not trailer  
tow during the first 1,000 miles (1,600 km) of a new vehicle.  
To ensure proper “break-in” of powertrain components during the first  
500 miles (800 km) of trailer towing, drive no faster than 70 mph  
(113 km/h) with no full throttle starts.  
Turn off the speed control. The speed control may shut off  
automatically when you are towing on long, steep grades.  
189  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Consult your local motor vehicle speed regulations for towing a trailer.  
To eliminate excessive shifting, use a lower gear. This will also assist  
in transmission cooling.  
Anticipate stops and brake gradually.  
When descending long, steep downhill grades, always use a lower gear to  
provide engine braking to save wear on brakes. Use Drive (Overdrive  
OFF) on moderately steep hills, Second (2) on steep hills, and First (1)  
on very steep hills. Do not apply your brakes continuously, as they  
may overheat and become less effective.  
Servicing after towing  
If you tow a trailer for long distances, your vehicle will require more  
frequent service intervals. Refer to your scheduled maintenance  
information for more information.  
Trailer towing tips  
Practice turning, stopping and backing up before starting on a trip to  
get the feel of the vehicle trailer combination. When turning, make  
wider turns so the trailer wheels will clear curbs and other obstacles.  
Allow more distance for stopping with a trailer attached.  
The trailer tongue weight should be 10–15% of the loaded trailer  
weight.  
If you will be towing a trailer frequently in hot weather, hilly  
conditions, at GCWR, or any combination of these factors, consider  
refilling your rear axle with synthetic gear lube if not already so  
equipped. Refer to the Maintenance and specifications chapter for  
the lubricant specification. Remember that regardless of the rear axle  
lube used, do not tow a trailer for the first 1,000 miles (1,600 km) of a  
new vehicle, and that the first 500 miles (800 km) of towing be done  
at no faster than 70 mph (113 km/h) with no full throttle starts.  
Do not tow a trailer for the first 500 miles (800 km) after changing  
the rear axle lube.  
After you have traveled 50 miles (80 km), thoroughly check your  
hitch, electrical connections and trailer wheel lug nuts.  
When stopped in traffic for long periods of time in hot weather, place  
the gearshift in P (Park) and increase idle speed. This aids engine  
cooling and air conditioner efficiency.  
Vehicles with trailers should not be parked on a grade. If you must  
park on a grade, place wheel chocks under the trailer’s wheels.  
190  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Launching or retrieving a boat  
Disconnect the wiring to the trailer before backing the trailer  
into the water. Reconnect the wiring to the trailer after the  
trailer is removed from the water.  
When backing down a ramp during boat launching or retrieval:  
do not allow the static water level to rise above the bottom edge of  
the rear bumper.  
do not allow waves to break higher than 6 inches (15 cm) above the  
bottom edge of the rear bumper.  
Exceeding these limits may allow water to enter vehicle components:  
causing internal damage to the components.  
affecting driveability, emissions and reliability.  
Replace the rear axle lubricant any time the axle has been submerged in  
water. Rear axle lubricant quantities are not to be checked or changed  
unless a leak is suspected or repair required.  
RECREATIONAL TOWING  
Follow these guidelines if you have a need for recreational (RV) towing.  
An example of recreational towing would be towing your vehicle behind  
a motorhome. These guidelines are designed to ensure that your  
transmission is not damaged.  
All vehicles: Do not tow your vehicle with any wheels on the ground, as  
vehicle or transmission damage may occur. It is recommended to tow  
your vehicle with all four (4) wheels off the ground such as when using a  
car-hauling trailer. Otherwise, no recreational towing is permitted.  
In case of a roadside emergency with a disabled vehicle, see Wrecker  
towing in the Roadside Emergencies chapter.  
191  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
STARTING  
Positions of the ignition  
1. Accessory — allows the electrical  
accessories such as the radio to  
operate while the engine is not  
running.  
4
3
1
5
2. Lock — locks the automatic  
transmission gearshift lever and  
allows key removal.  
2
3. Off — shuts off the engine and all  
accessories without locking the  
steering wheel.  
4. On — all electrical circuits operational. Warning lights illuminated. Key  
position when driving.  
5. Start — cranks the engine. Release the key as soon as the engine  
starts.  
Preparing to start your vehicle  
Engine starting is controlled by the powertrain control system.  
This system meets all Canadian interference-causing equipment standard  
requirements regulating the impulse electrical field strength of radio  
noise.  
When starting a fuel-injected engine, don’t press the accelerator before  
or during starting. Only use the accelerator when you have difficulty  
starting the engine. For more information on starting the vehicle, refer to  
Starting the engine in this chapter.  
WARNING: Extended idling at high engine speeds can produce  
very high temperatures in the engine and exhaust system,  
creating the risk of fire or other damage.  
WARNING: Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle in dry grass  
or other dry ground cover. The emission system heats up the  
engine compartment and exhaust system, which can start a fire.  
192  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: Do not start your vehicle in a closed garage or in  
other enclosed areas. Exhaust fumes can be toxic. Always open  
the garage door before you start the engine. See Guarding against  
exhaust fumes in this chapter for more instructions.  
WARNING: If you smell exhaust fumes inside your vehicle, have  
your dealer inspect your vehicle immediately. Do not drive if you  
smell exhaust fumes.  
Important safety precautions  
When the engine starts, the idle RPM runs faster to warm the engine. If  
the engine idle speed does not slow down automatically, have the vehicle  
checked. If your vehicle is operated in a heavy snow storm or blowing  
snow conditions, the engine air induction may become partially clogged  
with snow and/or ice. If this occurs, the engine may experience a  
significant reduction in power output. At the earliest opportunity, clear  
all the snow and/or ice away from the air induction inlet.  
Before starting the vehicle:  
1. Make sure all occupants buckle their safety belts. For more  
information on safety belts and their proper usage, refer to the Seating  
and Safety Restraints chapter.  
2. Make sure the headlamps and electrical accessories are off.  
Make sure the parking brake is  
set.  
Make sure the gearshift is in P  
(Park).  
193  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Turn the key to 4 (on) without  
turning the key to 5 (start).  
4
3
1
5
2
Some warning lights will briefly illuminate. See Warning lights and  
chimes in the Instrument Cluster chapter for more information  
regarding the warning lights.  
Starting the engine  
1. Turn the key to 4 (on) without  
turning the key to 5 (start).  
4
2. Turn the key to 5 (start), then  
release the key as soon as the  
engine starts. Excessive cranking  
could damage the starter.  
3
5
2
1
Note: If the engine does not start within five seconds on the first try,  
turn the key to 3 (off), wait 10 seconds and try again. If the engine still  
fails to start, press the accelerator to the floor and try again; this will  
allow the engine to crank with the fuel shut off in case the engine is  
flooded with fuel.  
Cold weather starting (flexible fuel vehicles only)  
The starting characteristics of all grades of E85 ethanol make it  
unsuitable for use when ambient temperatures fall below 0°F (-18°C).  
Consult your fuel distributor for the availability of winter grade ethanol.  
As the outside temperature approaches freezing, ethanol fuel distributors  
should supply winter grade ethanol (same as with unleaded gasoline). If  
summer grade ethanol is used in cold weather conditions, 0°F to 32°F  
(-18°C to 0°C), you may experience increased cranking times, rough idle  
or hesitation until the engine has warmed up.  
194  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
You may experience a decrease in peak performance when the engine is  
cold when operating on E85 ethanol.  
Do not crank the engine for more than 10 seconds at a time as starter  
damage may occur. If the engine fails to start, turn the key to off and  
wait 30 seconds before trying again.  
Do not use starting fluid such as ether in the air intake system. Such  
fluid could cause immediate explosive damage to the engine and possible  
personal injury.  
If you should experience cold weather starting problems on E85 ethanol,  
and neither an alternative brand of E85 ethanol nor an engine block  
heater is available, the addition of unleaded gasoline to your tank will  
improve cold starting performance. Your vehicle is designed to operate  
on E85 ethanol alone, unleaded gasoline alone, or any mixture of the two.  
See Choosing the right fuel in the Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter for more information on ethanol.  
Guarding against exhaust fumes  
Carbon monoxide is present in exhaust fumes. Take precautions to avoid  
its dangerous effects.  
WARNING: If you smell exhaust fumes inside your vehicle, have  
your dealer inspect your vehicle immediately. Do not drive if you  
smell exhaust fumes.  
Important ventilating information  
If the engine is idling while the vehicle is stopped for a long period of  
time, open the windows at least 1 inch (2.5 cm) or adjust the heating or  
air conditioning to bring in fresh air.  
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER (IF EQUIPPED)  
An engine block heater warms the engine coolant which aids in starting  
and allows the heater/defroster system to respond quickly. If your vehicle  
is equipped with this system, your equipment includes a heater element  
which is installed in your engine block and a wire harness which allows  
the user to connect the system to a grounded 120 volt A/C electrical  
source. The block heater system is most effective when outdoor  
temperatures reach below 0°F (-18°C).  
For flexible fuel vehicles, if operating with E85 ethanol, an engine block  
heater must be used if ambient temperature is below 0°F (-18°C).  
195  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
See Cold weather starting earlier in this chapter for more information  
on starting with ethanol.  
WARNING: Failure to follow engine block heater instructions  
could result in property damage or physical injury.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of electrical shock, do not use  
your heater with ungrounded electrical systems or two-pronged  
(cheater) adapters.  
Prior to using the engine block heater, follow these recommendations for  
proper and safe operation:  
For your safety, use an outdoor extension cord that is product  
certified by Underwriter’s Laboratory (UL) or Canadian Standards  
Association (CSA). Use only an extension cord that can be used  
outdoors, in cold temperatures, and is clearly marked “Suitable for Use  
with Outdoor Appliances.” Never use an indoor extension cord  
outdoors; it could result in an electric shock or fire hazard.  
Use a 16 gauge outdoor extension cord, minimum.  
Use as short an extension cord as possible.  
Do not use multiple extension cords. Instead, use one extension cord  
which is long enough to reach from the engine block heater cord to  
the outlet without stretching.  
Make certain that the extension cord is in excellent condition (not  
patched or spliced). Store your extension cord indoors at  
temperatures above 32°F (0°C). Outdoor conditions can deteriorate  
extension cords over a period of time.  
To reduce the risk of electrical shock, do not use your heater with  
ungrounded electrical systems or two pronged (cheater) adapters.  
Also ensure that the block heater, especially the cord, is in good  
condition before use.  
Make sure that when in operation, the extension cord plug /engine  
block heater cord plug connection is free and clear of water in order  
to prevent possible shock or fire.  
Be sure that areas where the vehicle is parked are clean and clear of  
all combustibles such as petroleum products, dust, rags, paper and  
similar items.  
Be sure that the engine block heater, heater cord and extension cord  
are solidly connected. A poor connection can cause the cord to  
196  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
become very hot and may result in an electrical shock or fire. Be sure  
to check for heat anywhere in the electrical hookup once the system  
has been operating for approximately a half hour.  
Finally, have the engine block heater system checked during your fall  
tune-up to be sure it’s in good working order.  
How to use the engine block heater  
Ensure the receptacle terminals are clean and dry prior to use. To clean  
them, use a dry cloth.  
Depending on the type of factory installed equipment, your engine block  
heater system may consume anywhere between 400 watts or 1000 watts  
of power per hour. Your factory installed block heater system does not  
have a thermostat; however, maximum temperature is attained after  
approximately three hours of operation. Block heater operation longer  
than three hours will not improve system performance and will  
unnecessarily use additional electricity.  
Make sure system is unplugged and properly stowed before driving the  
vehicle. While not in use, make sure the protective cover seals the  
prongs of the engine block heater cord plug.  
BRAKES  
Occasional brake noise is normal. If a metal-to-metal, continuous grinding  
or continuous squeal sound is present, the brake linings may be worn-out  
and should be inspected by an authorized dealer. If the vehicle has  
continuous vibration or shudder in the steering wheel while braking, the  
vehicle should be inspected by an authorized dealer.  
Refer to Warning lights and  
!
P
chimes in the Instrument Cluster  
chapter for information on the brake  
system warning light.  
BRAKE  
Four-wheel anti-lock brake system (ABS)  
Your vehicle is equipped with an anti-lock braking system (ABS). This  
system helps you maintain steering control during emergency stops by  
keeping the brakes from locking. Noise from the ABS pump motor and  
brake pedal pulsation may be observed during ABS braking and the  
brake pedal may suddenly travel a little farther as soon as ABS braking is  
done and normal brake operation resumes. These are normal  
characteristics of the ABS and should be no reason for concern.  
197  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Using ABS  
When hard braking is required, apply continuous force on the brake  
pedal; do not pump the brake pedal since this will reduce the  
effectiveness of the ABS and will increase your vehicle’s stopping  
distance. The ABS will be activated immediately, allowing you to retain  
steering control during hard braking and on slippery surfaces. However,  
the ABS does not decrease stopping distance.  
ABS warning lamp  
The ABS lamp in the instrument  
cluster momentarily illuminates  
ABS  
when the ignition is turned on. If  
the light does not illuminate during  
start up, remains on or flashes, the  
ABS may be disabled and may need to be serviced.  
Even when the ABS is disabled,  
normal braking is still effective. If  
your BRAKE warning lamp  
illuminates with the parking brake  
released, have your brake system  
serviced immediately by an authorized dealer.  
!
P
BRAKE  
Parking brake  
To set the parking brake (1), press  
the parking brake pedal down until  
the pedal stops.  
To release, pull the lever (2).  
WARNING: Always set the  
parking brake fully and  
make sure that the gearshift is  
securely latched in P (Park).  
The BRAKE warning lamp will  
illuminate and will remain  
illuminated until the parking brake  
is released.  
!
P
BRAKE  
The parking brake is not recommended to stop a moving vehicle.  
However, if the normal brakes fail, the parking brake can be used to stop  
198  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
your vehicle in an emergency. Since the parking brake applies only the  
rear brakes, the vehicle’s stopping distance will increase greatly and the  
handling of your vehicle will be adversely affected.  
TRACTION CONTROL (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a traction control system (TCS). This  
system helps you maintain the stability and steerability of your vehicle,  
especially on slippery road surfaces such as snow- or ice-covered roads  
and gravel roads. The system will allow your vehicle to make better use  
of available traction in these conditions.  
During TCS operation, the traction  
control active light will flash and the  
engine will not “rev-up” when you  
push further on the accelerator. This  
is normal system behavior and  
should be no reason for concern.  
WARNING: Aggressive driving in any road conditions can cause  
you to lose control of your vehicle increasing the risk of severe  
personal injury or property damage. The occurrence of a traction  
control event is an indication that at least some of the tires have  
exceeded their ability to grip the road; this may lead to an increased  
risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and  
death. If you experience a severe road event, SLOW DOWN.  
The TCS switch, located on the  
center console, has an indicator  
light that illuminates steadily in the  
instrument cluster when the system  
is off. The TCS will automatically  
turn on every time the ignition is  
turned off and on. The TCS should  
normally be left on.  
If you should become stuck in snow or ice or on a very slippery road  
surface, try switching the TCS off. This may allow excess wheel spin to  
“dig” the vehicle out and enable a successful “rocking” maneuver.  
Remember to switch the TCS back on once the vehicle is no longer  
stuck.  
If a system fault is detected, the traction control active light will  
illuminate steadily in the instrument cluster, the TCS button will not turn  
the system on or off and your vehicle should be serviced by an  
authorized dealer.  
199  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
ADVANCETRACWITH ROLL STABILITY CONTROL™ (RSC)  
STABILITY ENHANCEMENT SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
WARNING: Vehicle modifications involving braking system,  
aftermarket roof racks, suspension, steering system, tire  
construction and/or wheel/tire size may change the handling  
characteristics of the vehicle and may adversely affect the performance  
of the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem. In addition, installing any  
stereo loudspeakers may interfere with and adversely affect the  
AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem. Install any aftermarket stereo  
loudspeaker as far as possible from the front center console, the  
tunnel, and the front seats in order to minimize the risk of interfering  
with the AdvanceTracwith RSCsensors. Reducing the effectiveness  
of the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem could lead to an increased risk  
of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
WARNING: Remember that even advanced technology cannot  
defy the laws of physics. It’s always possible to lose control of a  
vehicle due to inappropriate driver input for the conditions. Aggressive  
driving on any road condition can cause you to lose control of your  
vehicle increasing the risk of personal injury or property damage.  
Activation of the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem is an indication that  
at least some of the tires have exceeded their ability to grip the road;  
this could reduce the operator’s ability to control the vehicle,  
potentially resulting in a loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover,  
personal injury and death. If your AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem  
activates, SLOW DOWN.  
WARNING: If a failure has been detected within the  
AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem, the “sliding car” icon  
will  
illuminate steadily. Verify that the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem is  
not manually disabled (push the AdvanceTracwith RSC“Off ”  
button located on the center of the instrument panel). If the “sliding  
car” icon  
still illuminates steadily, have the system serviced by an  
authorized dealer immediately. Operating your vehicle with  
AdvanceTracwith RSCdisabled could lead to an increased risk of  
loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
200  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
The AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem provides the following stability  
enhancement features for certain driving situations:  
Traction control system (TCS), which functions to help avoid  
drive-wheel spin and loss of traction.  
Electronic stability control (ESC), which functions to help avoid skids  
or lateral slides  
Roll Stability Control™ (RSC), which functions to help avoid a  
vehicle roll-over.  
The AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem automatically enables each time  
the engine is started. All features of the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem  
(TCS, ESC, and RSC) are active and monitor the vehicle from start-up.  
However, the system will only intervene if the driving situation requires  
it.  
The AdvanceTracwith RSC௡  
system includes an AdvanceTrac௡  
with RSC“Off” button on the  
center of the instrument panel, and  
a “sliding car” icon  
instrument cluster. The “sliding car”  
icon in the instrument cluster  
in the  
will illuminate temporarily during  
start-up as part of a normal system self-check, or during driving if a  
driving situation causes the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem to operate.  
If the “sliding car” icon  
illuminates steadily, verify that the  
AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem is not manually disabled by pressing  
the AdvanceTracwith RSC“Off” button located on the center stack of  
the instrument panel. If the “sliding car” icon  
remains steadily  
illuminated, or if the message center (if equipped) displays SERVICE  
RSC NOW, have the system serviced by an authorized dealer  
immediately.  
When AdvanceTracwith RSCperforms a normal system self-check,  
some drivers may notice a slight movement of the brake, and/or a  
rumble, grunting, or grinding noise after startup and when driving off.  
When an event occurs that activates AdvanceTracwith RSCyou may  
experience the following:  
A slight deceleration of the vehicle  
The “sliding car”  
indicator light will flash.  
A vibration in the pedal when your foot is on the brake pedal  
201  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
If the driving condition is severe and your foot is not on the brake, the  
brake pedal may move as the systems applies higher brake forces. You  
may also hear a whoosh of air from under the instrument panel during  
this severe condition.  
The brake pedal may feel stiffer than usual.  
Traction control system (TCS)  
Traction control is a driver aid feature that helps your vehicle maintain  
traction of the wheels, typically when driving on slippery and/or hilly  
road surfaces, by detecting and controlling wheel spin.  
Excessive wheel spin is controlled in two ways, which may work  
separately or in tandem: Engine traction control and brake traction  
control. Engine traction control works to limit drive-wheel spin by  
momentarily reducing engine power. Brake traction control works to limit  
wheel spin by momentarily applying the brakes to the wheel that is  
slipping. Traction control is most active at low speeds.  
During traction control events the “sliding car” icon  
cluster will flash.  
in the instrument  
If the TCS is activated excessively in a short period of time, the braking  
portion of the system may become temporarily disabled to allow the  
brakes to cool down. In this situation, TCS will use only engine power  
reduction or transfer to help control the wheels from over-spinning.  
When the brakes have cooled down, the system will regain all features.  
Anti-lock braking, RSC, and ESC are not affected by this condition and  
will continue to function during the cool-down period.  
The engine traction control and brake traction control system may be  
deactivated in certain situations. See the Switching off AdvanceTrac௡  
with RSCsection following.  
Electronic stability control (ESC)  
Electronic stability control (ESC) may enhance your vehicle’s directional  
stability during adverse maneuvers, for example when cornering severely  
or avoiding objects in the roadway. ESC operates by applying brakes to  
one or more of the wheels individually and, if necessary, reducing engine  
power if the system detects that the vehicle is about to skid or slide  
laterally.  
During ESC events the “sliding car” icon  
will flash.  
in the instrument cluster  
202  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Certain adverse driving maneuvers may activate the ESC system, which  
include but are not limited to:  
Taking a turn too fast  
Maneuvering quickly to avoid an accident, pedestrian or obstacle  
Driving over a patch of ice or other slippery surfaces  
Changing lanes on a snow-rutted road  
Entering a snow-free road from a snow-covered side street, or vice  
versa  
Entering a paved road from a gravel road, or vice versa  
Cornering while towing a heavily loaded trailer (refer to Trailer  
towing in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter).  
Roll Stability Control™ (RSC)  
Roll Stability Control™ (RSC) may help to maintain roll stability of the  
vehicle during adverse maneuvers. RSCoperates by detecting the  
vehicle’s roll motion and the rate at which it changes and by applying the  
brakes to one or more wheels individually.  
During an event that activates the RSCthe “sliding car” icon  
in the  
instrument cluster will flash.  
Certain adverse driving maneuvers may activate the RSCsystem, which  
include:  
Emergency lane-change  
Taking a turn too fast  
Quick maneuvering to avoid an accident, pedestrian or obstacle  
Switching off AdvanceTracwith RSC௡  
If the vehicle is stuck in snow, mud or sand, and seems to lose engine  
power, switching off certain features of the AdvanceTracwith RSC௡  
system may be beneficial because the wheels are allowed to spin. This  
will restore full engine power and will enhance momentum through the  
obstacle. To switch off the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem partially,  
press the AdvanceTracwith RSC“Off” button below 20 mph  
(32 km/h). Full features of the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem can be  
restored by pressing the AdvanceTracwith RSC“Off” button again or  
if the vehicle is above 20 mph (32 km/h) or by turning off and restarting  
the engine.  
If you switch off the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem below 20 mph  
(32 km/h), the “sliding car” icon  
will illuminate steadily. Pressing the  
203  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
AdvanceTracwith RSC“Off” button again or if the vehicle is above  
20 mph (32 km/h) will turn off the “sliding car”  
icon. The switch will  
not allow partial AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem disabling above  
20 mph (32 km/h).  
In R (Reverse), ABS and the engine traction control and brake traction  
control features will continue to function; however, ESC and RSCare  
disabled.  
AdvanceTracwith RSCFeatures  
“Sliding  
car”  
icon  
Button func-  
tions  
RSC௡  
ESC  
TCS  
Illuminated  
during bulb  
check  
Default at  
start-up  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Disabled  
below  
20 mph  
(32 km/h)  
Button pressed Illuminated  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
momentarily  
solid  
Button pressed  
again after de-  
activation or  
driving above  
20 mph  
Not illumi-  
nated  
Enabled  
(32 km/h)  
STEERING  
To help prevent damage to the power steering system:  
Never hold the steering wheel at its furthest turning points (until it  
stops) for more than a few seconds when the engine is running.  
Do not operate the vehicle with a low power steering pump fluid level  
(If the fluid level is below the FULL COLD range on the dipstick).  
Some noise is normal during operation. If the noise is excessive, check  
for low power steering pump fluid level before seeking service by your  
authorized dealer.  
Heavy or uneven steering efforts may be caused by low power steering  
pump fluid level. Check for low power steering pump fluid level before  
seeking service by your authorized dealer.  
204  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Do not fill the power steering pump reservoir above the FULL COLD  
range on the dipstick, as this may result in leaks from the reservoir.  
If the power steering system breaks down (or if the engine is turned  
off), you can steer the vehicle manually, but it takes more effort.  
If the steering wanders or pulls, check for:  
an improperly inflated tire.  
uneven tire wear.  
loose or worn suspension components.  
loose or worn steering components.  
improper steering alignment.  
A high crown in the road or high crosswinds may also make the steering  
seem to wander/pull.  
TRACTION-LOK AXLE (IF EQUIPPED)  
This axle provides added traction on slippery surfaces, particularly when  
one wheel is on a poor traction surface. Under normal conditions, the  
Traction-Lok axle functions like a standard rear axle. The axle may  
exhibit a slight noise or vibration in tight turns with low vehicle speed.  
This is normal behavior and indicates the axle is working.  
PREPARING TO DRIVE  
WARNING: Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover  
rate than other types of vehicles.  
WARNING: In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is  
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt.  
Utility vehicles and trucks have larger tires and increased ground  
clearance, giving the vehicle a higher center of gravity than a passenger  
car.  
WARNING: Vehicles with a higher center of gravity such as  
utility vehicles and trucks handle differently than vehicles with a  
lower center of gravity. Utility vehicles and trucks are not designed for  
cornering at speeds as high as passenger cars any more than low-slung  
sports cars are designed to perform satisfactorily under off-road  
conditions. Avoid sharp turns, excessive speed or abrupt maneuvers in  
these vehicles. Failure to drive cautiously could result in an increased  
risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and  
death.  
205  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: Loaded vehicles, with a higher center of gravity,  
may handle differently than unloaded vehicles. Do not overload  
your vehicle and use extra precautions, such as driving at slower  
speeds, avoiding abrupt steering changes and allowing for increased  
stopping distance, when driving a heavily loaded vehicle. Over-loading  
or loading the vehicle improperly can deteriorate handling capability  
and contribute to loss of vehicle control and vehicle rollover.  
Vehicle stability and handling  
The risk of a rollover crash increases as the number of people and load  
in the vehicle increase. This increased risk occurs because the passenger  
weight and load raises the vehicle’s center of gravity and causes it to  
shift rearward. As a result, the van has less resistance to rollover and  
handles differently from other commonly driven passenger vehicles,  
making it more difficult to control in an emergency situation. Placing any  
load on the roof also raises the center of gravity and increases the  
potential for rollover.  
The van should be operated by an experienced driver. An organization  
that owns a 15–passenger van should select one or two experienced  
drivers to drive the van on a regular basis. These drivers will gain  
valuable experience handling the van. This experience will help make  
each trip safer.  
The van should be operated at a safe speed which, in some conditions,  
may be less than the posted speed limit.  
Further, all occupants should be properly restrained. Most people killed  
in rollover crashes were unbelted. Occupants can dramatically reduce  
their risk of being killed or seriously injured in a rollover crash by simply  
using their seat belts. Organizations that own 15–passenger vans should  
have a written seat belt use policy. Drivers should be responsible for  
enforcing the policy.  
206  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Emergency maneuvers  
In an unavoidable emergency situation where a sudden sharp turn  
must be made, remember to avoid “over-driving” your vehicle, i.e.,  
turn the steering wheel only as rapidly and as far as required to avoid  
the emergency. Excessive steering will result in less vehicle control,  
not more. Additionally, smooth variations of the accelerator and/or  
brake pedal pressure should be utilized if changes in vehicle speed are  
called for. Avoid abrupt steering, acceleration or braking which could  
result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover  
and/or personal injury. Use all available road surface to return the  
vehicle to a safe direction of travel.  
In the event of an emergency stop, avoid skidding the tires and do not  
attempt any sharp steering wheel movements.  
WARNING: Vehicles with a higher center of gravity such as  
utility and four-wheel drive vehicles handle differently than  
vehicles with a lower center of gravity. Utility and four-wheel drive  
vehicles are not designed for cornering at speeds as high as passenger  
cars any more than low-slung sports cars are designed to perform  
satisfactorily under off-road conditions. Avoid sharp turns, excessive  
speed and abrupt maneuvers in these vehicles. Failure to drive  
cautiously could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control,  
vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
If the vehicle goes from one type of surface to another (i.e., from  
concrete to gravel) there will be a change in the way the vehicle  
responds to a maneuver (steering, acceleration or braking). Again,  
avoid these abrupt inputs.  
BRAKE-SHIFT INTERLOCK  
The vehicle is equipped with a brake-shift interlock feature that prevents  
the gearshift lever from being moved from P (Park) unless the brake  
pedal is pressed.  
If you cannot move the gearshift lever out of P (Park) with ignition in  
the on position and the brake pedal pressed, it is possible that a fuse has  
blown or the vehicle’s brake lamps are not operating properly. Refer to  
Fuses and relays in the Roadside Emergencies chapter.  
207  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
If the fuse is not blown and the brake lamps are working properly, the  
following procedure will allow you to move the gearshift lever from P  
(Park):  
1. Apply the parking brake, and turn  
the ignition to the on position.  
2. Remove the lower trim panel  
under the steering column. Make  
sure not disturb the wires on the  
electrical connector.  
3. Locate the brake-shift interlock  
solenoid underneath the steering  
column.  
4. With your hand, pull back on the  
solenoid, and at the same time, shift  
the transmission into N (Neutral).  
5. Start the vehicle.  
See your authorized dealer as  
soon as possible if this  
procedure is used.  
WARNING: Do not drive your vehicle until you verify that the  
brake lamps are working.  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the lock  
position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
WARNING: If the parking brake is fully released, but the brake  
warning lamp remains illuminated, the brakes may not be  
working properly. See your authorized dealer.  
208  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION OPERATION  
Understanding the gearshift positions of the 4–speed automatic  
transmission  
Your vehicle has been designed to improve fuel economy by reducing  
fuel usage during coasting or deceleration. When you take your foot off  
the accelerator pedal and the vehicle begins to slow down the torque  
converter clutch locks up and aggressively shuts off fuel flow to the  
engine while decelerating. This fuel economy benefit may be perceived  
as a light to medium braking sensation when removing your foot from  
the accelerator pedal.  
This vehicle is equipped with an adaptive transmission shift strategy.  
Adaptive transmission shift strategy offers the optimal transmission  
operation and shift quality. When the vehicle’s battery has been  
disconnected for any type of service or repair, the transmission will need  
to relearn the normal shift strategy parameters, much like having to reset  
your radio stations when your vehicle battery has been disconnected.  
The adaptive transmission shift strategy allows the transmission to  
relearn these operating parameters. This learning process could take  
several transmission upshifts and downshifts; during this learning  
process, slightly firmer shifts may occur. After this learning process,  
normal shift feel and shift scheduling will resume.  
P (Park)  
This position locks the transmission and prevents the rear wheels from  
turning.  
To put your vehicle in gear:  
1. Start the engine  
2. Press the brake pedal  
3. Move the gearshift lever into the desired gear  
To put your vehicle in P (Park):  
1. Come to a complete stop  
2. Move the gearshift lever and securely latch it in P (Park)  
209  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the lock  
position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
R (Reverse)  
With the gearshift lever in R (Reverse), the vehicle will move backward.  
Always come to a complete stop before shifting into and out of R  
(Reverse).  
N (Neutral)  
With the gearshift lever in N (Neutral), the vehicle can be started and is  
free to roll. Hold the brake pedal down while in this position.  
(Overdrive)  
The normal driving position for the  
best fuel economy. Transmission  
operates in gears one through four.  
Overdrive can be deactivated by  
pressing the transmission control  
O/D  
ON/OFF  
switch on the end of the gearshift  
lever.  
The O/D OFF lamp will illuminate in  
O/D  
the instrument cluster.  
OFF  
Drive (not shown)  
Drive is activated when the transmission control switch is pressed.  
This position allows for all forward gears except overdrive.  
O/D OFF lamp is illuminated.  
Provides engine braking.  
Use when driving conditions cause excessive shifting from O/D to  
other gears. Examples: heavy city traffic where continuous shifting in  
and out of overdrive occurs, hilly terrain, heavy loads, trailer towing  
and when engine braking is required.  
To return to O/D (Overdrive), press the transmission control switch.  
The O/D OFF lamp will not be illuminated.  
O/D (Overdrive) is automatically returned each time the key is turned  
off.  
210  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
2 (Second)  
This position allows for second gear only.  
Provides engine braking.  
Use to start-up on slippery roads.  
To return to  
(Overdrive), move the gearshift lever into the  
(Overdrive) position.  
Selecting 2 (Second) at higher speeds will cause the transmission to  
downshift to second gear at the appropriate vehicle speed.  
1 (First)  
Provides maximum engine braking.  
Allows upshifts by moving gearshift lever.  
Will not downshift into 1 (First) at high speeds; allows for 1 (First)  
when vehicle reaches slower speeds.  
Forced downshifts  
Allowed in  
(Overdrive) or Drive.  
Press the accelerator to the floor.  
Allows transmission to select an appropriate gear.  
Understanding the shift positions of the 5–speed automatic  
transmission (if equipped - 5.4L and 6.8L gasoline engines only)  
Your vehicle has been designed to improve fuel economy by reducing  
fuel usage during coasting or deceleration. When you take your foot off  
the accelerator pedal and the vehicle begins to slow down the torque  
converter clutch locks up and aggressively shuts off fuel flow to the  
engine while decelerating. This fuel economy benefit may be perceived  
as a light to medium braking sensation when removing your foot from  
the accelerator pedal.  
This vehicle is equipped with an adaptive transmission shift strategy.  
Adaptive transmission shift strategy offers the optimal transmission  
operation and shift quality. When the vehicle’s battery has been  
disconnected for any type of service or repair, the transmission will need  
to relearn the normal shift strategy parameters, much like having to reset  
your radio stations when your vehicle battery has been disconnected.  
211  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
The adaptive transmission shift strategy allows the transmission to  
relearn these operating parameters. This learning process could take  
several transmission upshifts and downshifts; during this learning  
process, slightly firmer shifts may occur. After this learning process,  
normal shift feel and shift scheduling will resume.  
P (Park)  
This position locks the transmission and prevents the rear wheels from  
turning.  
To put your vehicle in gear:  
1. Start the engine  
2. Press the brake pedal  
3. Move the gearshift lever into the desired gear  
To put your vehicle in P (Park):  
1. Come to a complete stop  
2. Move the gearshift lever and securely latch it in P (Park)  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the lock  
position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
R (Reverse)  
With the gearshift lever in R (Reverse), the vehicle will move backward.  
Always come to a complete stop before shifting into and out of R  
(Reverse).  
N (Neutral)  
With the gearshift lever in N (Neutral), the vehicle can be started and is  
free to roll. Hold the brake pedal down while in this position.  
D (Overdrive) with Tow/Haul off  
D (Overdrive) with tow/haul off is the normal driving position for the  
best fuel economy. The overdrive function allows automatic upshifts and  
downshifts through gears one through five.  
D (Overdrive) with Tow/Haul on  
The tow/haul feature improves transmission operation when towing a  
trailer or a heavy load. All transmission gear ranges are available when  
using tow/haul.  
212  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
To activate tow/haul, press the  
button on the end of the gearshift  
lever.  
The TOW HAUL indicator light will  
illuminate in the instrument cluster.  
Tow/haul delays upshifts to reduce frequency of transmission shifting.  
Tow/haul also provides engine braking in all forward gears when the  
transmission is in the D (Overdrive) position; this engine braking will  
slow the vehicle and assist the driver in controlling the vehicle when  
descending a grade. Depending on driving conditions and load  
conditions, the transmission may downshift, slow the vehicle and control  
the vehicle speed when descending a hill, without the accelerator pedal  
being pressed. The amount of downshift braking provided will vary based  
upon the amount the brake pedal is depressed.  
To deactivate the tow/haul feature and return to normal driving mode,  
press the button on the end of the gearshift lever. The TOW HAUL light  
will no longer be illuminated.  
When you shut-off and restart the engine, the transmission will  
automatically return to normal D (Overdrive) mode (Tow/Haul OFF).  
WARNING: Do not use the tow/haul feature when driving in icy  
or slippery conditions as the increased engine braking can cause  
the rear wheels to slide and the vehicle to swing around with the  
possible loss of vehicle control.  
3 (Third)  
Transmission starts and operates in third gear only.  
Used for improved traction on slippery roads. Selecting 3 (Third)  
provides engine braking.  
2 (Second)  
Use 2 (Second) to start-up on slippery roads or to provide additional  
engine braking on downgrades.  
1 (First)  
Provides maximum engine braking.  
Allows upshifts by moving gearshift lever.  
213  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
The transmission will not downshift into 1 (First) at high speeds; it  
will downshift to a lower gear and then shift into 1 (First) when the  
vehicle reaches slower speeds.  
Forced downshifts  
Allowed in  
(Overdrive) or Drive.  
Press the accelerator to the floor.  
Allows transmission to select an appropriate gear.  
Understanding the shift positions of the 5–speed automatic  
transmission (if equipped - diesel engines only)  
This vehicle is equipped with an Adaptive Transmission Shift Strategy.  
Adaptive Transmission Shift Strategy offers the optimal transmission  
operation and shift quality. When the vehicle’s battery has been  
disconnected for any type of service or repair, the transmission will need  
to relearn the normal shift strategy parameters, much like having to reset  
your radio stations when your vehicle battery has been disconnected.  
The Adaptive Transmission Shift Strategy allows the transmission to  
relearn these operating parameters. This learning process could take  
several transmission upshifts and downshifts; during this learning  
process, slightly firmer shifts may occur. After this learning process,  
normal shift feel and shift scheduling will resume.  
P (Park)  
This position locks the transmission and prevents the rear wheels from  
turning.  
To put your vehicle in gear:  
Start the engine  
Press the brake pedal  
Move the gearshift lever into the desired gear  
To put your vehicle in P (Park):  
Come to a complete stop  
Move the gearshift lever and securely latch it in P (Park)  
214  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the  
LOCK position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
R (Reverse)  
With the gearshift lever in R (Reverse), the vehicle will move backward.  
Always come to a complete stop before shifting into and out of R  
(Reverse).  
N (Neutral)  
With the gearshift lever in N (Neutral), the vehicle can be started and is  
free to roll. Hold the brake pedal down while in this position.  
D (Drive) with Overdrive  
D (Drive) with Overdrive is the normal driving position for the best fuel  
economy. The overdrive function allows automatic upshifts and  
downshifts through gears one through five.  
D (Drive) without Overdrive  
D (Drive) without Overdrive can be  
activated by pressing the  
O/D  
ON/OFF  
transmission control switch (TCS)  
on the end of the gearshift lever.  
This position allows for all forward gears except overdrive.  
The O/D OFF lamp will illuminate  
O/D  
OFF  
in the instrument cluster.  
Provides engine braking.  
Use when driving conditions cause excessive shifting from O/D to  
other gears. Examples: heavy city traffic where continuous shifting in  
and out of overdrive occurs, hilly terrain, heavy loads, trailer towing  
and when engine braking is required.  
To return to O/D (Overdrive), press the transmission control switch.  
The O/D OFF lamp will not be illuminated.  
O/D (Overdrive) is automatically returned each time the key is turned  
off.  
3 (Third)  
Transmission starts and operates in third gear only.  
215  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Used for improved traction on slippery roads. Selecting 3 (Third)  
provides additional engine braking.  
2 (Second)  
Use 2 (Second) to start-up on slippery roads or to provide additional  
engine braking on downgrades.  
1 (First)  
Provides maximum engine braking.  
Allows upshifts by moving gearshift lever.  
The transmission will not downshift into 1 (First) at high speeds; it  
will downshift to a lower gear and then shift into 1 (First) when the  
vehicle reaches slower speeds.  
Forced downshifts  
Allowed in D (Drive) with Overdrive or D (Drive) without Overdrive.  
Press the accelerator to the floor.  
Allows transmission to select an appropriate gear.  
If your vehicle goes off the edge of the pavement  
If your vehicle goes off the edge of the pavement, slow down, but  
avoid severe brake application, ease the vehicle back onto the  
pavement only after reducing your speed. Do not turn the steering  
wheel too sharply while returning to the road surface.  
It may be safer to stay on the apron or shoulder of the road and slow  
down gradually before returning to the pavement. You may lose  
control if you do not slow down or if you turn the steering wheel too  
sharply or abruptly.  
It often may be less risky to strike small objects, such as highway  
reflectors, with minor damage to your vehicle rather than attempt a  
sudden return to the pavement which could cause the vehicle to slide  
sideways out of control or roll over. Remember, your safety and the  
safety of others should be your primary concern.  
WARNING: Vehicles with a higher center of gravity such as  
utility and four-wheel drive vehicles handle differently than  
vehicles with a lower center of gravity. Utility and four-wheel drive  
vehicles are not designed for cornering at speeds as high as passenger  
cars any more than low-slung sports cars are designed to perform  
satisfactorily under off-road conditions. Avoid sharp turns, excessive  
speed and abrupt maneuvers in these vehicles. Failure to drive  
cautiously could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control,  
vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
216  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
REVERSE SENSING SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
The reverse sensing system (RSS) sounds a tone to warn the driver of  
obstacles near the rear bumper when the R (Reverse) is selected and the  
vehicle is moving at speeds less than 3 mph (5 km/h). The system is not  
effective at speeds above 3 mph (5 km/h) and may not detect certain  
angular or moving objects.  
WARNING: To help avoid personal injury, please read and  
understand the limitations of the reverse sensing system as  
contained in this section. Reverse sensing is only an aid for some  
(generally large and fixed) objects when moving in reverse on a flat  
surface at “parking speeds”. Inclement weather may also affect the  
function of the RSS; this may include reduced performance or a false  
activation.  
WARNING: To help avoid personal injury, always use caution  
when in reverse and when using the RSS.  
WARNING: This system is not designed to prevent contact with  
small or moving objects. The system is designed to provide a  
warning to assist the driver in detecting large stationary objects to  
avoid damaging the vehicle. The system may not detect smaller  
objects, particularly those close to the ground.  
WARNING: Certain add-on devices such as large trailer hitches,  
bike or surfboard racks and any device that may block the  
normal detection zone of the RSS system may create false beeps.  
217  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
The RSS detects obstacles up to  
6 feet (2 meters) from the rear  
bumper with a decreased coverage  
area at the outer corners of the  
bumper, (refer to the figures for  
approximate zone coverage areas).  
As you move closer to the obstacle,  
the rate of the tone increases. When  
the obstacle is less than 10 inches  
(25.0 cm) away, the tone will sound  
continuously. If the RSS detects a  
stationary or receding object further  
than 10 inches (25.0 cm) from the  
side of the vehicle, the tone will  
sound for only three seconds. Once  
the system detects an object  
approaching, the tone will sound  
again.  
While receiving a warning, on some radios, the volume will be reduced to  
a predetermined level. After the warning goes away, the radio will return  
to the previous value.  
The RSS automatically turns on when the gearshift lever is placed in R  
(Reverse) and the ignition is on. A control in the message center allows  
the driver to disable the system, refer to Message center in the  
Instrument Cluster chapter for more information.  
Keep the RSS sensors (located on the rear bumper/fascia) free  
from snow, ice and large accumulations of dirt (do not clean the  
sensors with sharp objects). If the sensors are covered, it will  
affect the accuracy of the RSS.  
If your vehicle sustains damage to the rear bumper/fascia, leaving  
it misaligned or bent, the sensing zone may be altered causing  
inaccurate measurement of obstacles or false alarms.  
218  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
REARVIEW CAMERA SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
The rearview camera system located  
on the back door provides a video  
image, which appears in the  
rearview mirror or navigation screen  
(if equipped), of the area behind the  
vehicle. It adds assistance to the  
driver while reversing or reverse  
parking the vehicle.  
To use the camera system, place the transmission in R (Reverse); an  
image will display on the left portion of the rearview mirror or on the  
navigation screen (if equipped). The area displayed on the screen may  
vary according to the vehicle orientation and/or road condition.  
(1) Rear bumper  
(2) Red zone  
(3) Yellow zone  
(4) Green zone  
(5) Centerline of vehicle  
Always use caution while backing.  
Objects in the red zone are closest  
to your vehicle and objects in the  
green zone are further away. Objects  
are getting closer to your vehicle as they move from the green zone to  
the yellow or red zones.  
Use the side mirrors and rearview mirror to get better coverage on both  
sides and rear of the vehicle.  
Image delay if displayed through the rearview mirror:  
When shifting out of R (Reverse) and into any other gear, the image in  
the rearview mirror will remain on for a few seconds before it shuts off  
to assist in parking or trailer hookup.  
Image delay if displayed through the navigation screen:  
After shifting out of R (Reverse) and into any gear other than P (Park),  
the image in the navigation screen will remain until the vehicle speed  
reaches five mph (8 km/h), only if the rear camera delay feature is on, or  
until any navigation radio button is pressed.  
219  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Note: The default setting for the rear camera delay is off. Press the  
“Settings” button found on the navigation screen (if equipped) to set the  
rear camera delay feature to on or off.  
When towing, the camera system will only see what is being towed  
behind the vehicle; this might not provide adequate coverage as it  
usually provides in normal operation and some objects might not be  
seen.  
The camera lens for the camera is located on the back door. Keep the  
lens clean so the video image remains clear and undistorted. Clean the  
lens with a soft, lint-free cloth and non-abrasive cleaner.  
Note: If the camera system image is not clear or seems distorted, it may  
be covered with water droplets, snow, mud or any other substance. If  
this occurs, clean the camera lens before using the camera system.  
WARNING: The camera system is a reverse aid supplement  
device that still requires the driver to use it in conjunction with  
the rearview mirror and the side mirrors for maximum coverage.  
WARNING: Objects that are close to either corner of the  
bumper or under the bumper, might not be seen on the screen  
due to the limited coverage of the camera system.  
WARNING: Backup as slow as possible since higher speeds  
might limit your reaction time to stop the vehicle.  
WARNING: Do not use the camera system with the backdoor  
open.  
If the back end of the vehicle is hit or damaged, then check with your  
authorized dealer to have your rear video system checked for proper  
coverage and operation.  
Night time and dark area use  
At night time or in dark areas, the camera system relies on the reverse  
lamp lighting to produce an image. Therefore it is necessary that both  
reverse lamps are operating in order to get a clear image in the dark. If  
either of the lamps are not operating, stop using the camera system, at  
least in the dark, until the lamp(s) are replaced and functioning.  
220  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Servicing  
If the image comes on while the vehicle is not in R (Reverse), have  
the system inspected by your authorized dealer.  
If the image is not clear, then check if there is anything covering the  
lens such as dirt, mud, ice, snow, etc. If the image is still not clear  
after cleaning, have your system inspected by your authorized dealer.  
BLIND SPOT MIRRORS (IF EQUIPPED)  
Blind spot mirrors have an  
integrated convex spotter mirror  
built into the upper outboard corner  
of the outside mirrors. They are  
designed to assist the driver by  
increasing visibility along the side of  
the vehicle. For more information on  
your side view mirrors, refer to  
Exterior mirrors in the Driver  
Controls chapter.  
Driving with blind spot mirrors  
Before a lane change, check the  
main mirror first, then check the  
blind spot mirror. If no vehicles are  
present in the blind spot mirror and  
the traffic in the adjacent lane is at  
3
a safe distance, signal that you are  
going to change lanes. Glance over  
your shoulder to verify traffic is  
clear, and carefully change lanes.  
When the approaching vehicle is at  
a distance, its image is small and  
2
near the inboard edge of the main  
mirror. As the vehicle approaches,  
the image becomes larger and  
begins to move outboard across the  
main mirror (1). As the vehicle  
approaches its image will transition  
from the main mirror and begin to  
appear in the blind spot mirror (2).  
As the vehicle leaves the blind spot  
1
mirror it will transition to the driver’s peripheral field of view (3).  
221  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: Objects in the blind spot mirror are closer than they  
appear.  
VEHICLE USED AS A STATIONARY POWER SOURCE  
Auxiliary equipment called power take-off or PTO, is often added to the  
engine or transmission to operate utility equipment. Examples include a  
wheel-lift for tow trucks, cranes, tools for construction or tire service and  
pumping fluids. PTO applications draw auxiliary horsepower from the  
powertrain, often while the vehicle is stationary. In this condition, there  
is limited cooling air flow through the radiator and around the vehicle  
that normally occurs when a vehicle is moving. The aftermarket PTO  
system installer, having the most knowledge of the final application, is  
responsible for determining whether additional chassis heat protection or  
powertrain cooling is required, and alerting the user to the safe and  
proper operation.  
Your vehicle is qualified for use as a stationary power source, within  
limits detailed in the Ford Truck Body Builders Layout Book, found at  
www.fleet.ford.com/truckbbas, and through the Ford Truck Body Builders  
Advisory Service.  
Gas engine vehicles are qualified for up to 10 minutes of continuous  
operation as a stationary power source, due to the potential for the  
normal venting of fuel vapors. For stationary PTO operation of extended  
duration (beyond 10 minutes), diesel engine is recommended. Further  
consult your aftermarket PTO installer, since the duration of operation  
limit for the aftermarket PTO may be less than the vehicle is capable of.  
222  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
DRIVING THROUGH WATER  
If driving through deep or standing  
water is unavoidable, proceed very  
slowly especially when the depth is  
not known. Never drive through  
water that is higher than the bottom  
of the wheel rims (for cars) or the  
bottom of the hubs (for trucks).  
When driving through water, traction or brake capability may be limited.  
Also, water may enter your engine’s air intake and severely damage your  
engine or your vehicle may stall. Driving through deep water where  
the transmission vent tube is submerged may allow water into the  
transmission and cause internal transmission damage.  
Once through the water, always dry the brakes by moving your  
vehicle slowly while applying light pressure on the brake pedal.  
Wet brakes do not stop the vehicle as quickly as dry brakes.  
223  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
ROADSIDE ASSISTANCE  
Getting roadside assistance  
To fully assist you should you have a vehicle concern, Ford Motor  
Company offers a complimentary roadside assistance program. This  
program is separate from the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. The service  
is available:  
24–hours, seven days a week  
for the coverage period listed on the Roadside Assistance Card  
included in your Owner Guide portfolio.  
Roadside assistance will cover:  
a flat tire change with a good spare (except vehicles that have been  
supplied with a tire inflation kit)  
battery jump start  
lock-out assistance (key replacement cost is the customer’s  
responsibility)  
fuel delivery – Independent Service Contractors, if not prohibited by  
state, local or municipal law shall deliver up to 2.0 gallons (7.5L) of  
gasoline or 5.0 gallons (18.9L) of diesel fuel to a disabled vehicle. Fuel  
delivery service is limited to two no-charge occurrences within a  
12-month period.  
winch out – available within 100 feet (30.5 meters) of a paved or  
county maintained road, no recoveries.  
towing – Ford/Mercury/Lincoln eligible vehicle towed to an authorized  
dealer within 35 miles (56 km) of the disablement location or to the  
nearest authorized dealer. If a member requests to be towed to an  
authorized dealer more than 35 miles (56 km) from the disablement  
location, the member shall be responsible for any mileage costs in  
excess of 35 miles (56 km).  
Trailers shall be covered up to $200 if the disabled eligible vehicle  
requires service at the nearest authorized dealer. If the trailer is disabled,  
but the towing vehicle is operational, the trailer does not qualify for any  
roadside services.  
Canadian customers refer to your Customer Information Guide  
for information on:  
coverage period  
exact fuel amounts  
224  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
towing of your disabled vehicle  
emergency travel expense reimbursement  
travel planning benefits  
In Canada, for uninterrupted Roadside Assistance coverage, you may  
purchase extended coverage prior to your Basic Warranty’s Roadside  
Assistance expiring. For more information and enrollment, contact  
1–877–294–2582 or visit our website at www.ford.ca.  
Using roadside assistance  
Complete the roadside assistance identification card and place it in your  
wallet for quick reference. In the United States, this card is found in the  
Owner Guide portfolio in the glove compartment. In Canada, the card is  
found in the Owner Information Guide in the glove compartment.  
U.S. Ford, Mercury and Lincoln vehicle customers who require Roadside  
Assistance, call 1-800-241-3673.  
Canadian customers who require roadside assistance, call  
1-800-665-2006.  
Motorhome customers in the U.S and Canada should contact  
1-800-444-3311.  
If you need to arrange roadside assistance for yourself, Ford Motor  
Company will reimburse a reasonable amount for towing to the nearest  
dealership within 35 miles. To obtain reimbursement information, U.S.  
Ford, Mercury and Lincoln vehicle customers call 1-800-241-3673.  
Customers will be asked to submit their original receipts.  
Canadian customers who need to obtain reimbursement information, call  
1-800-665-2006.  
HAZARD FLASHER CONTROL  
The hazard flasher is located on the  
steering column, just behind the  
steering wheel. The hazard flashers  
will operate when the ignition is in  
any position or if the key is not in  
the ignition.  
Press in the flasher control and all  
front and rear direction signals will  
flash. Press the flasher control again  
to turn them off. Use it when your  
vehicle is disabled and is creating a  
safety hazard for other motorists.  
225  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Note: With extended use, the flasher may run down your battery.  
FUEL PUMP SHUT-OFF SWITCH  
(DIESEL-POWERED AND STRIPPED CHASSIS VEHICLES ONLY)  
This device stops the electric fuel pump from sending fuel to the engine  
when your vehicle has had a substantial jolt.  
After an accident, if the engine cranks but does not start, this switch  
may have been activated.  
On diesel-powered vehicles, this  
switch is located in the front  
passenger’s footwell, by the kick  
panel.  
226  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
On commercial stripped chassis  
vehicles, this switch is located on a  
bracket above the brake pedal.  
To reset the switch:  
1. Turn the ignition off.  
2. Check the fuel system for leaks.  
3. If no leaks are apparent, reset the  
switch by pushing in on the reset  
button.  
4. Turn the ignition on.  
5. Wait a few seconds and return  
the key to off.  
6. Make another check for leaks.  
Fuel pump shut-off (gas engines except stripped chassis)  
In the event of a moderate to severe collision, this vehicle is equipped  
with a fuel pump shut-off feature that stops the flow of fuel to the  
engine. Not every impact will cause a shut-off.  
Should your vehicle shut off after a collision due to this feature, you may  
restart your vehicle by doing the following:  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the off position.  
2. Turn the ignition switch to the on position.  
In some instances the vehicle may not restart the first time you try to  
restart and may take one additional attempt.  
WARNING: Failure to inspect and if necessary repair fuel leaks  
after a collision may increase the risk of fire and serious injury.  
Ford Motor Company recommends that the fuel system be inspected  
by an authorized dealer after any collision.  
227  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
FUSES AND RELAYS  
Fuses  
If electrical components in the  
vehicle are not working, a fuse may  
have blown. Blown fuses are  
identified by a broken wire within  
the fuse. Check the appropriate  
fuses before replacing any electrical  
components.  
15  
Note: Always replace a fuse with one that has the specified amperage  
rating. Using a fuse with a higher amperage rating can cause severe wire  
damage and could start a fire.  
Standard fuse amperage rating and color  
COLOR  
Cartridge  
Fuse  
rating  
Mini  
fuses  
Standard  
fuses  
Maxi  
fuses  
Fuse link  
cartridge  
maxi  
fuses  
2A  
3A  
4A  
Grey  
Violet  
Pink  
Tan  
Grey  
Violet  
Pink  
Tan  
5A  
7.5A  
10A  
15A  
20A  
25A  
30A  
40A  
50A  
60A  
70A  
80A  
Brown  
Red  
Brown  
Red  
Yellow  
Green  
Orange  
Red  
Blue  
Tan  
Natural  
Blue  
Pink  
Green  
Red  
Yellow  
Blue  
Pink  
Green  
Red  
Yellow  
Brown  
Black  
Blue  
Yellow  
Natural  
Green  
Blue  
Yellow  
Natural  
Green  
Black  
Passenger compartment fuse panel  
The fuse panel is located to the left of the brake pedal and mounted  
onto the lower left cowl panel. Remove the fuse panel cover to access  
the fuses.  
228  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
WARNING: Always disconnect the battery before servicing high  
current fuses.  
If your vehicle is equipped with an auxiliary battery,  
disconnecting the primary under-hood battery DOES NOT remove  
power from all circuits.  
To remove a fuse use the fuse puller tool provided on the inside of the  
fuse panel cover.  
The fuses are coded as follows.  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
30A  
Protected Circuits  
Not used (spare)  
Not used (spare)  
Not used (spare)  
Not used (spare)  
1
2
3
4
15A  
15A  
30A  
229  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
5
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
10A  
Protected Circuits  
Passenger compartment fuse panel  
(SPDJB)/Brake-shift interlock  
Turn signal, Hazard, Stop lamps  
Left low beam  
Right low beam  
Courtesy lamps  
Switch illumination  
Not used (spare)  
Not used (spare)  
6
7
8
9
20A  
10A  
10A  
15A  
15A  
10A  
7.5A  
5A  
10A  
10A  
15A  
20A  
20A  
25A  
15A  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
Mirrors  
SYNC, GPS module  
Satellite radio  
Not used (spare)  
Door locks  
Not used (spare)  
Not used (spare)  
Diagnostic connector  
(except stripped chassis)  
Not used (spare)  
Park lamps, License plate lamps  
High beams  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
15A  
15A  
15A  
20A  
10A  
10A  
20A  
5A  
5A  
5A  
10A  
10A  
10A  
Horn (except stripped chassis)  
Demand lighting  
Cluster (except stripped chassis)  
Ignition switch feed  
Audio mute (start)  
Cluster (except stripped chassis)  
Not used (spare)  
Not used (spare)  
Restraints module  
Trailer brake controller  
230  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
5A  
Protected Circuits  
34  
35  
Not used (spare)  
Reverse park aid, Rear video camera,  
Cutaway run/start  
10A  
36  
37  
5A  
Passive anti-theft system (PATS) RF  
module  
Climate control, Stripped chassis IP #1  
run/start  
10A  
38  
39  
40  
41  
20A  
20A  
20A  
15A  
Not used (spare)  
Radio, Navigation  
Amplifier  
Radio, Switch illumination, Reverse  
camera mirror, Automatic dimming rear  
view mirror  
42  
43  
44  
10A  
10A  
10A  
Upfitter switch  
Stripped chassis IP connector #1  
Auxiliary battery relay/Trailer tow  
battery charger relay  
45  
46  
47  
48  
5A  
Wipers, Stripped chassis Engine  
connector 3  
Passenger airbag deactivation indicator  
(PADI)  
7.5A  
30A circuit Windows accessory delay  
breaker  
Relay  
Delayed accessory  
Power distribution box  
The power distribution box is located in the engine compartment. The  
power distribution box contains high-current fuses that protect your  
vehicle’s main electrical systems from overloads.  
WARNING: Always disconnect the battery before servicing high  
current fuses.  
231  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
WARNING: To reduce risk of electrical shock, always replace  
the cover to the Power Distribution Box before reconnecting the  
battery or refilling fluid reservoirs.  
If your vehicle is equipped with an auxiliary battery,  
disconnecting the primary under-hood battery DOES NOT remove  
power from all circuits.  
If the battery has been disconnected and reconnected, refer to the  
Battery section of the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
The high-current fuses are coded as follows.  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
Protected Circuits  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
HC Micro Relay Powertrain control module (PCM)  
HC Micro Relay Starter solenoid  
HC Micro Relay Wiper  
HC Micro Relay Trailer tow battery charge  
HC Micro Relay Fuel pump  
HC Micro Relay Trailer tow park lamp  
HC Micro Relay Upfitter #4  
HC Micro Relay Upfitter #3  
HC Micro Relay Modified vehicle and stripped chassis  
run/start  
232  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
10  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
HC ISO  
Protected Circuits  
Fuel injector control module (FICM)  
relay (Diesel engine only)  
Not used  
Modified vehicle and stripped chassis  
run/start  
11  
12  
40A**  
13  
14  
15  
30A**  
40A**  
40A**  
Starter solenoid relay  
Run start relay  
Modified vehicle and stripped chassis  
battery  
16  
17  
50A**  
50A**  
Auxiliary A/C blower  
Auxiliary battery feed, Trailer tow  
battery charge, trailer tow park feed  
Electric trailer brake, Trailer brake  
controller  
18  
30A**  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
30A**  
30A**  
50A**  
Upfitter #1  
Upfitter #2  
FICM relay (diesel engine only)  
Not used  
A/C clutch  
G8VA relay  
G8VA relay  
HC Micro relay Run/start  
Horn relay (Stripped chassis)  
20A*  
10A*  
10A*  
10A*  
Not used  
Not used  
Back up lamp  
A/C clutch  
Brake on/off (BOO) switch  
Cluster battery (stripped chassis  
only), FICM coil (diesel engine only)  
Blower motor  
Anti-lock brake system (ABS) pump  
Stripped chassis horn  
PCM relay  
32  
33  
34  
35  
50A**  
40A**  
20A**  
40A**  
233  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
36  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
Protected Circuits  
Ignition switch  
20A**  
(Stripped chassis only)  
Trailer tow stop — left turn signal  
Trailer tow stop — right turn signal  
Back up lamp  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
G8VA relay  
G8VA relay  
G8VA relay  
ISO relay  
10A*  
Blower motor  
Charging (diesel engine only)  
Diagnostic connector  
(stripped chassis)  
15A*  
43  
44  
45  
46  
20A*  
10A*  
15A*  
10A*  
Fuel pump  
Upfitter #3  
Upfitter #4  
PCM keep alive power, Canister vent,  
PCM relay coil  
47  
48  
49  
50  
51  
52  
40A**  
20A**  
30A**  
20A**  
10A*  
ABS coil  
Trailer tow stop lamp/turn signal  
Wiper motor  
Not used  
Cutaway  
Stripped chassis and modified vehicle  
run/start relay coil  
53  
54  
10A*  
10A*  
ABS run/start feed  
Fuel pump relay coil  
(gas engine only)  
55  
56  
10A*  
20A*  
PCM (diesel engine only)  
Diesel fuel conditioner module  
(DFCM) (diesel engine only)  
Trailer tow park lamp  
Trailer tow backup lamp  
Not used  
57  
58  
59  
60  
20A*  
15A*  
One touch integrated start (OTIS)  
(diode)  
234  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Protected Circuits  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
61  
Auxiliary battery (diode)  
62  
HC Micro relay Upfitter #2  
63  
64  
30A**  
Trailer tow battery charge  
Not used  
65  
66  
67  
68  
20A**  
20A**  
20A**  
50A**  
Power point 2 (glove box)  
Power point 3 (left-hand B-pillar)  
Power point 1 (instrument panel)  
Modified vehicle  
69  
Not used  
70  
71  
30A**  
Stripped chassis  
Not used  
72  
73  
20A**  
Cigar lighter  
Not used  
74  
75  
76  
30A**  
20A*  
20A*  
Power seat  
Vehicle power (VPWR) 1, PCM power  
VPWR 2, PCM – emission related  
powertrain components  
VPWR 3, PCM – general powertrain  
components  
VPWR 4 (gas engine only), Ignition  
coil (diesel engine only), Fuel pump  
relay coil  
77  
78  
10A*  
15A*  
79  
80  
10A*  
10A*  
VPWR 5, Transmission  
Cluster run/start  
(stripped chassis only)  
FICM logic (diesel engine only)  
Not used  
Fuel pump (diode)  
Not used  
81  
82  
83  
84  
85  
15A*  
HC Micro relay Upfitter #1  
* Mini fuses ** A1S fuses  
235  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
CHANGING THE TIRES  
If you get a flat tire while driving, do not apply the brake heavily.  
Instead, gradually decrease your speed. Hold the steering wheel firmly  
and slowly move to a safe place on the side of the road.  
Note: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) indicator light will  
illuminate when the spare tire is in use. To restore the full functionality  
of the monitoring system, all road wheels equipped with tire pressure  
monitoring sensors must be mounted on the vehicle.  
Have a flat serviced by an authorized dealer in order to prevent damage  
to the TPMS sensors, refer to Tire pressure monitoring system  
(TPMS) in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter. Replace the spare  
tire with a road tire as soon as possible. During repairing or replacing of  
the flat tire, have the authorized dealer inspect the TPMS sensor for  
damage.  
WARNING: The use of tire sealants may damage your Tire  
Pressure Monitoring System and should not be used.  
WARNING: Refer to Tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS)  
in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter for important  
information. If the tire pressure monitor sensor becomes damaged, it  
will no longer function.  
Dissimilar spare tire/wheel information  
WARNING: Failure to follow these guidelines could result in an  
increased risk of loss of vehicle control, injury or death.  
If you have a dissimilar spare tire/wheel, then it is intended for  
temporary use only. This means that if you need to use it, you should  
replace it as soon as possible with a road tire/wheel that is the same size  
and type as the road tires and wheels that were originally provided by  
Ford. If the dissimilar spare tire or wheel is damaged, it should be  
replaced rather than repaired.  
A dissimilar spare tire/wheel is defined as a spare tire and/or wheel that  
is different in brand, size or appearance from the road tires and wheels  
and can be one of three types:  
1. T-type mini-spare: This spare tire begins with the letter “T” for tire  
size and may have “Temporary Use Only” molded in the sidewall  
236  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
2. Full-size dissimilar spare with label on wheel: This spare tire has  
a label on the wheel that states: “THIS TIRE AND WHEEL FOR  
TEMPORARY USE ONLY”  
When driving with one of the dissimilar spare tires listed above, do not:  
Exceed 50 mph (80 km/h)  
Load the vehicle beyond maximum vehicle load rating listed on the  
Safety Compliance Label  
Tow a trailer  
Use snow chains on the end of the vehicle with the dissimilar spare  
tire  
Use more than one dissimilar spare tire at a time  
Use commercial car washing equipment  
Try to repair the dissimilar spare tire  
Use of one of the dissimilar spare tires listed above at any one wheel  
location can lead to impairment of the following:  
Handling, stability and braking performance  
Comfort and noise  
Ground clearance and parking at curbs  
Winter weather driving capability  
Wet weather driving capability  
3. Full-size dissimilar spare without label on wheel  
When driving with the full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel, do not:  
Exceed 70 mph (113 km/h)  
Use more than one dissimilar spare tire/wheel at a time  
Use commercial car washing equipment  
Use snow chains on the end of the vehicle with the dissimilar spare  
tire/wheel  
The usage of a full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel can lead to  
impairment of the following:  
Handling, stability and braking performance  
Comfort and noise  
Ground clearance and parking at curbs  
Winter weather driving capability  
237  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Wet weather driving capability  
All-Wheel driving capability (if applicable)  
Load leveling adjustment (if applicable)  
When driving with the full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel additional  
caution should be given to:  
Towing a trailer  
Driving vehicles equipped with a camper body  
Driving vehicles with a load on the cargo rack  
Drive cautiously when using a full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel and  
seek service as soon as possible.  
Full-size matching spare tire/wheel information  
This spare tire/wheel will match the road tire/wheel. When driving with  
the full size matching spare tire/wheel, do not exceed 70 mph  
(113 km/h). It is intended for temporary use only. This means if you  
need to use it, you should replace it as soon as possible.  
Stopping and securing your vehicle  
1. Park on a level surface.  
2. Activate the warning flashers.  
3. Place the gearshift in P (Park).  
4. Apply the parking brake and turn  
the engine off.  
Spare tire information  
The spare tire for your vehicle is stowed under the rear of your vehicle  
(except cutaway and stripped chassis models).  
238  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
To remove the spare tire:  
1. Open the rear doors and remove  
the thumb screw and anti-theft  
bracket. If finger pressure will not  
remove the thumb screw, use the  
lug wrench to loosen the screw.  
2. Remove the access plug under  
the left door.  
3. Remove the jack handle from the  
right side compartment and insert  
the tip of the jack handle through  
the access hole and into the tube.  
4. Turn the jack handle  
counterclockwise until the cable is  
slack and the tire can be slid from  
under the vehicle.  
5. Remove the retainer from the  
spare tire.  
To stow the cable retainer with the spare removed, turn the jack handle  
clockwise until all slack is removed.  
Tire change procedure  
WARNING: To help prevent the vehicle from moving when you  
change a tire, be sure the parking brake is set, then block (in  
both directions) the wheel that is diagonally opposite (other side and  
end of the vehicle) to the tire being changed.  
WARNING: If the vehicle slips off the jack, you or someone else  
could be seriously injured.  
WARNING: Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of the  
vehicle close to moving traffic. Pull far enough off the road to  
avoid the danger of being hit when operating the jack or changing the  
wheel.  
239  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Note: Passengers should not remain in the vehicle when the vehicle is  
being jacked.  
1. Block the wheel that is diagonally opposite the tire you are changing.  
On E-450 vehicles, the parking brake is on the transmission. Therefore,  
the vehicle will not be prevented from moving when a rear wheel is  
lifted, even if the parking brake is applied. Be sure to block both  
directions of the wheel that is diagonally opposite to the wheel that is  
being lifted.  
2. Remove the spare tire and jack from the storage location.  
The jack is located in the rear  
right-hand side of the cargo area.  
3. Remove any wheel trim. Insert the tapered end of the lug nut wrench  
behind wheel covers or hubcaps and twist off.  
4. Loosen the wheel nut by pulling up on the handle of the lug nut  
wrench about one-half turn (counterclockwise). Do not remove the  
wheel lug nuts until you raise the tire off the ground.  
240  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
WARNING: When one of the rear wheels is off the ground, the  
transmission alone will not prevent the vehicle from moving or  
slipping off the jack, even if the transmission is in P (Park) (automatic  
transmission) or R (Reverse) (manual transmission). To help prevent  
the vehicle from moving when you change the tire, be sure that the  
parking brake is set and the diagonally opposite wheel is blocked.  
Replacing the tire  
1. Assemble the jack handle sections together and lock into the jack. Use  
the jack handle to slide the jack under the vehicle.  
WARNING: To lessen the risk of personal injury, do not put any  
part of your body under the vehicle while changing a tire. Do not  
start the engine when your vehicle is on the jack. The jack is only  
meant for changing the tire.  
2. Position the jack to raise the front or rear wheel.  
Never use the front or rear  
differential as a jacking point.  
241  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Rear axle jacking points - All  
models except E-350 Dual Rear  
Wheel (DRW) and E-450:  
Rear axle jacking points - E-350  
Dual Rear Wheel (DRW) and  
E-450:  
Front axle jacking points:  
Place the jack under the pin on the  
front surface of the front axle.  
Do not place the jack under or  
on the steering linkage.  
3. Raise the jack until the wheel is  
completely off the ground. (Turn  
jack handle clockwise if your vehicle  
is equipped with a screw-type jack  
or pump the jack if equipped with a  
hydraulic jack.)  
4. Remove the lug nuts with the lug  
nut wrench.  
5. Replace the flat tire with the  
spare tire.  
242  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
If your vehicle has single rear wheels, thread the lug nuts on the studs  
with the beveled face toward the wheel.  
If your vehicle has dual rear wheels, thread the two element swiveling  
lug nuts on the studs with the flange facing toward the wheel.  
6. Use the lug nut wrench to screw the lug nut snugly against the wheel.  
7. Lower the vehicle by turning the jack handle counterclockwise.  
8. Remove the jack and fully tighten the lug nuts in the following pattern  
(Refer to Wheel lug nut torque specifications later in this chapter for  
the proper lug nut torque specification):  
WARNING: Never use  
wheels or lug nuts different  
than the original equipment as  
this could damage the wheel or  
mounting system. This damage  
could allow the wheels to come off  
while the vehicle is being driven.  
9. Install any wheel covers,  
ornaments or hub caps. Make sure they are snapped in place.  
10. Stow the jack, handle and lug wrench.  
11. Unblock the wheels.  
Stowing the flat/spare tire  
Note: Failure to follow spare tire stowage instructions may result in  
failure of cable or loss of spare tire.  
1. Lay the tire on the ground with the valve stem facing in the direction  
specified on the Tire Changing Instructions located with the jack  
hardware.  
2. Slide the wheel partially under the vehicle and install the retainer  
through the wheel center. Pull on the cable to align the components at  
the end of the cable.  
243  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
3. Turn the jack handle clockwise until the tire is raised to its stowed  
position underneath the vehicle. The effort to turn the jack handle  
increases significantly and the spare tire carrier ratchets or slips when  
the tire is raised to the maximum tightness. Tighten to the best of your  
ability, to the point where the ratchet/slip occurs, if possible. The spare  
tire carrier will not allow you to overtighten. If the spare tire carrier  
ratchets or slips with little effort, take the vehicle to your authorized  
dealer for assistance at your earliest convenience.  
4. Check that the tire lies flat against the frame and is properly  
tightened. Try to push or pull, then turn the tire to be sure it will not  
move. Loosen and retighten, if necessary. Failure to properly stow the  
spare tire may result in failure of the winch cable and loss of the tire.  
5. Repeat this tightness check procedure when servicing the spare tire  
pressure (every six months, as per your scheduled maintenance  
information), or at any time that the spare tire is disturbed through  
service of other components.  
6. If removed, install the spare tire lock (if equipped) into the bumper  
drive tube with the spare tire lock key (if equipped) and jack handle.  
WHEEL LUG NUT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS  
On vehicles equipped with single rear wheels, retighten the lug nuts to  
the specified torque at 100 miles (160 km) after any wheel disturbance  
(tire rotation, changing a flat tire, wheel removal, etc.).  
On vehicles equipped with dual rear wheels, retighten the wheel lug nuts  
to the specified torque at 100 miles (160 km), and again at 500 miles  
(800 km) of new vehicle operation and after any wheel disturbance (tire  
rotation, changing a flat tire, wheel removal, etc.).  
Bolt size and wheel  
lug nut type  
9/16 x 18 conical lug  
nut  
Wheel lug nut torque*  
lb.ft.  
Nm  
150  
200  
9/16 x 18 two-piece  
lug nut  
140  
190  
* Torque specifications are for nut and bolt threads free of dirt and  
rust. Use only Ford recommended replacement fasteners.  
244  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
On all two-piece flat wheel nuts,  
apply one drop of motor oil between  
the flat washer and the nut. Do not  
apply motor oil to the wheel nut  
threads or the wheel stud threads.  
WARNING: When a wheel is installed, always remove any  
corrosion, dirt or foreign materials present on the mounting  
surfaces of the wheel or the surface of the wheel hub, brake drum or  
brake disc that contacts the wheel. Ensure that any fasteners that  
attach the rotor to the hub are secured so they do not interfere with  
the mounting surfaces of the wheel. Installing wheels without correct  
metal-to-metal contact at the wheel mounting surfaces can cause the  
wheel nuts to loosen and the wheel to come off while the vehicle is in  
motion, resulting in loss of control.  
Note: Inspect the wheel pilot hole  
prior to installation. If there is  
visible corrosion in wheel pilot hole,  
remove loose particles by wiping  
with clean rag and apply grease.  
Apply grease only to the wheel pilot  
hole surface by smearing a “dime”  
(1 square cm) sized glob of grease  
around the wheel pilot surface (1)  
with end of finger. DO NOT apply  
grease to lugnut/stud holes or  
wheel-to-brake surfaces.  
JUMP STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
The following procedure is for vehicles equipped with a gasoline engine;  
if your vehicle is equipped with a diesel engine, refer to the 6.0 and 6.4  
Liter Power Stroke Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s Guide  
Supplement for the proper jump starting procedure.  
WARNING: The gases around the battery can explode if  
exposed to flames, sparks, or lit cigarettes. An explosion could  
result in injury or vehicle damage.  
245  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
WARNING: Batteries contain sulfuric acid which can burn skin,  
eyes and clothing, if contacted.  
Do not attempt to push-start your automatic transmission  
vehicle. Automatic transmissions do not have push-start  
capability. Attempting to push-start a vehicle with an automatic  
transmission may cause transmission damage.  
Preparing your vehicle  
When the battery is disconnected or a new battery is installed, the  
automatic transmission must relearn its shift strategy. As a result, the  
transmission may have firm and/or soft shifts. This operation is  
considered normal and will not affect function or durability of the  
transmission. Over time, the adaptive learning process will fully update  
transmission operation.  
1. Use only a 12–volt supply to start your vehicle.  
2. Do not disconnect the battery of the disabled vehicle as this could  
damage the vehicle’s electrical system.  
3. Park the booster vehicle close to the hood of the disabled vehicle  
making sure the two vehicles do not touch. Set the parking brake on  
both vehicles and stay clear of the engine cooling fan and other moving  
parts.  
4. Check all battery terminals and remove any excessive corrosion before  
you attach the battery cables. Ensure that vent caps are tight and level.  
5. Turn the heater fan on in both vehicles to protect from any electrical  
surges. Turn all other accessories off.  
Connecting the jumper cables  
246  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
1. Connect the positive (+) jumper cable to the positive (+) terminal of  
the discharged battery.  
Note: In the illustrations, lightning bolts are used to designate the  
assisting (boosting) battery.  
2. Connect the other end of the positive (+) cable to the positive (+)  
terminal of the assisting battery.  
3. Connect the negative (-) cable to the negative (-) terminal of the  
assisting battery.  
247  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
4. Make the final connection of the negative (-) cable to an exposed  
metal part of the stalled vehicle’s engine, away from the battery and the  
carburetor/fuel injection system.  
Note: Do not attach the negative (-) cable to fuel lines, engine rocker  
covers, the intake manifold or electrical components as grounding  
points.  
WARNING: Do not connect the end of the second cable to the  
negative (-) terminal of the battery to be jumped. A spark may  
cause an explosion of the gases that surround the battery.  
5. Ensure that the cables are clear of fan blades, belts, moving parts of  
both engines, or any fuel delivery system parts.  
Jump starting  
1. Start the engine of the booster vehicle and run the engine at  
moderately increased speed.  
2. Start the engine of the disabled vehicle.  
3. Once the disabled vehicle has been started, run both engines for an  
additional three minutes before disconnecting the jumper cables.  
248  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Removing the jumper cables  
Remove the jumper cables in the reverse order that they were  
connected.  
1. Remove the jumper cable from the ground metal surface.  
Note: In the illustrations, lightning bolts are used to designate the  
assisting (boosting) battery.  
2. Remove the jumper cable on the negative (-) connection of the  
booster vehicle’s battery.  
249  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
3. Remove the jumper cable from the positive (+) terminal of the booster  
vehicle’s battery.  
4. Remove the jumper cable from the positive (+) terminal of the  
disabled vehicle’s battery.  
After the disabled vehicle has been started and the jumper cables  
removed, allow it to idle for several minutes so the engine computer can  
relearn its idle conditions.  
250  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
WRECKER TOWING  
If you need to have your vehicle towed, contact a professional towing  
service or, if you are a member of a roadside assistance program, your  
roadside assistance service provider.  
Ford recommends your vehicle be towed with a wheel lift or flatbed. Do  
not tow with a slingbelt. Ford Motor Company has not approved a  
slingbelt towing procedure.  
If your vehicle is equipped with an air dam and must be towed from the  
front, it is recommended that your vehicle be towed by wheel lift or  
flatbed equipment to prevent damage to the air dam.  
If the vehicle is towed by other means or incorrectly, vehicle  
damage may occur.  
Ford Motor Company produces a towing manual for all authorized tow  
truck operators. Have your tow truck operator refer to this manual for  
proper hook-up and towing procedures for your vehicle.  
251  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Emergency towing  
In case of a roadside emergency with a disabled vehicle (without access  
to wheel dollies, car hauling trailer, or flatbed transport vehicle) your  
vehicle (regardless of transmission powertrain configuration) can be flat  
towed (all wheels on the ground) under the following conditions:  
Vehicle is facing forward so that it is being towed in a forward  
direction.  
Place the transmission in N (Neutral). Refer to Brake-shift interlock  
in the Driving chapter for specific instructions if you cannot move the  
gear shift lever into N (Neutral).  
Maximum speed is not to exceed 35 mph (56 km/h).  
Maximum distance is 50 miles (80 km).  
252  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
GETTING THE SERVICES YOU NEED  
Warranty repairs to your vehicle must be performed by an authorized  
Ford, Lincoln, or Mercury dealer. While any authorized dealer handling  
your vehicle line will provide warranty service, we recommend you  
return to your selling authorized dealer who wants to ensure your  
continued satisfaction.  
Please note that certain warranty repairs require special training and/or  
equipment, so not all authorized dealers are authorized to perform all  
warranty repairs. This means that, depending on the warranty repair  
needed, you may have to take your vehicle to another authorized dealer.  
A reasonable time must be allowed to perform a repair after taking your  
vehicle to the authorized dealer. Repairs will be made using Ford or  
Motorcraftparts, or remanufactured or other parts that are authorized  
by Ford.  
Away from home  
If you are away from home when your vehicle needs service, contact the  
Ford Customer Relationship Center or use the online resources listed  
below to find the nearest authorized dealer.  
In the United States:  
Mailing Address  
Ford Motor Company  
Customer Relationship Center  
P.O. Box 6248  
Dearborn, MI 48121  
Telephone  
1-800-392-3673 (FORD)  
(TDD for the hearing impaired: 1-800-232-5952  
Online  
Additional information and resources are available online at  
www.genuineservice.com.  
U.S. dealer locator by Dealer Name, City/State, or Zip Code  
Owner Guides  
Maintenance Schedules  
Recalls  
Ford Extended Service Plans  
Ford Genuine Accessories  
Service specials and promotions.  
253  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
In Canada:  
Mailing Address (Ford vehicles)  
Customer Relationship Centre  
Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited  
P.O. Box 2000  
Oakville, Ontario L6J 5E4  
Telephone  
1-800-565-3673 (FORD)  
Online  
www.ford.ca  
Mailing Address (Lincoln vehicles)  
Lincoln Centre  
Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited  
P.O. Box 2000  
Oakville, Ontario L6J 5E4  
Telephone  
1-800-387-9333  
Online  
www.lincolncanada.com  
Away from home–motorhome service  
If you own a motorhome built on a Ford Chassis and are away from  
home when your vehicle needs service, or if you need more help than  
the authorized dealer could provide, after following the steps above,  
contact the Ford Motorhome Customer Assistance Center to find an  
authorized dealer or service location to help you. In the United States  
and Canada:  
Ford Motorhome Customer Assistance Center  
900 N. Lake Havasu Avenue  
Lake Havasu City, AZ 86403  
1-800-444-3311  
Open 365/24/7  
In order to help service your motorhome vehicle, please have the  
following information available when contacting the Motorhome  
Customer Assistance Center:  
telephone number where you can be reached  
vehicle location (city and state)  
year and make of your vehicle  
date of vehicle purchase  
254  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
current odometer reading  
vehicle identification number (VIN)  
Additional Assistance  
If you have questions or concerns, or are unsatisfied with the service you  
are receiving, follow these steps:  
1. Contact your Sales Representative or Service Advisor at your  
selling/servicing authorized dealer.  
2. If your inquiry or concern remains unresolved, contact the Sales  
Manager, Service Manager or Customer Relations Manager.  
3. If you require assistance or clarification on Ford Motor Company  
policies, please contact the Ford Customer Relationship Center  
In order to help you serve you better, please have the following  
information available when contacting a Customer Relationship Center:  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
Your telephone number (home and business)  
The name of the authorized dealer and city where located  
The vehicle’s current odometer reading  
In some states, you must directly notify Ford in writing before pursuing  
remedies under your state’s warranty laws. Ford is also allowed a final  
repair attempt in some states.  
In the United States, a warranty dispute must be submitted to the BBB  
AUTO LINE before taking action under the Magnuson-Moss Warranty  
Act, or to the extent allowed by state law, before pursuing replacement  
or repurchase remedies provided by certain state laws. This dispute  
handling procedure is not required prior to enforcing state created rights  
or other rights which are independent of the Magnuson-Moss Warranty  
Act or state replacement or repurchase laws.  
IN CALIFORNIA (U.S. ONLY)  
California Civil Code Section 1793.2(d) requires that, if a manufacturer  
or its representative is unable to repair a motor vehicle to conform to the  
vehicle’s applicable express warranty after a reasonable number of  
attempts, the manufacturer shall be required to either replace the  
vehicle with one substantially identical or repurchase the vehicle and  
reimburse the buyer in an amount equal to the actual price paid or  
payable by the consumer (less a reasonable allowance for consumer  
use). The consumer has the right to choose whether to receive a refund  
or replacement vehicle.  
255  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
California Civil Code Section 1793.22(b) presumes that the manufacturer  
has had a reasonable number of attempts to conform the vehicle to its  
applicable express warranties if, within the first 18 months of ownership  
of a new vehicle or the first 18,000 miles (29,000 km), whichever occurs  
first:  
1. Two or more repair attempts are made on the same non-conformity  
likely to cause death or serious bodily injury OR  
2. Four or more repair attempts are made on the same nonconformity (a  
defect or condition that substantially impairs the use, value or safety of  
the vehicle) OR  
3. The vehicle is out of service for repair of nonconformities for a total of  
more than 30 calendar days (not necessarily all at one time)  
In the case of 1 or 2 above, the consumer must also notify the  
manufacturer of the need for the repair of the nonconformity at the  
following address:  
Ford Motor Company  
16800 Executive Plaza Drive  
Mail Drop 3NE-B  
Dearborn, MI 48126  
THE BETTER BUSINESS BUREAU (BBB) AUTO LINE PROGRAM  
(U.S. ONLY)  
Your satisfaction is important to Ford Motor Company and to your dealer.  
If a warranty concern has not been resolved using the three-step  
procedure outlined on the first page of the Customer Assistance section,  
you may be eligible to participate in the BBB AUTO LINE program.  
The BBB AUTO LINE program consists of two parts – mediation and  
arbitration. During mediation, a representative of the BBB will contact  
both you and Ford Motor Company to explore options for settlement of  
the claim. If an agreement is not reached during mediation and your  
claim is eligible, you may participate in the arbitration process. An  
arbitration hearing will be scheduled so that you can present your case  
in an informal setting before an impartial person. The arbitrator will  
consider the testimony provided and make a decision after the hearing.  
You are not bound by the decision, but should you choose to accept the  
BBB AUTO LINE decision, Ford must abide by the accepted decision as  
well. Disputes submitted to the BBB AUTO LINE program are usually  
decided within forty days after you file your claim with the BBB.  
BBB AUTO LINE Application: Using the information provided below,  
please call or write to request a program application. You will be asked  
256  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
for your name and address, general information about your new vehicle,  
information about your warranty concerns, and any steps you have  
already taken to try to resolve them. A Customer Claim Form will be  
mailed that will need to be completed, signed and returned to the BBB  
along with proof of ownership. Upon receipt, the BBB will review the  
claim for eligibility under the Program Summary Guidelines.  
You can get more information by calling BBB AUTO LINE at  
1-800-955-5100, or writing to:  
BBB AUTO LINE  
4200 Wilson Boulevard, Suite 800  
Arlington, Virginia 22203–1833  
BBB AUTO LINE applications can also be requested by calling the Ford  
Motor Company Customer Relationship Center at 1-800-392-3673.  
Note: Ford Motor Company reserves the right to change eligibility  
limitations, modify procedures, or to discontinue this process at any time  
without notice and without obligation.  
UTILIZING THE MEDIATION/ARBITRATION PROGRAM  
(CANADA ONLY)  
For vehicles delivered to authorized Canadian dealers. In those cases  
where you continue to feel that the efforts by Ford of Canada and the  
authorized dealer to resolve a factory-related vehicle service concern  
have been unsatisfactory, Ford of Canada participates in an impartial  
third party mediation/arbitration program administered by the Canadian  
Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP).  
The CAMVAP program is a straight-forward and relatively speedy  
alternative to resolve a disagreement when all other efforts to produce a  
settlement have failed. This procedure is without cost to you and is  
designed to eliminate the need for lengthy and expensive legal  
proceedings.  
In the CAMVAP program, impartial third-party arbitrators conduct  
hearings at mutually convenient times and places in an informal  
environment. These impartial arbitrators review the positions of the  
parties, make decisions and, when appropriate, render awards to resolve  
disputes. CAMVAP decisions are fast, fair, and final as the arbitrator’s  
award is binding both to you and Ford of Canada.  
CAMVAP services are available in all territories and provinces. For more  
information, without charge or obligation, call your CAMVAP Provincial  
Administrator directly at 1-800-207-0685.  
257  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
GETTING ASSISTANCE OUTSIDE THE U.S. AND CANADA  
Before exporting your vehicle to a foreign country, contact the  
appropriate foreign embassy or consulate. These officials can inform you  
of local vehicle registration regulations and where to find unleaded fuel.  
If you cannot find unleaded fuel or can only get fuel with an anti-knock  
index lower than is recommended for your vehicle, contact a regional  
office or owner relations/customer relationship office.  
The use of leaded fuel in your vehicle without proper conversion may  
damage the effectiveness of your emission control system and may cause  
engine knocking or serious engine damage. Ford Motor Company/Ford of  
Canada is not responsible for any damage caused by use of improper  
fuel. Using leaded fuel may also result in difficulty importing your vehicle  
back into the U.S.  
If your vehicle must be serviced while you are traveling or living in  
Central America, the Caribbean, or the Middle East, contact the nearest  
authorized dealer. If the authorized dealer cannot help you, contact:  
FORD MOTOR COMPANY  
FORD EXPORT OPERATIONS  
1555 Fairlane Drive  
Fairlane Business Park #3  
Allen Park, Michigan 48101  
U.S.A.  
Telephone: (313) 594-4857  
FAX: (313) 390-0804  
Email: expcac@ford.com  
If you are in another foreign country, contact the nearest authorized  
dealer. If the authorized dealer employees cannot help you, they can  
direct you to the nearest Ford affiliate office.  
If you buy your vehicle in North America and then relocate outside of  
the U.S. or Canada, register your vehicle identification number (VIN) and  
new address with Ford Motor Company Export Operations.  
Customers in the U.S. should call 1-800-392-3673.  
ORDERING ADDITIONAL OWNER’S LITERATURE  
To order the publications in this portfolio, contact Helm, Incorporated at:  
HELM, INCORPORATED  
P.O. Box 07150  
Detroit, Michigan 48207  
Or to order a free publication catalog, call toll free: 1-800-782-4356  
Monday-Friday 8:00 a.m. - 6:00 p.m. EST  
258  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
Helm, Incorporated can also be reached by their website:  
www.helminc.com.  
(Items in this catalog may be purchased by credit card, check or  
money order.)  
Obtaining a French Owner’s Guide  
French Owner’s Guides can be obtained from your authorized dealer or  
by writing to:  
Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited  
Service Publications CHQ202  
The Canadian Road  
P.O. Box 2000  
Oakville, ON, Canada  
L6J 5E4  
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS (U.S. ONLY)  
If you believe that your vehicle has  
a defect which could cause a crash  
or could cause injury or death, you  
should immediately inform the  
National Highway Traffic Safety  
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Ford Motor Company.  
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and  
if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a  
recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved  
in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Ford Motor  
Company.  
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at  
1–888–327–4236 (TTY: 1–800–424–9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov;  
or write to:  
Administrator  
1200 New Jersey Avenue, Southeast  
Washington, D.C. 20590  
You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from  
http://www.safercar.gov.  
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS (CANADA ONLY)  
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or  
could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform Transport  
Canada, using their toll-free number: 1–800–333–0510.  
259  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
WASHING THE EXTERIOR  
Wash your vehicle regularly with cool or lukewarm water and a neutral  
pH shampoo, such as MotorcraftDetail Wash (ZC-3-A), which is  
available from your authorized dealer.  
Never use strong household detergents or soap, such as dish washing  
or laundry liquid. These products can discolor and spot painted  
surfaces.  
Never wash a vehicle that is “hot to the touch” or during exposure to  
strong, direct sunlight.  
Always use a clean sponge or car wash mitt with plenty of water for  
best results.  
Dry the vehicle with a chamois or soft terry cloth towel in order to  
eliminate water spotting.  
It is especially important to wash the vehicle regularly during the  
winter months, as dirt and road salt are difficult to remove and cause  
damage to the vehicle.  
Immediately remove items such as gasoline, diesel fuel, bird droppings  
and insect deposits because they can cause damage to the vehicle’s  
paintwork and trim over time. Use MotorcraftBug and Tar Remover  
(ZC-42), which is available from your authorized dealer.  
Remove any exterior accessories, such as antennas, before entering a  
car wash.  
Suntan lotions and insect repellents can damage any painted  
surface; if these substances come in contact with your vehicle,  
wash off as soon as possible.  
If your vehicle is equipped with running boards, do not use  
rubber, plastic and vinyl protectant products on the running  
board surface, as the area may become slippery.  
Exterior chrome  
Wash the vehicle first, using cool or lukewarm water and a neutral pH  
shampoo, such as MotorcraftDetail Wash (ZC-3-A).  
Use MotorcraftCustom Bright Metal Cleaner (ZC-15), available from  
your authorized dealer. Apply the product as you would a wax to  
clean bumpers and other chrome parts; allow the cleaner to dry for a  
few minutes, then wipe off the haze with a clean, dry rag.  
Never use abrasive materials such as steel wool or plastic pads  
as they can scratch the chrome surface.  
260  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
After polishing chrome bumpers, apply a coating of Motorcraft௡  
Premium Liquid Wax (ZC-53-A), available from your authorized dealer,  
or an equivalent quality product to help protect from environmental  
effects.  
WAXING  
Wash the vehicle first.  
Do not use waxes that contain abrasives; use Motorcraft Premium  
Liquid Wax (ZC-53-A), which is available from your authorized dealer,  
or an equivalent quality product.  
Do not allow paint sealant to come in contact with any non-body  
(low-gloss black) colored trim, such as grained door handles, roof  
racks, bumpers, side moldings, mirror housings or the windshield cowl  
area. The paint sealant will “gray” or stain the parts over time.  
Do not allow paint sealant to come in contact with the sliding door  
electrical contact switches. Paint sealant or other contaminants could  
interfere with the proper operation of the power locks or radio  
speakers. If necessary, clean the contacts with Motorcraft Bug and Tar  
Remover (ZC-42) to remove any sealant. Do not use any abrasives on  
the contact surfaces.  
PAINT CHIPS  
Your authorized dealer has touch-up paint to match your vehicle’s color.  
Take your color code (printed on a sticker in the driver’s door jamb) to  
your authorized dealer to ensure you get the correct color.  
Remove particles such as bird droppings, tree sap, insect deposits, tar  
spots, road salt and industrial fallout before repairing paint chips.  
Always read the instructions before using the products.  
ALUMINUM WHEELS AND WHEEL COVERS  
Aluminum wheels and wheel covers are coated with a clearcoat paint  
finish. In order to maintain their shine:  
Clean weekly with MotorcraftWheel and Tire Cleaner (ZC-37-A),  
which is available from your authorized dealer. Heavy dirt and brake  
dust accumulation may require agitation with a sponge. Rinse  
thoroughly with a strong stream of water.  
Never apply any cleaning chemical to hot or warm wheel rims or  
covers.  
Some automatic car washes may cause damage to the finish on your  
wheel rims or covers. Chemical-strength cleaners, or cleaning  
261  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
chemicals, in combination with brush agitation to remove brake dust  
and dirt, could wear away the clearcoat finish over time.  
Do not use hydrofluoric acid-based or high caustic-based wheel  
cleaners, steel wool, fuels or strong household detergent.  
To remove tar and grease, use MotorcraftBug and Tar Remover  
(ZC-42), available from your authorized dealer.  
ENGINE  
Engines are more efficient when they are clean because grease and dirt  
buildup keep the engine warmer than normal. When washing:  
Take care when using a power washer to clean the engine. The  
high-pressure fluid could penetrate the sealed parts and cause  
damage.  
Do not spray a hot engine with cold water to avoid cracking the  
engine block or other engine components.  
Spray Motorcraft Engine Shampoo and Degreaser (ZC-20) on all parts  
that require cleaning and pressure rinse clean. In Canada, use  
Motorcraft Engine Shampoo (CXC-66-A).  
Cover the highlighted areas to prevent water damage when cleaning  
the engine.  
Never wash or rinse the engine while it is running; water in the  
running engine may cause internal damage.  
Never wash or rinse any ignition coil, spark plug wire or spark plug  
well, or the area in and around these locations.  
262  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
PLASTIC (NON-PAINTED) EXTERIOR PARTS  
Use only approved products to clean plastic parts. These products are  
available from your authorized dealer.  
For routine cleaning, use MotorcraftDetail Wash (ZC-3-A).  
If tar or grease spots are present, use MotorcraftBug and Tar  
Remover (ZC-42).  
WINDOWS AND WIPER BLADES  
The windshield, rear and side windows and the wiper blades should be  
cleaned regularly. If the wipers do not wipe properly, substances on the  
vehicle’s glass or the wiper blades may be the cause. These may include  
hot wax treatments used by commercial car washes, water repellent  
coatings, tree sap, or other organic contamination; these contaminants  
may cause squeaking or chatter noise from the blades, and streaking and  
smearing of the windshield. To clean these items, follow these tips:  
The windshield, rear windows and side windows may be cleaned with  
a non-abrasive cleaner such as MotorcraftUltra-Clear Spray Glass  
Cleaner (ZC-23), available from your authorized dealer.  
The wiper blades can be cleaned with isopropyl (rubbing) alcohol or  
MotorcraftPremium Windshield Washer Concentrate (ZC-32-A),  
available from your authorized dealer. This washer fluid contains  
special solution in addition to alcohol which helps to remove the hot  
wax deposited on the wiper blade and windshield from automated car  
wash facilities. Be sure to replace wiper blades when they appear  
worn or do not function properly.  
Do not use abrasives, as they may cause scratches.  
Do not use fuel, kerosene, or paint thinner to clean any parts.  
If you cannot remove those streaks after cleaning with the glass cleaner  
or if the wipers chatter and move in a jerky motion, clean the outer  
surface of the windshield and the wiper blades using a sponge or soft  
cloth with a neutral detergent or mild-abrasive cleaning solution. After  
cleaning, rinse the windshield and wiper blades with clean water. The  
windshield is clean if beads do not form when you rinse the windshield  
with water.  
263  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
INSTRUMENT PANEL/INTERIOR TRIM AND CLUSTER LENS  
Clean the instrument panel, interior trim areas and cluster lens with a  
clean, damp, white cotton cloth, then use a clean and dry white cotton  
cloth to dry these areas.  
Avoid cleaners or polishes that increase the gloss of the upper portion  
of the instrument panel. The dull finish in this area helps protect the  
driver from undesirable windshield reflection.  
Be certain to wash or wipe your hands clean if you have been in  
contact with certain products such as insect repellent and suntan  
lotion in order to avoid possible damage to the interior painted  
surfaces.  
Do not use household or glass cleaners as these may damage the  
finish of the instrument panel, interior trim and cluster lens.  
WARNING: Do not use chemical solvents or strong detergents  
when cleaning the steering wheel or instrument panel to avoid  
contamination of the airbag system.  
If a staining liquid like coffee/juice has been spilled on the instrument  
panel or on interior trim surfaces, clean as follows:  
1. Wipe up spilled liquid using a clean, white, cotton cloth.  
2. Wipe the surface with a damp, clean, white cotton cloth. For more  
thorough cleaning, use a mild soap and water solution. If the spot cannot  
be completely cleaned by this method, the area may be cleaned using a  
commercially available cleaning product designed for automotive  
interiors.  
3. If necessary, apply more soap and water solution or cleaning product  
to a clean, white, cotton cloth and press the cloth onto the soiled  
area–allow this to set at room temperature for 30 minutes.  
4. Remove the soaked cloth, and if it is not soiled badly, use this cloth to  
clean the area by using a rubbing motion for 60 seconds.  
5. Following this, wipe area dry with a clean, white, cotton cloth.  
264  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
INTERIOR  
For fabric, carpets, cloth seats and safety belts:  
Remove dust and loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner.  
Remove light stains and soil with MotorcraftProfessional Strength  
Carpet & Upholstery Cleaner (ZC-54).  
If grease or tar is present on the material, spot-clean the area first  
with MotorcraftSpot and Stain Remover (ZC-14). In Canada, use  
MotorcraftMulti-Purpose Cleaner (CXC-101).  
If a ring forms on the fabric after spot cleaning, clean the entire area  
immediately (but do not oversaturate) or the ring will set.  
Do not use household cleaning products or glass cleaners, which can  
stain and discolor the fabric and affect the flame retardant abilities of  
the seat materials.  
WARNING: Do not use cleaning solvents, bleach or dye on the  
vehicle’s seatbelts, as these actions may weaken the belt  
webbing.  
LEATHER SEATS (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your leather seating surfaces have a clear, protective coating over the  
leather.  
For routine cleaning, wipe the surface with a soft, damp cloth. For  
more thorough cleaning, wipe the surface with a mild soap and water  
solution. In Canada, use MotorcraftVinyl Cleaner (CXC-93). Dry the  
area with a soft cloth.  
If the leather cannot be completely cleaned using a mild soap and  
water solution, the leather may be cleaned using a commercially  
available cleaning product designed for automotive leather.  
Do not use household cleaning products, alcohol solutions, solvents or  
cleaners intended for rubber, vinyl and plastics, or oil/petroleum-based  
leather conditioners. These products may cause premature wearing of  
the clear, protective coating.  
Note: In some instances, color or dye transfer can occur when wet  
clothing comes in contact with leather upholstery. If this occurs, the  
leather should be cleaned immediately to avoid permanent staining.  
UNDERBODY  
Flush the complete underside of your vehicle frequently. Keep body and  
door drain holes free from packed dirt.  
265  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
FORD AND LINCOLN MERCURY CAR CARE PRODUCTS  
Your Ford or Lincoln Mercury authorized dealer has many quality  
products available to clean your vehicle and protect its finishes. These  
quality products have been specifically engineered to fulfill your  
automotive needs; they are custom designed to complement the style  
and appearance of your vehicle. Each product is made from high quality  
materials that meet or exceed rigid specifications. For best results, use  
the following products or products of equivalent quality:  
MotorcraftBug and Tar Remover (ZC-42)  
MotorcraftCustom Bright Metal Cleaner (ZC-15)  
MotorcraftCustom Clear Coat Polish (ZC-8-A)  
MotorcraftDetail Wash (ZC-3-A)  
MotorcraftDusting Cloth (ZC-24)  
MotorcraftEngine Shampoo and Degreaser (U.S. only) (ZC-20)  
MotorcraftEngine Shampoo (Canada only) (CXC-66-A)  
MotorcraftMulti-Purpose Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-101)  
MotorcraftPremium Glass Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-100)  
MotorcraftPremium Liquid Wax (ZC-53-A)  
MotorcraftPremium Windshield Washer Concentrate (U.S. only)  
(ZC-32-A)  
MotorcraftProfessional Strength Carpet & Upholstery Cleaner (ZC-54)  
MotorcraftSpot and Stain Remover (U.S. only) (ZC-14)  
MotorcraftTire Clean and Shine (ZC-28)  
MotorcraftUltra-Clear Spray Glass Cleaner (ZC-23)  
MotorcraftVinyl Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-93)  
MotorcraftWheel and Tire Cleaner (ZC-37-A)  
266  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
SERVICE RECOMMENDATIONS  
To help you service your vehicle, we provide scheduled maintenance  
information which makes tracking routine service easy.  
If your vehicle requires professional service, your authorized dealer can  
provide the necessary parts and service. Check your Warranty  
Guide/Customer Information Guide to find out which parts and  
services are covered.  
Use only recommended fuels, lubricants, fluids and service parts  
conforming to specifications. Motorcraftparts are designed and built to  
provide the best performance in your vehicle.  
PRECAUTIONS WHEN SERVICING YOUR VEHICLE  
Do not work on a hot engine.  
Make sure that nothing gets caught in moving parts.  
Do not work on a vehicle with the engine running in an enclosed  
space, unless you are sure you have enough ventilation.  
Keep all open flames and other burning material (such as cigarettes)  
away from the battery and all fuel related parts.  
Working with the engine off  
1. Set the parking brake and ensure the gearshift is securely latched in P  
(Park).  
2. Turn off the engine and remove the key.  
3. Block the wheels to prevent the vehicle from moving unexpectedly.  
Working with the engine on  
1. Set the parking brake and shift to P (Park).  
2. Block the wheels.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of vehicle damage and/or  
personal burn injuries, do not start your engine with the air  
cleaner removed and do not remove it while the engine is running.  
267  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
OPENING THE HOOD  
1. Inside the vehicle, pull the hood  
release handle located under the  
bottom left corner of the instrument  
panel.  
HOOD  
2. Go to the front of the vehicle and push the auxiliary latch, located in  
the center top of the grille, to the left to release the hood.  
3. Lift the hood and secure it with the prop rod.  
268  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
IDENTIFYING COMPONENTS IN THE ENGINE COMPARTMENT  
Refer to the 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Power Stroke Direct Injection Turbo  
Diesel Owner’s Guide Supplement for diesel engine component  
locations.  
1. Windshield washer fluid reservoir  
2. Engine oil filler cap  
3. Automatic transmission fluid dipstick  
4. Air filter assembly  
5. Engine oil dipstick  
6. Power steering fluid reservoir  
7. Brake fluid reservoir  
8. Engine coolant reservoir  
9. Power distribution box  
10. Battery  
269  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
WINDSHIELD WASHER FLUID  
Add fluid to fill the reservoir if the  
level is low. In very cold weather, do  
not fill the reservoir completely.  
Only use a washer fluid that meets  
Ford specification WSB-M8B16-A2.  
Do not use any special washer fluid  
such as windshield water repellent  
type fluid or bug wash. They may  
cause squeaking, chatter noise,  
streaking and smearing. Refer to  
Maintenance product  
specifications and capacities in this chapter.  
State or local regulations on volatile organic compounds may restrict the  
use of methanol, a common windshield washer antifreeze additive.  
Washer fluids containing non-methanol antifreeze agents should be used  
only if they provide cold weather protection without damaging the  
vehicle’s paint finish, wiper blades or washer system.  
WARNING: If you operate your vehicle in temperatures below  
40°F (5°C), use washer fluid with antifreeze protection. Failure  
to use washer fluid with antifreeze protection in cold weather could  
result in impaired windshield vision and increase the risk of injury or  
accident.  
Note: Do not put washer fluid in the engine coolant reservoir. Washer  
fluid placed in the cooling system may harm engine and cooling system  
components.  
270  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
CHANGING THE WIPER BLADES  
1. Pull the wiper arm away from the  
vehicle. Turn the blade at an angle  
from the wiper arm. Press the lock  
tab to release the blade and pull the  
wiper blade down toward the  
windshield to remove it from the  
arm.  
2. Attach the new wiper to the  
wiper arm and press it into place  
until a click is heard.  
Replace wiper blades at least once per year for optimum performance.  
Poor wiper quality can be improved by cleaning the wiper blades and the  
windshield. Refer to Windows and wiper blades in the Cleaning  
chapter.  
To prolong the life of the wiper blades, it is highly recommended to  
scrape off the ice on the windshield before turning on the wipers. The  
layer of ice has many sharp edges and can damage the micro edge of the  
wiper rubber element.  
ENGINE OIL  
Checking the engine oil  
Refer to the scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate  
intervals for checking the engine oil.  
1. Make sure the vehicle is on level ground.  
2. Turn the engine off and wait 15 minutes for the oil to drain into the  
oil pan.  
3. Set the parking brake and ensure the gearshift is securely latched in P  
(Park).  
4. Open the hood. Protect yourself from engine heat.  
271  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
5. Locate and carefully remove the  
engine oil level dipstick.  
6. Wipe the dipstick clean. Insert the dipstick fully, then remove it again.  
If the oil level is between the lower and upper holes or between  
the MIN and MAX marks (depending on application), the oil  
level is acceptable. DO NOT ADD OIL.  
If the oil level is below the lower  
hole or the MIN mark, add  
enough oil to raise the level  
within the lower and upper holes  
or within the MIN-MAX range.  
Oil levels above the upper hole or the MAX mark may cause engine  
damage. Some oil must be removed from the engine by an authorized  
dealer.  
7. Put the dipstick back in and ensure it is fully seated.  
Adding engine oil  
1. Check the engine oil. For instructions, refer to Checking the engine  
oil in this chapter.  
2. If the engine oil level is not within the normal range, add only certified  
engine oil of the recommended viscosity. Remove the engine oil filler cap  
and use a funnel to pour the engine oil into the opening.  
3. Recheck the engine oil level. Make sure the oil level is not above the  
normal operating range on the engine oil level dipstick.  
272  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
4. Install the dipstick and ensure it is fully seated.  
5. Fully install the engine oil filler cap by turning the filler cap clockwise  
1/4 of a turn until three clicks are heard or until the cap is fully seated.  
To avoid possible oil loss, DO NOT operate the vehicle with the  
engine oil level dipstick and/or the engine oil filler cap removed.  
Engine oil and filter recommendations  
Look for this certification  
trademark.  
Use SAE 5W-20 engine oil  
Only use oils “Certified For Gasoline Engines” by the American  
Petroleum Institute (API). An oil with this trademark symbol conforms  
to the current engine and emission system protection standards and fuel  
economy requirements of the International Lubricant Standardization and  
Approval Committee (ILSAC), comprised of U.S. and Japanese  
automobile manufacturers.  
To protect your engine and engine’s warranty, use MotorcraftSAE  
5W-20 or an equivalent SAE 5W-20 oil meeting Ford specification  
WSS-M2C930-A. SAE 5W-20 oil provides optimum fuel economy and  
durability performance meeting all requirements for your  
vehicle’s engine. Refer to Maintenance product specifications and  
capacities later in this chapter for more information.  
Do not use supplemental engine oil additives, cleaners or other engine  
treatments. They are unnecessary and could lead to engine damage that  
is not covered by Ford warranty.  
Change your engine oil and filter according to the appropriate schedule  
listed in the scheduled maintenance information.  
Ford production and Motorcraftreplacement oil filters are designed for  
added engine protection and long life. If a replacement oil filter is used  
that does not meet Ford material and design specifications, start-up  
engine noises or knock may be experienced.  
273  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
It is recommended you use the appropriate Motorcraftoil filter or  
another with equivalent performance for your engine application.  
BATTERY  
Your vehicle is equipped with a  
Motorcraftmaintenance-free  
battery which normally does not  
require additional water during its  
life of service.  
WARNING: This vehicle may be equipped with more than one  
battery, removal of cable from only one battery does not  
disconnect the vehicle electrical system. Be sure to disconnect cables  
from all batteries when disconnecting power. Failure to do so may  
cause serious personal injury or property damage.  
If your battery has a cover/shield, make sure it is reinstalled  
after the battery has been cleaned or replaced.  
For longer, trouble-free operation, keep the top of the battery clean and  
dry. Also, make certain the battery cables are always tightly fastened to  
the battery terminals.  
If you see any corrosion on the battery or terminals, remove the cables  
from the terminals and clean with a wire brush. You can neutralize the  
acid with a solution of baking soda and water.  
When the battery is disconnected or a new battery installed, the  
transmission must learn its adaptive strategy. As a result of this, the  
transmission may shift firmly. This operation is considered normal and  
will fully update transmission operation to its optimum shift feel.  
Note: Electrical or electronic accessories or components added to  
the vehicle by the dealer or the owner may adversely affect  
battery performance and durability.  
It is recommended that the negative battery cable terminal be  
disconnected from the battery if you plan to store your vehicle for an  
extended period of time. This will minimize the discharge of your battery  
during storage.  
274  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
WARNING: Batteries normally produce explosive gases which  
can cause personal injury. Therefore, do not allow flames, sparks  
or lighted substances to come near the battery. When working near the  
battery, always shield your face and protect your eyes. Always provide  
proper ventilation.  
WARNING: When lifting a plastic-cased battery, excessive  
pressure on the end walls could cause acid to flow through the  
vent caps, resulting in personal injury and/or damage to the vehicle or  
battery. Lift the battery with a battery carrier or with your hands on  
opposite corners.  
WARNING: Keep batteries out of reach of children. Batteries  
contain sulfuric acid. Avoid contact with skin, eyes or clothing.  
Shield your eyes when working near the battery to protect against  
possible splashing of acid solution. In case of acid contact with skin or  
eyes, flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and  
get prompt medical attention. If acid is swallowed, call a physician  
immediately.  
WARNING: Battery posts, terminals and related accessories  
contain lead and lead compounds. Wash hands after handling.  
For information on transmission operation after the battery has been  
disconnected, refer to Automatic transmission operation in the  
Driving chapter.  
Auxiliary battery (if equipped)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a frame-mounted auxiliary battery  
located on the passenger side frame rail, behind the front passenger  
door. This auxiliary battery is connected to the auxiliary battery relay, so  
it is not used to start the vehicle.  
275  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Battery relearn  
Because your vehicle’s engine is electronically controlled by a computer,  
some control conditions are maintained by power from the battery. When  
the battery is disconnected or a new battery is installed, the engine must  
relearn its idle and fuel trim strategy for optimum driveability and  
performance. Flexible fuel vehicles (FFV) must also relearn the ethanol  
content of the fuel for optimum driveability and performance. To begin  
this process:  
1. With the vehicle at a complete stop, set the parking brake.  
2. Put the gearshift in P (Park), turn off all accessories and start the  
engine.  
3. Run the engine until it reaches normal operating temperature.  
4. Allow the engine to idle for at least one minute.  
5. Turn the A/C on and allow the engine to idle for at least one minute.  
6. Release the parking brake. With your foot on the brake pedal and with  
the A/C on, put the vehicle in D (Drive) and allow the engine to idle for  
at least one minute.  
7. Drive the vehicle to complete the relearning process.  
The vehicle may need to be driven 10 miles (16 km) or more to  
relearn the idle and fuel trim strategy along with the ethanol content  
for flexible fuel vehicles.  
If you do not allow the engine to relearn its idle trim, the idle quality  
of your vehicle may be adversely affected until the idle trim is  
eventually relearned.  
For flexible fuel vehicles, if you are operating on E85, you may  
experience poor starts or an inability to start the engine and  
driveability problems until the fuel trim and ethanol content have been  
relearned.  
If the battery has been disconnected or a new battery has been installed,  
the clock and radio settings must be reset once the battery is  
reconnected.  
276  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Always dispose of automotive  
batteries in a responsible manner.  
Follow your local authorized  
standards for disposal. Call your  
local authorized recycling center  
to find out more about recycling  
automotive batteries.  
RECYCLE  
ENGINE COOLANT  
Checking engine coolant  
The concentration and level of engine coolant should be checked at the  
intervals listed in scheduled maintenance information. The coolant  
concentration should be maintained at 50/50 coolant and distilled water,  
which equates to a freeze point of -34°F (-36°C). Coolant concentration  
testing is possible with a hydrometer or antifreeze tester. The level of  
coolant should be maintained at the FULL COLD level or within the  
COLD FILL RANGE in the coolant reservoir. If the level falls below, add  
coolant per the instructions in the Adding engine coolant section.  
Your vehicle was factory-filled with a 50/50 engine coolant and water  
concentration. If the concentration of coolant falls below 40% or above  
60%, the engine parts could become damaged or not work properly. A  
50/50 mixture of coolant and water provides the following:  
Freeze protection down to -34°F (-36°C).  
Boiling protection up to 265°F (129°C).  
Protection against rust and other forms of corrosion.  
Proper function of calibrated gauges.  
277  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
When the engine is cold, check the  
level of the engine coolant in the  
reservoir.  
The engine coolant should be at the FULL COLD level or within the  
COLD FILL RANGE as listed on the engine coolant reservoir  
(depending upon application).  
Refer to scheduled maintenance information for service interval  
schedules.  
Be sure to read and understand Precautions when servicing your  
vehicle in this chapter.  
If the engine coolant has not been checked at the recommended interval,  
the engine coolant reservoir may become low or empty. If the reservoir is  
low or empty, add engine coolant to the reservoir. Refer to Adding  
engine coolant in this chapter.  
Note: Automotive fluids are not interchangeable; do not use engine  
coolant, antifreeze or windshield washer fluid outside of its specified  
function and vehicle location.  
Adding engine coolant  
When adding coolant, make sure it is a 50/50 mixture of engine coolant  
and distilled water. Add the mixture to the coolant reservoir, when the  
engine is cool, until the appropriate fill level is obtained.  
278  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
WARNING: Do not add engine coolant when the engine is hot.  
Steam and scalding liquids released from a hot cooling system  
can burn you badly. Also, you can be burned if you spill coolant on hot  
engine parts.  
WARNING: Do not put engine coolant in the windshield washer  
fluid container. If sprayed on the windshield, engine coolant  
could make it difficult to see through the windshield.  
Do not mix coolants. Add the coolant type originally equipped  
in your vehicle. Refer to Maintenance product specifications and  
capacities in this chapter.  
Note: Do not use stop leak pellets or cooling system sealants/additives  
as they can cause damage to the engine cooling and/or heating systems.  
This damage would not be covered under your vehicle’s warranty.  
A large amount of water without engine coolant may be added, in case  
of emergency, to reach a vehicle service location. In this instance, the  
cooling system must be drained and refilled with a 50/50 mixture of  
engine coolant and distilled water as soon as possible. Water alone  
(without engine coolant) can cause engine damage from corrosion,  
overheating or freezing.  
Do not use alcohol, methanol, brine or any engine coolants  
mixed with alcohol or methanol antifreeze (coolant). Alcohol  
and other liquids can cause engine damage from overheating or  
freezing.  
Do not add extra inhibitors or additives to the coolant. These  
can be harmful and compromise the corrosion protection of the engine  
coolant.  
For vehicles with overflow coolant systems with a non-pressurized cap  
on the coolant recovery system, add coolant to the coolant recovery  
reservoir when the engine is cool. Add the proper mixture of coolant and  
water to the FULL COLD level. For all other vehicles which have a  
coolant degas system with a pressurized cap, or if it is necessary to  
remove the coolant pressure relief cap on the radiator of a vehicle with  
an overflow system, follow these steps to add engine coolant.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of personal injury, make sure the  
engine is cool before unscrewing the coolant pressure relief cap.  
The cooling system is under pressure; steam and hot liquid can come  
out forcefully when the cap is loosened slightly.  
279  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Add the proper mixture of coolant and water to the cooling system by  
following these steps:  
1. Before you begin, turn the engine off and let it cool.  
2. When the engine is cool, wrap a thick cloth around the coolant  
pressure relief cap on the coolant reservoir (a translucent plastic bottle).  
Slowly turn cap counterclockwise (left) until pressure begins to release.  
3. Step back while the pressure releases.  
4. When you are sure that all the pressure has been released, use the  
cloth to turn it counterclockwise and remove the cap.  
5. Fill the coolant reservoir slowly with the proper coolant mixture, to  
within the COLD FILL RANGE or the FULL COLD level on the reservoir.  
If you removed the radiator cap in an overflow system, fill the radiator  
until the coolant is visible and radiator is almost full.  
6. Replace the cap. Turn until tightly installed. Cap must be tightly  
installed to prevent coolant loss.  
After any coolant has been added, check the coolant concentration (refer  
to Checking engine coolant). If the concentration is not 50/50  
(protection to –34°F/–36°C), drain some coolant and adjust the  
concentration. It may take several drains and additions to obtain a 50/50  
coolant concentration.  
Whenever coolant has been added, the coolant level in the coolant  
reservoir should be checked the next few times you drive the vehicle. If  
necessary, add enough 50/50 concentration of engine coolant and  
distilled water to bring the liquid level to the proper level.  
If you have to add more than 1.0 quart (1.0 liter) of engine coolant per  
month, have your authorized dealer check the engine cooling system.  
Your cooling system may have a leak. Operating an engine with a low  
level of coolant can result in engine overheating and possible engine  
damage.  
Recycled engine coolant  
Ford Motor Company does NOT recommend the use of recycled engine  
coolant since a Ford-approved recycling process is not yet available.  
Used engine coolant should be disposed of in an appropriate  
manner. Follow your community’s regulations and standards for recycling  
and disposing of automotive fluids.  
Coolant refill capacity  
To find out how much fluid your vehicle’s cooling system can hold, refer  
to Maintenance product specifications and capacities in this chapter.  
280  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Fill your engine coolant reservoir as outlined in Adding engine coolant  
in this section.  
Severe climates  
If you drive in extremely cold climates (less than –34°F [–36°C]):  
It may be necessary to increase the coolant concentration  
above 50%.  
NEVER increase the coolant concentration above 60%.  
Increased engine coolant concentrations above 60% will  
decrease the overheat protection characteristics of the engine  
coolant and may cause engine damage.  
Refer to the chart on the coolant container to ensure the  
coolant concentration in your vehicle will provide adequate  
freeze protection at the temperatures in which you drive in the  
winter months.  
If you drive in extremely hot climates:  
It is still necessary to maintain the coolant concentration  
above 40%.  
NEVER decrease the coolant concentration below 40%.  
Decreased engine coolant concentrations below 40% will  
decrease the corrosion protection characteristics of the engine  
coolant and may cause engine damage.  
Decreased engine coolant concentrations below 40% will  
decrease the freeze protection characteristics of the engine  
coolant and may cause engine damage.  
Refer to the chart on the coolant container to ensure the  
coolant concentration in your vehicle will provide adequate  
protection at the temperatures in which you drive.  
Vehicles driven year-round in non-extreme climates should use a 50/50  
mixture of engine coolant and distilled water for optimum cooling system  
and engine protection.  
What you should know about fail-safe cooling (if equipped)  
If the engine coolant supply is depleted, this feature allows the vehicle to  
be driven temporarily before incremental component damage is incurred.  
The “fail-safe” distance depends on ambient temperatures, vehicle load  
and terrain.  
281  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
WARNING: If fail-safe cooling activates, pull off the road as  
soon as safely possible, and turn the engine off, because the  
engine may automatically shut off while driving without further  
indication.  
How fail-safe cooling works  
If the engine begins to overheat:  
The engine coolant temperature gauge will move to the red (hot)  
area.  
The service engine soon  
The engine coolant temperature  
indicator light will illuminate.  
indicator light will illuminate.  
If the engine reaches a preset over-temperature condition, the engine  
will automatically switch to alternating cylinder operation. Each disabled  
cylinder acts as an air pump and cools the engine.  
When this occurs the vehicle will still operate. However:  
The engine power will be limited.  
The air conditioning system will be disabled.  
Continued operation will increase the engine temperature and the engine  
will completely shut down, causing steering and braking effort to  
increase.  
Once the engine temperature cools, the engine can be re-started. Take  
your vehicle to an authorized dealer as soon as possible to minimize  
engine damage.  
When fail-safe mode is activated  
You have limited engine power when in the fail-safe mode, so drive the  
vehicle with caution. The vehicle will not be able to maintain high-speed  
operation and the engine will run rough. Remember that the engine is  
capable of completely shutting down automatically to prevent engine  
damage, therefore:  
1. Pull off the road as soon as safely possible and turn off the engine.  
2. Arrange for the vehicle to be taken to an authorized dealer.  
3. If this is not possible, wait a short period for the engine to cool.  
4. Check the coolant level and replenish if low.  
282  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
WARNING: Never remove the coolant reservoir cap while the  
engine is running or hot.  
5. Re-start the engine and take your vehicle to an authorized dealer.  
Driving the vehicle without repairing the engine problem  
increases the chance of engine damage. Take your vehicle to an  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
FUEL FILTER  
Your vehicle is equipped with a lifetime fuel filter that is integrated with  
the fuel tank. Regular maintenance or replacement is not needed.  
WHAT YOU SHOULD KNOW ABOUT AUTOMOTIVE FUELS  
Important safety precautions  
WARNING: Do not overfill the fuel tank. The pressure in an  
overfilled tank may cause leakage and lead to fuel spray and fire.  
WARNING: The fuel system may be under pressure. If the fuel  
filler cap is venting vapor or if you hear a hissing sound, wait  
until it stops before completely removing the fuel filler cap. Otherwise,  
fuel may spray out and injure you or others.  
WARNING: If you do not use the proper fuel filler cap,  
excessive vacuum in the fuel tank may damage the fuel system  
or cause the fuel cap to disengage in a collision, which may result in  
serious personal injury.  
WARNING: Automotive fuels can cause serious injury or death  
if misused or mishandled.  
WARNING: Fuel ethanol and gasoline may contain benzene,  
which is a cancer-causing agent.  
283  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Observe the following guidelines when handling automotive fuel:  
Extinguish all smoking materials  
and any open flames before  
fueling your vehicle.  
Always turn off the vehicle before  
fueling.  
Automotive fuels can be harmful  
or fatal if swallowed. Fuels such as gasoline and ethanol are highly  
toxic and if swallowed can cause death or permanent injury. If fuel is  
swallowed, call a physician immediately, even if no symptoms are  
immediately apparent. The toxic effects of fuel may not be visible for  
hours.  
Avoid inhaling fuel vapors. Inhaling too much fuel vapor of any kind  
can lead to eye and respiratory tract irritation. In severe cases,  
excessive or prolonged breathing of fuel vapor can cause serious  
illness and permanent injury.  
Avoid getting fuel liquid in your eyes. If fuel is splashed in the eyes,  
remove contact lenses (if worn), flush with water for 15 minutes and  
seek medical attention. Failure to seek proper medical attention could  
lead to permanent injury.  
Fuels can also be harmful if absorbed through the skin. If fuel is  
splashed on the skin and/or clothing, promptly remove contaminated  
clothing and wash skin thoroughly with soap and water. Repeated or  
prolonged skin contact with fuel liquid or vapor causes skin irritation.  
Be particularly careful if you are taking “Antabuse” or other forms of  
disulfiram for the treatment of alcoholism. Breathing gasoline and/or  
ethanol vapors, or skin contact could cause an adverse reaction. In  
sensitive individuals, serious personal injury or sickness may result. If  
fuel is splashed on the skin, promptly wash skin thoroughly with soap  
and water. Consult a physician immediately if you experience an  
adverse reaction.  
FFV fuel tanks may contain zero to 85 percent ethanol. Any fuel  
blends containing gasoline and ethanol should be treated the same as  
“Fuel Ethanol.” To identify if your vehicle is an FFV, it may be  
equipped with a yellow fuel cap with the text “E85/Gasoline”, or check  
if there is a label on the fuel filler door.  
284  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Pure ethanol is the alcohol which is the intoxicating agent in liquor, beer  
and wine. It is distilled from the fermentation of plants such as field corn  
and sugar cane. When ethanol is produced for use in motor fuels, a small  
amount of gasoline is added to make it unfit for beverage use. The  
resulting ethanol blend is called denatured fuel ethanol meaning that it is  
denatured with 2% to 5% gasoline and is suitable for automotive use.  
During the summer season, fuel ethanol may contain a maximum of 85%  
denatured ethanol (Ed85) and 15% unleaded gasoline. The fuel ethanol  
has a higher octane rating than unleaded regular or premium gasoline  
and this allows the design of engines with greater efficiency and power.  
Winter blends may contain up to 75% denatured ethanol (Ed75) and up  
to 25% unleaded gasoline to enhance cold engine starts. Severely cold  
weather may require additional measures for reliable starting. Refer to  
Starting in the Driving chapter.  
Ethanol is more chemically active than gasoline. It corrodes some metals  
and causes some plastic and rubber components to swell, break down or  
become brittle and crack, especially when mixed with gasoline. Special  
materials and procedures have been developed for flexible fuel vehicles  
and the dispensers used by ethanol fuel providers.  
WARNING: Flexible fuel components and standard unleaded  
gasoline fuel components are not interchangeable. If your vehicle  
is not serviced in accordance with flexible fuel vehicles procedures,  
damage may occur and your warranty may be invalidated.  
WARNING: When refueling always shut the engine off and  
never allow sparks or open flames near the filler neck. Never  
smoke while refueling. Fuel vapor is extremely hazardous under certain  
conditions. Care should be taken to avoid inhaling excess fumes.  
WARNING: The flow of fuel through a fuel pump nozzle can  
produce static electricity, which can cause a fire if fuel is  
pumped into an ungrounded fuel container.  
285  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Refueling  
WARNING: Fuel vapor burns violently and a fuel fire can cause  
severe injuries. To help avoid injuries to you and others:  
Read and follow all the instructions on the pump island;  
Turn off your engine when you are refueling;  
Do not smoke if you are near fuel or refueling your vehicle;  
Keep sparks, flames and smoking materials away from fuel;  
Stay outside your vehicle and do not leave the fuel pump unattended  
when refueling your vehicle — this is against the law in some places;  
Keep children away from the fuel pump; never let children pump  
fuel.  
Use the following guidelines to avoid electrostatic charge build-up when  
filling an ungrounded fuel container:  
Place approved fuel container on the ground.  
DO NOT fill a fuel container while it is in the vehicle (including the  
cargo area).  
Keep the fuel pump nozzle in contact with the fuel container while  
filling.  
DO NOT use a device that would hold the fuel pump handle in the fill  
position.  
Fuel filler cap  
Your fuel tank filler cap has an indexed design with a 1/4 turn on/off  
feature.  
When fueling your vehicle:  
1. Turn the engine off.  
2. Carefully turn the filler cap counterclockwise until it spins off.  
3. Pull to remove the cap from the fuel filler pipe.  
4. To install the cap, align the tabs on the cap with the notches on the  
filler pipe.  
5. Turn the filler cap clockwise 1/4 of a turn until it clicks at least once.  
If the check fuel cap light  
or a “check fuel cap” message comes on,  
the fuel filler cap may not be properly installed. The light or message can  
come on after several driving events after you’ve refueled your vehicle.  
286  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
At the next opportunity, safely pull off of the road, remove the fuel filler  
cap, align the cap properly and reinstall it. The check fuel cap  
light  
or “check fuel cap” message may not reset immediately; it may  
or “check fuel  
take several driving cycles for the check fuel cap light  
cap” message to turn off. A driving cycle consists of an engine start-up  
(after four or more hours with the engine off) followed by city and  
highway driving.  
Continuing to drive with the check fuel cap light  
or “check fuel cap”  
message on may cause the light to turn on as well.  
If you must replace the fuel filler cap, replace it with a fuel filler  
cap that is designed for your vehicle. The customer warranty may  
be void for any damage to the fuel tank or fuel system if the  
correct genuine Ford, Motorcraft or other certified fuel filler cap  
is not used.  
WARNING: The fuel system may be under pressure. If the fuel  
filler cap is venting vapor or if you hear a hissing sound, wait  
until it stops before completely removing the fuel filler cap. Otherwise,  
fuel may spray out and injure you or others.  
WARNING: If you do not use the proper fuel filler cap,  
excessive vacuum in the fuel tank may damage the fuel system  
or cause the fuel cap to disengage in a collision, which may result in  
personal injury.  
FFV (Flex Fuel Vehicle) fuel cap  
If your vehicle is FFV capable, it will have a yellow colored fuel cap.  
287  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Choosing the right fuel  
If your vehicle is a flexible fuel vehicle (FFV), use only UNLEADED  
FUEL and FUEL ETHANOL (Ed75–Ed85).  
If your vehicle is not a flexible fuel vehicle (FFV), then only use  
UNLEADED fuel or UNLEADED fuel blended with a maximum of 10%  
ethanol. Do not use fuel ethanol (E85), diesel, methanol, leaded fuel or  
any other fuel.  
The use of leaded fuel is prohibited by law and could damage your  
vehicle.  
Your vehicle was not designed to use fuel or fuel additives with metallic  
compounds, including manganese-based additives.  
Note: Use of any fuel other than those recommended may cause  
powertrain damage, a loss of vehicle performance, and repairs may not  
be covered under warranty.  
Cleaner air  
Ford endorses the use of reformulated “cleaner-burning” gasolines to  
improve air quality, per the recommendations in the Choosing the right  
fuel section.  
Octane recommendations  
Your vehicle is designed to use “Regular” unleaded gasoline with a pump  
(R+M)/2 octane rating of 87. Some stations offer fuels posted as  
“Regular” with an octane rating below 87, particularly in high altitude  
areas. Fuels with octane levels below 87 are not recommended.  
Do not be concerned if your engine  
sometimes knocks lightly. However,  
if it knocks heavily under most  
87  
driving conditions while you are  
(R+M)/2 METHOD  
using fuel with the recommended  
octane rating, see your authorized dealer to prevent any engine damage.  
FFV engine (if equipped)  
If your vehicle is flex fuel capable, it is designed to use Fuel Ethanol  
(Ed75–Ed85), “Regular” unleaded gasoline or any mixture of the two  
fuels.  
Use of other fuels such as Fuel Methanol may cause powertrain  
damage, a loss of vehicle performance, and your warranty may be  
invalidated.  
It is best not to alternate repeatedly between gasoline and E85. If you do  
switch fuels, it is recommended that you add as much fuel as  
288  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
possible—at least half a tank. Do not add less than five gallons (18.9L)  
when refueling. You should drive the vehicle immediately after refueling  
for at least 5 miles (8 km) to allow the vehicle to adapt to the change in  
ethanol concentration.  
If you operate your vehicle 50% or more of the time on ethanol, you  
should follow a different maintenance schedule. In addition to this, if you  
exclusively use E85 fuel, it is also recommended to fill the fuel tank with  
regular unleaded gasoline once every 3,000 miles (4,800 km). See  
scheduled maintenance information for more information.  
Fuel quality  
Do not add aftermarket fuel additive products to your fuel tank. It  
should not be necessary to add any aftermarket products to your fuel  
tank if you continue to use high quality fuel of the recommended octane  
rating. These products have not been approved for your engine and  
could cause damage to the fuel system. Repairs to correct the effects of  
using an aftermarket product in your fuel may not be covered by your  
warranty.  
Many of the world’s automakers approved the World-Wide Fuel Charter  
that recommends gasoline specifications to provide improved  
performance and emission control system protection for your vehicle.  
Gasolines that meet the World-Wide Fuel Charter should be used when  
available. Ask your fuel supplier about gasolines that meet the  
World-Wide Fuel Charter.  
Running out of fuel  
Avoid running out of fuel because this situation may have an adverse  
effect on powertrain components.  
If you have run out of fuel:  
You may need to cycle the ignition from off to on several times after  
refueling to allow the fuel system to pump the fuel from the tank to  
the engine. On restarting, cranking time will take a few seconds longer  
than normal.  
Normally, adding 1 gallon (3.8L) of fuel is enough to restart the  
engine. If the vehicle is out of fuel and on a steep grade, more than  
1 gallon (3.8L) may be required.  
The service engine soon  
indicator may come on. For more  
indicator, refer to  
information on the service engine soon  
Warning lights and chimes in the Instrument Cluster chapter.  
289  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
ESSENTIALS OF GOOD FUEL ECONOMY  
Measuring techniques  
Your best source of information about actual fuel economy is you, the  
driver. You must gather information as accurately and consistently as  
possible. Fuel expense, frequency of fill-ups or fuel gauge readings are  
NOT accurate as a measure of fuel economy. We do not recommend  
taking fuel economy measurements during the first 1,000 miles  
(1,600 km) of driving (engine break-in period). You will get a more  
accurate measurement after 2,000 miles–3,000 miles  
(3,000 km–5,000 km).  
Filling the tank  
The advertised fuel capacity of the fuel tank on your vehicle is equal to  
the rated refill capacity of the fuel tank as listed in the Maintenance  
product specifications and capacities section of this chapter.  
The advertised capacity is the amount of the indicated capacity and the  
empty reserve combined. Indicated capacity is the difference in the  
amount of fuel in a full tank and a tank when the fuel gauge indicates  
empty. Empty reserve is the small amount of fuel remaining in the fuel  
tank after the fuel gauge indicates empty.  
The amount of usable fuel in the empty reserve varies and should  
not be relied upon to increase driving range. When refueling your  
vehicle after the fuel gauge indicates empty, you might not be  
able to refuel the full amount of the advertised capacity of the  
fuel tank due to the empty reserve still present in the tank.  
For consistent results when filling the fuel tank:  
Turn the engine/ignition switch to the off position prior to refueling,  
an error in the reading will result if the engine is left running.  
Use the same filling rate setting (low — medium — high) each time  
the tank is filled.  
Allow no more than two automatic click-offs when filling.  
Always use fuel with the recommended octane rating.  
Use a known quality gasoline, preferably a national brand.  
Use the same side of the same pump and have the vehicle facing the  
same direction each time you fill up.  
Have the vehicle loading and distribution the same every time.  
Your results will be most accurate if your filling method is consistent.  
290  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Calculating fuel economy  
1. Fill the fuel tank completely and record the initial odometer reading  
(in miles or kilometers).  
2. Each time you fill the tank, record the amount of fuel added (in  
gallons or liters).  
3. After at least three to five tank fill-ups, fill the fuel tank and record  
the current odometer reading.  
4. Subtract your initial odometer reading from the current odometer  
reading.  
5. Follow one of the simple calculations in order to determine fuel  
economy:  
Calculation 1: Divide total miles traveled by total gallons used.  
Calculation 2: Multiply liters used by 100, then divide by total  
kilometers traveled.  
Keep a record for at least one month and record the type of driving (city  
or highway). This will provide an accurate estimate of the vehicle’s fuel  
economy under current driving conditions. Additionally, keeping records  
during summer and winter will show how temperature impacts fuel  
economy. In general, lower temperatures give lower fuel economy.  
Driving style — good driving and fuel economy habits  
Give consideration to the lists that follow and you may be able to change  
a number of variables and improve your fuel economy.  
Habits  
Smooth, moderate operation can yield up to 10% savings in fuel.  
Steady speeds without stopping will usually give the best fuel  
economy.  
Idling for long periods of time (greater than one minute) may waste  
fuel.  
Anticipate stopping; slowing down may eliminate the need to stop.  
Sudden or hard accelerations may reduce fuel economy.  
Slow down gradually.  
Driving at reasonable speeds (traveling at 55 mph [88 km/h] uses 15%  
less fuel than traveling at 65 mph [105 km/h]).  
Revving the engine before turning it off may reduce fuel economy.  
Using the air conditioner or defroster may reduce fuel economy.  
291  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
You may want to turn off the speed control in hilly terrain if  
unnecessary shifting between the top gears occurs. Unnecessary  
shifting of this type could result in reduced fuel economy.  
Warming up a vehicle on cold mornings is not required and may  
reduce fuel economy.  
Resting your foot on the brake pedal while driving may reduce fuel  
economy.  
Combine errands and minimize stop-and-go driving.  
Maintenance  
Keep tires properly inflated and use only recommended size.  
Operating a vehicle with the wheels out of alignment will reduce fuel  
economy.  
Use recommended engine oil. Refer to Maintenance product  
specifications and capacities in this chapter.  
Perform all regularly scheduled maintenance items. Follow the  
recommended maintenance schedule and owner maintenance checks  
found in scheduled maintenance information.  
Conditions  
Heavily loading a vehicle or towing a trailer may reduce fuel economy  
at any speed.  
Carrying unnecessary weight may reduce fuel economy (approximately  
1 mpg [0.4 km/L] is lost for every 400 lb [180 kg] of weight carried).  
Adding certain accessories to your vehicle (for example bug  
deflectors, rollbars/light bars, running boards, ski racks) may reduce  
fuel economy.  
Using fuel blended with alcohol may lower fuel economy.  
Fuel economy may decrease with lower temperatures during the first  
8–10 miles (12–16 km) of driving.  
Driving on flat terrain offers improved fuel economy as compared to  
driving on hilly terrain.  
Transmissions give their best fuel economy when operated in the top  
cruise gear and with steady pressure on the gas pedal.  
Close windows for high speed driving.  
EPA fuel economy estimates  
Every new vehicle should have a sticker on the window called the  
Monroney Label which contains EPA fuel economy estimates. Contact  
292  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
your authorized dealer if the Monroney label is not supplied with your  
vehicle. The EPA fuel economy estimates should be your guide for the  
fuel economy comparisons with other vehicles. Your fuel economy may  
vary depending upon the method of operation and conditions.  
Note: Vehicles over 8,500 GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) will not have fuel  
economy information printed on the window sticker.  
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM  
Your vehicle is equipped with various emission control components and a  
catalytic converter which will enable your vehicle to comply with  
applicable exhaust emission standards. To make sure that the catalytic  
converter and other emission control components continue to work  
properly:  
Use only the specified fuel listed.  
Avoid running out of fuel.  
Do not turn off the ignition while your vehicle is moving, especially at  
high speeds.  
Have the items listed in scheduled maintenance information  
performed according to the specified schedule.  
The scheduled maintenance items listed in scheduled maintenance  
information are essential to the life and performance of your vehicle  
and to its emissions system.  
If other than Ford, Motorcraftor Ford-authorized parts are used for  
maintenance replacements or for service of components affecting  
emission control, such non-Ford parts should be equivalent to genuine  
Ford Motor Company parts in performance and durability.  
WARNING: Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle in dry grass  
or other dry ground cover. The emission system heats up the  
engine compartment and exhaust system, which can start a fire.  
Illumination of the service engine soon  
indicator, charging system  
warning light or the temperature warning light, fluid leaks, strange odors,  
smoke or loss of engine power could indicate that the emission control  
system is not working properly.  
An improperly operating or damaged exhaust system may allow exhaust  
to enter the vehicle. Have a damaged or improperly operating exhaust  
system inspected and repaired immediately.  
293  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
WARNING: Exhaust leaks may result in entry of harmful and  
potentially lethal fumes into the passenger compartment.  
Do not make any unauthorized changes to your vehicle or engine. By  
law, vehicle owners and anyone who manufactures, repairs, services,  
sells, leases, trades vehicles, or supervises a fleet of vehicles are not  
permitted to intentionally remove an emission control device or prevent  
it from working. Information about your vehicle’s emission system is on  
the Vehicle Emission Control Information Decal located on or near the  
engine. This decal also lists engine displacement.  
Please consult your Warranty Guide/Customer Information Guide for  
complete emission warranty information.  
On board diagnostics (OBD-II)  
Your vehicle is equipped with a computer that monitors the engine’s  
emission control system. This system is commonly known as the On  
Board Diagnostics System (OBD-II). The OBD-II system protects the  
environment by ensuring that your vehicle continues to meet  
government emission standards. The OBD-II system also assists your  
authorized dealer in properly servicing your vehicle. When the service  
engine soon  
a malfunction. Temporary malfunctions may cause the service engine  
soon indicator to illuminate. Examples are:  
indicator illuminates, the OBD-II system has detected  
1. The vehicle has run out of fuel—the engine may misfire or run poorly.  
2. Poor fuel quality or water in the fuel—the engine may misfire or run  
poorly.  
3. The fuel cap may not have been securely tightened. See Fuel filler  
cap in this chapter.  
4. Driving through deep water—the electrical system may be wet.  
These temporary malfunctions can be corrected by filling the fuel tank  
with good quality fuel, properly tightening the fuel cap or letting the  
electrical system dry out. After three driving cycles without these or any  
other temporary malfunctions present, the service engine soon  
indicator should stay off the next time the engine is started. A driving  
cycle consists of a cold engine startup followed by mixed city/highway  
driving. No additional vehicle service is required.  
If the service engine soon  
indicator remains on, have your vehicle  
serviced at the first available opportunity. Although some malfunctions  
294  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
detected by the OBD-II may not have symptoms that are apparent,  
continued driving with the service engine soon  
indicator on can  
result in increased emissions, lower fuel economy, reduced engine and  
transmission smoothness, and lead to more costly repairs.  
Readiness for Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) testing  
Some state/provincial and local governments may have  
Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) programs to inspect the emission control  
equipment on your vehicle. Failure to pass this inspection could prevent  
you from getting a vehicle registration. Your vehicle may not pass the I/M  
test if the service engine soon  
indicator is on or not working  
properly (bulb is burned out), or if the OBD-II system has determined  
that some of the emission control systems have not been properly  
checked. In this case, the vehicle is considered not ready for I/M testing.  
If the service engine soon  
indicator is on or the bulb does not  
work, the vehicle may need to be serviced. Refer to the On board  
diagnostics (OBD-II) description in this chapter.  
If the vehicle’s engine or transmission has just been serviced, or the  
battery has recently run down or been replaced, the OBD-II system may  
indicate that the vehicle is not ready for I/M testing. To determine if the  
vehicle is ready for I/M testing, turn the ignition key to the on position  
for 15 seconds without cranking the engine. If the service engine  
soon  
indicator blinks eight times, it means that the vehicle is not  
ready for I/M testing; if the service engine soon  
indicator stays on  
solid, it means that the vehicle is ready for I/M testing.  
The OBD-II system is designed to check the emission control system  
during normal driving. A complete check may take several days. If the  
vehicle is not ready for I/M testing, the following driving cycle consisting  
of mixed city and highway driving may be performed:  
15 minutes of steady driving on an expressway/highway followed by  
20 minutes of stop-and-go driving with at least four 30-second idle  
periods.  
Allow the vehicle to sit for at least eight hours without starting the  
engine. Then, start the engine and complete the above driving cycle. The  
engine must warm up to its normal operating temperature. Once started,  
do not turn off the engine until the above driving cycle is complete. If  
the vehicle is still not ready for I/M testing, the above driving cycle will  
have to be repeated.  
295  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
POWER STEERING FLUID  
Check the power steering fluid.  
Refer to the scheduled maintenance  
guide for more information.  
Check the fluid level when it is at ambient temperature, 20°-80°F  
(-7°-25°C):  
1. Check the fluid level on the dipstick. It should be between the arrows  
in the FULL COLD range. Do not add fluid if the level is within this  
range.  
2. If the fluid level is low, start the engine.  
3. While the engine idles, turn the steering wheel left and right several  
times.  
4. Turn the engine off.  
WARNING: For E-350 and E-450 vehicles with the Hydro-Boost  
Brake System, do not press the brake pedal after the engine has  
been turned off. Pressing the brake pedal after the engine has been  
turned off will give a false power steering fluid level reading.  
5. Recheck the fluid level on the dipstick. Do not add fluid if the level is  
between the arrows in the FULL COLD range.  
296  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
6. If the fluid is low, add fluid in small amounts, continuously checking  
the level until it reaches the FULL COLD range. Be sure to put the  
dipstick back in the reservoir. Refer to Maintenance product  
specifications and capacities in this chapter for the proper fluid type.  
BRAKE FLUID  
E-150/E-350 Single Rear Wheel  
E-350/E-450 Dual Rear Wheel  
The fluid level will drop slowly as the brakes wear, and will rise when the  
brake components are replaced. Fluid levels between the MIN and MAX  
lines are within the normal operating range; there is no need to add  
fluid. If the fluid levels are outside of the normal operating range, the  
performance of the system could be compromised; seek service from  
your authorized dealer immediately.  
DRIVELINE UNIVERSAL JOINT AND SLIP YOKE  
Your vehicle may be equipped with universal joints that require  
lubrication. Refer to the scheduled maintenance information for  
maintenance intervals. If the original universal joints are replaced with  
universal joints equipped with grease fittings, lubrication will also be  
necessary.  
297  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
TRANSMISSION FLUID  
Checking automatic transmission fluid (if equipped)  
Refer to your scheduled maintenance information for scheduled  
intervals for fluid checks and changes. Your transmission does not  
consume fluid. However, the fluid level should be checked if the  
transmission is not working properly, i.e., if the transmission slips or  
shifts slowly or if you notice some sign of fluid leakage.  
Automatic transmission fluid expands when warmed. To obtain an  
accurate fluid check, drive the vehicle until it is at normal operating  
temperature (approximately 20 miles [30 km]). If your vehicle has been  
operated for an extended period at high speeds, in city traffic during hot  
weather or pulling a trailer, the vehicle should be turned off for about  
30 minutes to allow fluid to cool before checking.  
1. Drive the vehicle 20 miles (30 km) or until it reaches normal operating  
temperature.  
2. Park the vehicle on a level surface and engage the parking brake.  
3. With the parking brake engaged and your foot on the brake pedal,  
start the engine and move the gearshift lever through all of the gear  
ranges. Allow sufficient time for each gear to engage.  
4. Latch the gearshift lever in P (Park) and leave the engine running.  
5. Remove the dipstick, wiping it clean with a clean, dry lint free rag. If  
necessary, refer to Identifying components in the engine compartment  
in this chapter for the location of the dipstick.  
6. Install the dipstick making sure it is fully seated in the filler tube.  
7. Remove the dipstick and inspect the fluid level. The fluid should be in  
the designated area for normal operating temperature or ambient  
temperature.  
298  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Low fluid level  
Do not drive the vehicle if the fluid level is at the bottom of the dipstick  
and the ambient temperature is above 50°F (10°C).  
ADD  
COLD  
HOT  
DO NOT ADD  
Correct fluid level  
The transmission fluid should be checked at normal operating  
temperature 150°F-170°F (66°C-77°C) on a level surface. The normal  
operating temperature can be reached after approximately 20 miles  
(30 km) of driving.  
You can check the fluid without driving if the ambient temperature is  
above 50°F (10°C). However, if fluid is added at this time, an overfill  
condition could result when the vehicle reaches normal operating  
temperature.  
299  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
ADD  
COLD  
HOT  
DO NOT ADD  
The transmission fluid should be in this range if at normal operating  
temperature (150°F-170°F [66°C-77°C]).  
DON'T ADD IF IN CROSSHATCHED AREA  
CHECK WHEN HOT  
IDLING IN PARK  
ADD  
COLD  
HOT  
DO NOT ADD  
The transmission fluid should be in this range if at ambient temperature  
(50°F-95°F [10°C-35°C]).  
300  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
High fluid level  
DON'T ADD IF IN CROSSHATCHED AREA  
CHECK WHEN HOT  
IDLING IN PARK  
ADD  
COLD  
HOT  
DO NOT ADD  
Fluid levels above the safe range may result in transmission failure.  
An overfill condition of transmission fluid may cause shift and/or  
engagement concerns and/or possible damage.  
High fluid levels can be caused by an overheating condition.  
Adjusting automatic transmission fluid levels  
Before adding any fluid, make sure the correct type is used. The type of  
fluid used is normally indicated on the dipstick. Refer to Maintenance  
product specifications and capacities in this chapter.  
Use of a non-approved automatic transmission fluid may cause  
internal transmission component damage.  
If necessary, add fluid in 1/2 pint (250 ml) increments through the filler  
tube until the level is correct.  
301  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
DON'T ADD IF IN CROSSHATCHED AREA  
CHECK WHEN HOT  
IDLING IN PARK  
ADD  
COLD  
HOT  
DO NOT ADD  
If an overfill occurs, excess fluid should be removed by an authorized  
dealer.  
An overfill condition of transmission fluid may cause shift and/or  
engagement concerns and/or possible damage.  
Do not use supplemental transmission fluid additives, treatments or  
cleaning agents. The use of these materials may affect transmission  
operation and result in damage to internal transmission components.  
302  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Automatic transmission fluid filter  
The Torqshift automatic  
transmission is equipped with a  
serviceable transmission fluid filter  
located inside the transmission  
bottom pan.  
Refer to scheduled maintenance  
information for service intervals for  
automatic transmission fluid and  
transmission filter.  
For transmission filter maintenance,  
see your authorized dealer.  
AIR FILTER  
Refer to scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate  
intervals for changing the air filter element.  
When changing the air filter element, use only the air filter element  
listed. Refer to Motorcraftpart numbers in this chapter.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of vehicle damage and/or  
personal burn injuries do not start your engine with the air  
cleaner removed and do not remove it while the engine is running.  
303  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Changing the air filter element  
1. Disconnect the fresh air inlet tube  
from the radiator support.  
2. Open the clamp that secures the  
two halves of the air filter housing  
together.  
3. Carefully separate the two halves  
of the air filter housing.  
4. Remove the air filter element  
from the housing.  
5. Install a new air filter element. Be careful not to crimp the filter  
element edges between the air filter housing. This could cause filter  
damage and allow unfiltered air to enter the engine if not properly  
seated.  
6. Replace the two halves of the air filter housing and secure the clamp.  
7. Connect the fresh air inlet tube to the radiator support.  
Note: Failure to use the correct air filter element may result in severe  
engine damage. The customer warranty may be void for any damage to  
the engine if the correct air filter element is not used.  
304  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
MOTORCRAFT PART NUMBERS  
6.8L V10  
engine  
Component*  
4.6L V8 engine 5.4L V8 engine  
Air filter element  
Battery-  
FA-1632  
FA-1632  
FA-1632  
BXT-65-650 /  
(BXT-65-750)  
BXT-65-650 /  
(BXT-65-750)  
BXT-65-650 /  
(BXT-65-750)  
standard /  
(auxiliary)  
Oil filter  
Spark plugs  
Torqshift  
automatic  
transmission  
internal  
FL-820-S  
FL-820-S  
FL-820-S  
FT-180  
1
FT-180  
bottom–pan  
filter2  
*Refer to the 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Power Stroke Direct Injection Turbo  
Diesel Owner’s Guide Supplement for Motorcraftdiesel engine service  
part numbers.  
1For spark plug replacement, see your authorized dealer. Refer to  
scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate intervals for  
changing the spark plugs.  
Replace the spark plugs with ones that meet Ford material and  
design specifications for your vehicle, such as Motorcraftor  
equivalent replacement parts. The customer warranty may be  
void for any damage to the engine if such spark plugs are not  
used.  
2Also available with 6.0L diesel engine/TorqShift transmission.  
305  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
306  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
307  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
308  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
309  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
ENGINE DATA  
6.8L V10 en-  
gine  
Engine1  
4.6L V8 engine 5.4L V8 engine  
Cubic inches  
Required fuel  
281  
87 octane or  
E852  
330  
87 octane or  
E852  
415  
87 octane  
1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8  
1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8  
1-6-5-10-2-7-3-8-  
4-9  
Firing order  
Ignition system Coil on plug  
Coil on plug  
Coil on plug  
0.041–0.047 inch 0.051–0.057 inch 0.052–0.056 inch  
(1.04–1.20mm) (1.29–1.45mm) (1.32–1.42mm)  
Spark plug gap  
Compression  
ratio  
9.4:1  
9.0:1  
9.0:1  
1Refer to the 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Power Stroke Direct Injection Turbo  
Diesel Owner’s Guide Supplement for diesel engine information.  
24.6L V8 and 5.4L V8 FFV engines only.  
Engine drivebelt routing  
4.6L V8, 5.4L V8 and 6.8L V10 engines without A/C  
310  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
4.6L V8, 5.4L V8 and 6.8L V10 engines with A/C  
IDENTIFYING YOUR VEHICLE  
Safety Compliance Certification Label  
(complete Ford built vehicles)  
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration Regulations require  
that a Safety Compliance Certification Label be affixed to a vehicle and  
prescribe where the Safety Compliance Certification Label may be  
located. The Safety Compliance Certification Label is located on the  
structure (B-Pillar) by the trailing edge of the driver’s door or the edge  
of the driver’s door.  
311  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Vehicle identification number (VIN)  
The VIN is located on the driver side instrument panel or on the  
certification label. It contains the following information:  
1. World manufacturer identifier  
2. Brake system / Gross Vehicle  
Weight Rating (GVWR) / Restraint  
Devices and their location  
3. Make, vehicle line, series, body  
type  
4. Engine type  
5. Check digit  
6. Model year  
7. Assembly plant  
8. Production sequence number  
Certification label for incomplete vehicles  
On completed derivations of incomplete vehicles, the certification label is  
affixed at a location determined by a subsequent stage manufacturer of  
the completed vehicle. In these cases the completed vehicle is  
manufactured in two or more stages by two or more separate  
manufacturers.  
312  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
TRANSMISSION CODE DESIGNATIONS  
You can find a transmission code on the Safety Compliance Certification  
Label. The following table tells you which transmission each code  
represents.  
Description  
Code  
Four-speed automatic overdrive (4R75E)  
Five-speed automatic TorqShift with Tow/Haul  
Five-speed automatic 5R110W-Hi/Torque  
Q
T
B
313  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories  
GENUINE FORD ACCESSORIES FOR YOUR VEHICLE  
A wide selection of Genuine Ford Accessories are available for your  
vehicle through your local Ford or Ford of Canada dealer. These quality  
accessories have been specifically engineered to fulfill your automotive  
needs; they are custom designed to complement the style and  
aerodynamic appearance of your vehicle. In addition, each accessory is  
made from high quality materials and meets or exceeds Ford’s rigorous  
engineering and safety specifications. Ford Motor Company will repair or  
replace any properly dealer-installed Genuine Ford Accessories found to  
be defective in factory-supplied materials or workmanship during the  
warranty period, as well as any component damaged by the defective  
accessories. The accessories will be warranted for whichever provides  
you the greatest benefit:  
12 months or 12,000 miles (20,000 km) (whichever occurs first), or  
the remainder of your new vehicle limited warranty.  
Contact your dealer for details and a copy of the warranty.  
The following is a list of several Genuine Ford Accessories. Not all  
accessories are available for all models. For a complete listing of the  
accessories that are available for your vehicle, please contact your dealer  
or visit our online store at: www.fordaccessories.com.  
Exterior style  
Bug shields  
Deflectors  
Running boards  
Interior style  
Cargo organization  
Electrochromic compass/temperature interior mirrors  
Floor mats  
Lifestyle  
Trailer hitches and towing accessories  
314  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Accessories  
Peace of mind  
Keyless entry keypad  
Remote start  
Vehicle security systems  
For maximum vehicle performance, keep the following information in  
mind when adding accessories or equipment to your vehicle:  
When adding accessories, equipment, passengers and luggage to your  
vehicle, do not exceed the total weight capacity of the vehicle or of  
the front or rear axle (GVWR or GAWR as indicated on the Safety  
Compliance Certification label). Consult your authorized dealer for  
specific weight information.  
The Federal Communications Commission (FCC) and Canadian Radio  
Telecommunications Commission (CRTC) regulate the use of mobile  
communications systems — such as two-way radios, telephones and  
theft alarms - that are equipped with radio transmitters. Any such  
equipment installed in your vehicle should comply with FCC or CRTC  
regulations and should be installed only by a qualified service  
technician.  
Mobile communications systems may harm the operation of your  
vehicle, particularly if they are not properly designed for automotive  
use.  
To avoid interference with other vehicle functions, such as anti-lock  
braking systems, amateur radio users who install radios and antennas  
onto their vehicle should not locate the Amateur Radio Antennas in  
the area of the driver’s side hood.  
Electrical or electronic accessories or components that are added to  
the vehicle by the authorized dealer or the owner may adversely affect  
battery performance and durability.  
315  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ford Extended Service Plan  
FORD ESP EXTENDED SERVICE PLANS  
More than 30 million Ford, Lincoln, and Mercury owners have discovered  
the powerful protection of Ford ESP. It is the only extended service plan  
backed by Ford Motor Company, and provides “peace of mind”  
protection beyond the New Vehicle Limited Warranty coverage.  
Up to 500+ Covered Vehicle Components  
There are four, new-vehicle Extended Service Plans with different levels  
of coverage. Ask you dealer for details.  
PremiumCare – Our most comprehensive coverage. With over 500  
covered components, this plan is so complete that we generally only  
discuss what’s not covered!  
ExtraCare – Covers 113 components, and includes many high-tech  
items.  
BaseCare – Covers 84 components.  
PowertrainCare – Covers 29 critical components.  
Ford ESP is honored by all Ford, Lincoln and Mercury Dealers in  
the U.S. and Canada It’s the only extended service plan authorized and  
backed by Ford Motor Company. That means you get:  
Reliable, quality service anywhere you go.  
Factory-trained technicians.  
Genuine Ford and MotorcraftParts.  
Rental car reimbursement  
If your vehicle is kept overnight for covered repairs, you are  
eligible for rental car coverage, including Bumper-to-Bumper warranty  
repairs, or manufacturer’s recalls.  
Transferable coverage  
If you sell your vehicle before your Ford ESP coverage expires, you can  
transfer any remaining coverage to the new owner. Whenever you’re  
ready to sell your car, prospective buyers may feel better about taking a  
risk on your used vehicle. Ford ESP may add resale value!  
Plus, exclusive 24/7 roadside assistance, including:  
Towing, flat-tire change and battery jump starts.  
Out-of-fuel and lock-out assistance.  
Travel expense reimbursement for lodging, meals and rental car.  
Destination assistance for taxi, shuttle, rental car coverage and  
emergency transportation.  
316  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ford Extended Service Plan  
Ford ESP Can Quickly Pay for Itself  
One service bill – the cost of parts and labor – can easily exceed the  
price of your Ford ESP Service Contract. With Ford ESP, you minimize  
your risk for unexpected repair bills and rising repair costs.  
Avoid the rising cost of properly maintaining your vehicle!  
Ford ESP also offers a Premium Maintenance Plan that covers items that  
routinely wear out.  
The coverage is prepaid, so you never have to worry about affording  
your vehicle maintenance. It covers regular checkups, routine  
inspections, preventive care and replacement of items that require  
periodic attention for normal “wear”:  
Wiper blades  
Spark plugs  
Brake pads and linings  
Shock absorbers  
Belts and hoses  
(except California)  
Clutch disc  
Contact your selling Ford, Lincoln, or Mercury dealership today so they  
can customize a Ford Extended Service Plan that fits your driving  
lifestyle and budget.  
Interest free finance options available  
Take advantage of our installment payment plan, just a 10% down  
payment will provide you with an affordable no interest, no-fee payment  
opportunity.  
317  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ford Extended Service Plan  
318  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
A
B
C
Automatic transmission  
Axle  
Cleaning your vehicle  
319  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Index  
D
Dipstick  
Driving under special  
conditions  
Clock adjust  
E
Emergencies, roadside  
Controls  
Coolant  
320  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
H
F
Four-Wheel Drive vehicles  
Heating  
I
Instrument panel  
G
J
321  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
K
Keyless entry system  
N
L
O
Lamps  
P
Locks  
M
R
322  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
S
Steering wheel  
T
Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System (TPMS)  
Setting the clock  
323  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
U
V
W
Windows  
324  
2010 Econoline (eco)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Edelbrock Automobile Parts YZ WR400 User Manual
Euro Pro Frozen Dessert Maker KP160E User Manual
Extron electronic Speaker 3G AE 100 User Manual
Extron electronic Stereo System 15HD User Manual
Faber Ventilation Hood Dama Isola User Manual
Fisher Price Motorized Toy Car K3115 User Manual
Furuno Radar Detector CSH 5L User Manual
Gateway Computer Monitor 22 INCH WIDESCREEN LCD MONITOR User Manual
GE Microwave Oven ZET938BM User Manual
Glen Dimplex Home Appliances Ltd Cooktop FSE 60 I User Manual